Sustainable International Business: Smart Strategies for Business and Society (Contributions to Management Science) 3031437845, 9783031437847

This is a unique book that adopts a global approach to studying international business. It stimulates research and rethi

115 71 13MB

English Pages 533 [524] Year 2023

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD PDF FILE

Table of contents :
Foreword
Contents
Sustainability in International Business: An Introduction
1 Background
2 Part 1: Economic Sustainability
3 Part 2: Environmental Sustainability
4 Part 3: Social Sustainability
References
Part I: Economic Sustainability
Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach
1 Introduction and Research Background
2 The African Progress Towards The 2030 Agenda
3 Research Methodology
4 Theoretical Framework
4.1 PCSR
4.2 Neo-institutional Theory and Notions of Legitimacy
4.3 Institutional Voids and Development
5 Rejuvenating the SDGs in Africa Through Impactful PCSR
5.1 The Context of PCSR for Development in Africa
5.2 Dynamic Nature of PCSR for Development: The Role of Institutions and Moral Legitimacy
6 Conclusion and Agenda for Future Research
References
Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development of Sustainable Foreign Trade
1 Introduction
2 Origin and Definition
3 Importance of Sustainability in International Trade
4 Strategies for Value Creation
5 Impact of Value Creation Strategy on International Trade
6 The SDGs in International Trade
7 Implications of the SDGs for Sustainable International Trade in Its Three Dimensions
7.1 Economic Dimension
7.2 Social Dimension
7.3 Environmental Dimension
8 Cases Applied in the Sustainable Business World
9 Closing Remarks
References
Reshaping the World´s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam´s PAN Group Adopting the Circular Economy Concept
1 Introduction
2 Sustainability and Circular Economy
3 Vietnam and the Reshaping of the Global Supply Chain
3.1 Low-Hanging Fruit Approach to Relocation
3.2 The Role of Foreign Trade Investment
3.3 A National Policy for Sustainable Development Through the Circular Economy
4 The Circular Economy and the Reshaping of the Global Supply Chain
4.1 The Emergence of the Circular Economy as a National Economic Strategy
4.2 The Circular Economy and the New Global Supply Chain
5 Vietnam and the Circular Economy Movement
5.1 The Circular Economy Movement
5.2 Circular Economy and the Agriculture Sector in Vietnam
6 Circular Economy and Sustainable Transformation of the Agricultural Sector: A Case Study of the Pan Group
6.1 Methodology and Data Collection
6.2 The PAN Group
6.3 More Than Meets the Eyes: The Circular Economy in Action
6.4 High Cohesion/Low Coupling Strategy as a CE Approach to Supply Chain Design
7 Conclusion
References
Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A Business Model Suggestion
1 Introduction
2 Literature Review
2.1 Sustainability and Sustainable Development Goals
2.1.1 Responsible Consumption and Production
2.1.2 Climate Action
2.1.3 Industries, Innovation, and Infrastructure
2.2 Internal Audit
3 Role of Internal Auditors in Sustainability Practices
4 Case Study
4.1 Company Profile
4.2 Company´s Sustainability Perspective
4.3 Company´s Internal Audit Department
4.4 Analysis of Inventory Purchases and Waste Inventory
4.5 Proposed Business Model
5 Summary and Conclusion
References
Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News on Internationalizing Firms: The Role of Social Media Capability
1 Introduction
2 Theoretical Background
2.1 Internationalization and Legitimacy
2.2 Social Media in the Context of Internationalizing
2.3 Fake Social Media News Stories
3 Conceptual Development and Propositions
3.1 Influence of Fake News Stories on Internationalizing Firms
3.2 Social Media Capability
4 Discussion and Conclusions
4.1 Theoretical Implications
4.2 Practical Implications
4.3 Limitations and Suggestions for Future Research
References
Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization in the Social Media Context
1 Introduction
2 Theoretical Background
2.1 The Social Media Context
2.2 Social Network Approach
2.3 Social Networking Tactics
2.4 Social Media and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization
3 Methodology
3.1 Case Selection
3.2 Data Collection
3.3 Data Analyses
4 Findings
4.1 Omnibus Context
4.2 Discrete Context
4.3 Duration
4.3.1 Opportunity Recognition
4.4 Intimacy
4.4.1 Opportunity Recognition
4.5 Reciprocity
4.5.1 Opportunity Recognition
5 Discussion
6 Conclusion
6.1 Theoretical and Practical Implications
6.2 Limitations
References
Part II: Environmental Sustainability
Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation Among International Businesses: A Review and Research Ag...
1 Introduction
1.1 Concept of Green Entrepreneurship
1.2 Sustainability and International Businesses
1.3 Chapter Objectives
1.4 Study Justification and Significance
2 Theoretical Review
2.1 Legitimacy Theory
2.2 Knowledge Spill-Over Theory
2.3 Multi-stakeholder Theory
3 Research Method
3.1 Theoretical Basis
3.2 Research Strategy
3.3 Search Strategy
3.3.1 Identification of a Database
3.3.2 Search Strings
3.3.3 Exclusion and Inclusion Criteria
3.4 Analysis Strategy
3.4.1 Bibliometric Analysis and VOS Viewer
3.4.2 Thematic Analysis
4 Results and Discussion
4.1 Distribution of Articles by Output and by Academic Impact
4.1.1 Output
4.1.2 Citations
4.2 Top Journals that Have Published the 100 Most Cited Articles on Green Entrepreneurship and Its Implications for Climate Ch...
4.3 The Intellectual Structure of Knowledge on Green Entrepreneurship and Its Implications for Climate Change in Africa (Co-au...
4.3.1 Top Authors and Organizations
4.3.2 Co-authorship
4.3.3 Citation Analysis
4.4 Major Themes/Key Concepts that Have Been Explored and How Are They Related
4.4.1 Themes According to Research Categories
4.4.2 Themes According to SDGs
4.4.3 Green Entrepreneurship and SDGs
4.5 Common Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation Practices Among International Businesses
4.5.1 Creative Green Entrepreneurial Practices Among International Businesses
4.5.2 Greenwashing and Green International Businesses
5 Recommendation
5.1 Business Sector
5.2 Government
5.3 Academics
6 Conclusion
References
Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens of Sustainability
1 Introduction
1.1 Defining the Circular Economy
1.2 Putting Circular Economy in Practice
1.3 Conceptual Framework
2 The Inter-Link and Variance Between Circular Economy, Sustainability, and the SDGs
2.1 The 3 Pillars of Sustainability
2.1.1 Social Sustainability
2.1.2 Economic Sustainability
2.1.3 Environmental Sustainability
2.2 Circular Economy and SDGs
2.3 Understanding How Sustainability Differs from Circular Economy
2.4 The Contribution of Circular Economy Towards SDGs and in Turn Towards Sustainability (Table 1)
3 Circular Economy Encapsulated Within International Businesses
3.1 The Need for Sustainability in International Business
3.2 Current State of International Businesses´ Adopting Circular Economy
3.3 Ensuring the Continuous Adoption of Circular Economy in International Businesses
4 How Circular Economy Benefits International Businesses
4.1 Benefits
4.2 The Driving Forces in the Circular Economy
4.2.1 Climate Change
4.2.2 Consumer Awareness
4.2.3 Sustainability in Business
4.2.4 Internal Stakeholders
4.2.5 External Stakeholders
5 Challenges
5.1 Current Challenges that International Business Face Is Implementing SDGs
6 Recommendations and Conclusion
6.1 Recommended Shifts that International Business Can Implement
6.2 Conclusion
References
Analyzing Accountability of Weather Index Insurance Service in Attainment of Sustainable Development Goals: A Sustainable Acco...
1 Introduction
1.1 Weather Index Insurance Service and Agriculture Sector
1.2 Mechanism of Weather Index Insurance Service
1.3 Problem Formulation
1.4 Objectives of Chapter
1.5 Methodology of Chapter
1.6 Organization of Chapter
2 Review of Literature
2.1 Impact of Micro Insurance on Agriculture Risk
2.2 Sustainable Accountability Assessment of WII Service
2.3 Sustainability Challenges of Weather Index Insurance Service
3 Sustainable Accounting Perspective in Measuring Sustainable Service Performance
3.1 Need and Significance of Sustainability Accounting
3.2 Global Reporting Initiative and Sustainability Reporting Standard for Insurance Firms
4 Scope of WII as Financial Service in Insuring Sustainability
4.1 Role of Financial Service in Climate Change Risk Mitigation
4.2 Sustainable Development Perspective of WII
5 Overview of WII in Developing and Developed Nations
5.1 Status of WII in Developing Nations
5.2 Status of WII in Developed Nations
6 Thematic Analysis of WII for Relevance to Sustainable Development Goals
7 Discussion and Findings
8 Conclusion
8.1 Limitations
8.2 Further Avenues
Appendix
References
Refurbished Products and Green Mindfulness: A Qualitative Study from an Emerging Market
1 Introduction
2 Background
2.1 Refurbished Products as Sustainable Products
2.2 Green Mindfulness
3 Study Context: Turkey as an Emerging Market
4 Methodology
4.1 Sample
4.2 Procedure: Abductive Research Approach
4.3 Analysis
5 Findings
5.1 Stimuli Factors
5.1.1 Crises
5.1.2 Ungreen Business Operations
5.1.3 Sources of Information
5.2 Organism Factors
5.2.1 Perceived Risk
5.2.2 Potentially Being Green Mindful
5.3 Response
6 Conclusion
7 Theoretical and Managerial Implications
8 Suggestions for Future Research
References
Regaining Legitimacy in an MNC After a Socio-Ecological Crisis: An Un(smart) Business Strategy?
1 Introduction
2 Literature Review
2.1 CSR in the Mining Industry
2.2 CSR and Legitimacy for MNEs in Emerging Markets
2.2.1 Locally Versus Globally Responsive CSR Strategies for Legitimacy
2.3 Locally Responsive CSR Strategies for Mining MNEs
3 Research Design
3.1 Case Selection and Data Sources
3.2 Data Analysis Procedure
4 Findings and Analysis
4.1 Vale´s Voice: People, Safety, and Repair
4.1.1 Reparation Assurance Through Strategic Governance
4.1.2 Main Strategic Reparation Actions
Socio-Economic Reparation
Environmental Reparation
4.1.3 A New Pact with Society Through Proximity and Transparency(?)
4.2 Stakeholders´ Voices
4.2.1 Sceptism Over Response Measures
4.2.2 External Responses with Industry Impact
4.3 Tensions Concerning the Response Measures
5 Concluding Remarks
5.1 Research Implications and Future Research Directions
5.2 Managerial Implications
References
Wine Tourism as a Catalyst for the Sustainable Development Goals: The Case of Casa Sicilia Winery
1 Introduction
2 Theoretical Background
3 Methodology
3.1 Sample Selection
3.2 Data Collection
3.3 Data Analysis
4 Results
4.1 History and Terroir
4.2 Wine Tourism and Compliance with the SDGs
5 Conclusions
Annex 1
References
Sense or Sensibility? Managerial Sensemaking and Responsible Business Practices in International Small and Medium-Sized Enterp...
1 Introduction
2 Theoretical Background and Hypotheses Development
2.1 Sensemaking
2.2 Sensemaking and Cognition in IE
2.3 Sensemaking and Responsibility
2.4 SME Context
3 Methodology
3.1 Sample and Data Collection
3.2 Measures
3.2.1 Sensemaking
3.2.2 Responsible Business Practices
3.2.3 Control Variables
4 Results
4.1 Descriptive Statistics
4.2 Hypotheses Testing
5 Discussion and Conclusion
5.1 Theoretical and Practical Implications
5.2 Limitations and Future Research
Appendix 1
Sensemaking
Environmental RBPs
Employees-Related RBPs
Local Community RBPs
Customers-Related RBPs
Appendix 2
References
Part III: Social Sustainability
Business Ethics and Corporate Social Responsibility: Translating Theory into Action
1 Introduction
2 The Contours of Ethics
2.1 Definition of Ethics
2.1.1 A Deontological Approach
2.1.2 A Utilitarian Approach
3 Conceptualizing Business Ethics
4 Towards Corporate Social Responsibility
5 Conclusions: Looking Ahead
References
Multinational Enterprises as Bridging Institutional Actors Toward Sustainability
1 Introduction
2 Literature Background
3 Methodology
3.1 Theoretical Sampling
3.2 Data Sources
4 The Case of IKEA and SDGS
4.1 IKEA as an Economic Actor in Promoting Sustainability
4.2 IKEA as a Social Actor in Promoting Sustainability
4.3 IKEA as a Political Actor in Promoting Sustainability
4.4 The Sustainability Work of the IKEA Foundation: The Interplay of the Economic, Social, and Political Roles
5 Discussion
6 Conclusions
References
Sustainable Development Goals and the Mining Industry
1 Introduction
2 Corporate Responsibility in the Mining Sector: A Review of the Literature
3 Methodology
3.1 Background
3.2 The Importance of the Mining Industry
3.3 The Mining Industry and Sustainability Reporting in Europe and North America: Insights on the Geographical Setting of the ...
3.4 Methods
4 Findings
4.1 Data Analysis: Material Topics
4.2 Sustainability Material Topics of the Mining Industry and the SDGs
5 Conclusions
Appendix
References
Socio-Technical Imaginaries of Cultural Transformation Toward Sustainable Development
1 Introduction
2 Theoretical Framework
2.1 Sustainability in Developing Countries and MNEs
2.2 Socio-Technical Imaginaries and a Cultural Perspective
2.3 Socio-Cultural Context of Nepal
3 Methodology
3.1 Data Collection and Analysis
4 Results
4.1 Specifics of Project Implementation
4.2 Project Influence on Socio-Cultural Changes
4.3 Developing Holistic Imaginary of Sustainability
5 Discussion
6 Conclusions
6.1 Theoretical and Managerial Contributions
6.2 Study Limitations and Future Research Suggestions
References
Why Am I (Not) Struggling? Career Prospects of Migrant Academics at British and Finnish Higher Education Institutions
1 Introduction
2 Theoretical Background
2.1 Becoming and Being a Migrant Academic
2.2 Workplace Exclusion and Inclusion
2.3 Social Identity Theory
3 Methodology
3.1 Sampling
4 Analysis
5 Findings
5.1 Multi-Faceted Identities
5.2 Empowerment: Privileges Vs Disadvantages
5.3 Belongingness: Discrimination and Exclusion
5.4 Context Matters: The Institutional Attitude
5.5 A Comparative Assessment of British and Finnish HEIs
6 Summary and Discussion
7 Conclusion
References
Immigrant Entrepreneurs Out of the Shell? An Investigation of Individual Characteristics on the Propensity to Seek External Ad...
1 Introduction
2 Literature Review
2.1 Immigrant Entrepreneurship
2.2 Advantages and Drivers of External Advice-Seeking Behaviours for Ethnic Entrepreneurs
2.3 The Moderator Role of Individual Resilience
3 Methods
3.1 Sample
3.2 Measures
3.2.1 Dependent Variable
3.2.2 Independent Variables
3.2.3 Control Variables
3.3 Data Analysis
4 Results
4.1 Robustness Check
5 Discussion
5.1 Theoretical Contributions
5.2 Policy Implications
5.3 Limitations and Future Directions
6 Conclusion
Appendix
References
Sustainable International Business: A Retrospection and Future Research Direction
References
Index
Recommend Papers

Sustainable International Business: Smart Strategies for Business and Society (Contributions to Management Science)
 3031437845, 9783031437847

  • 0 0 0
  • Like this paper and download? You can publish your own PDF file online for free in a few minutes! Sign Up
File loading please wait...
Citation preview

Contributions to Management Science

Pratik Arte · Yi Wang · Cheryl Dowie · Maria Elo · Salla Laasonen   Editors

Sustainable International Business Smart Strategies for Business and Society

Contributions to Management Science

The series Contributions to Management Science contains research publications in all fields of business and management science. These publications are primarily monographs and multiple author works containing new research results, and also feature selected conference-based publications are also considered. The focus of the series lies in presenting the development of latest theoretical and empirical research across different viewpoints. This book series is indexed in Scopus.

Pratik Arte • Yi Wang • Cheryl Dowie • Maria Elo • Salla Laasonen Editors

Sustainable International Business Smart Strategies for Business and Society

Editors Pratik Arte Northumbria University Newcastle-upon-Tyne, UK

Yi Wang University of Southern Denmark Odense, Denmark

Cheryl Dowie University of Houston-Downtown Houston, TX, USA

Maria Elo University of Southern Denmark Odense, Denmark

Salla Laasonen Technical University of Denmark Kongens Lyngby, Denmark

ISSN 1431-1941 ISSN 2197-716X (electronic) Contributions to Management Science ISBN 978-3-031-43784-7 ISBN 978-3-031-43785-4 (eBook) https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-43785-4 © The Editor(s) (if applicable) and The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2023 This work is subject to copyright. All rights are solely and exclusively licensed by the Publisher, whether the whole or part of the material is concerned, specifically the rights of translation, reprinting, reuse of illustrations, recitation, broadcasting, reproduction on microfilms or in any other physical way, and transmission or information storage and retrieval, electronic adaptation, computer software, or by similar or dissimilar methodology now known or hereafter developed. The use of general descriptive names, registered names, trademarks, service marks, etc. in this publication does not imply, even in the absence of a specific statement, that such names are exempt from the relevant protective laws and regulations and therefore free for general use. The publisher, the authors, and the editors are safe to assume that the advice and information in this book are believed to be true and accurate at the date of publication. Neither the publisher nor the authors or the editors give a warranty, expressed or implied, with respect to the material contained herein or for any errors or omissions that may have been made. The publisher remains neutral with regard to jurisdictional claims in published maps and institutional affiliations. This Springer imprint is published by the registered company Springer Nature Switzerland AG The registered company address is: Gewerbestrasse 11, 6330 Cham, Switzerland Paper in this product is recyclable.

Foreword

The United Nations Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs) encompass a broad range of targets to promote economic, environmental, and social sustainability across the globe. Goals to protect and restore ecosystems, conserve biodiversity, combat climate change, reduce poverty and create employment opportunities, prioritize social inclusion and equality are some of the ways to contribute to a more sustainable and equitable future. In this book, the editors and contributing authors have attempted to understand the potential impacts of the SDGs, to study some of the contextual conditions that influence how SDGs are prioritized, and to move beyond mere financial gains to embrace sustainable practices. Forging a path to ensure a harmonious coexistence is critical in our pursuit of a sustainable future. Economic, environmental, and social sustainability are inextricably intertwined, and navigating through the challenges in our modern world requires active participation, a collaborative and interdisciplinary approach by governments, businesses, organizations, and individuals. The concept of sustainability acknowledges the interdependence of these three main pillars and challenges us to rethink our patterns of consumption, resource allocation, and the consequences of our actions. Each chapter of the book reminds us of our role as catalysts for change and underscores the critical importance of international business as an agent of transformation in the areas of supply chain management, renewable energy, waste management, internationalization of firms, and social justice, among other things. This book is an essential reading for academics, practitioners, and policymakers interested in tackling these critical and timely issues. The editors have arranged an excellent set of chapters from diverse authors around the world. The book is organized into three parts: economic sustainability, environmental sustainability, and social sustainability. In respect of economic sustainability, many regions of the world are currently struggling with a tension between stakeholder versus shareholder capitalism. Should it be the responsibility of corporations to consider sustainability, or should corporations only be held accountable to their shareholders and sustainability issues left to the hands of individuals? On the one hand, some scholars view corporate sustainability efforts as an agency problem, as corporate management v

vi

Foreword

does not have the information, time, and skills to decide where to spend on sustainability on behalf of its investors in a way that is more efficient than what investors themselves could do. On the other hand, other scholars view sustainability as an essential part of the purpose of the corporation, since corporate management does have access to information, supply chains, and resources that individuals do not have, and there are positive externalities from corporate efforts to promote sustainability. Networks and social media can help to promote those externalities and encourage others in the sustainability effort, but there are issues of fake news and other problems that corporations must wrestle with. Novel insights into these issues are provided in the first part of this book. This book provides equally important insights into environmental and social sustainability. Environmental sustainability encompasses green entrepreneurship both locally and internationally and the circular economy. Also, there are measurement issues such as weather indices, and dealing with fake measurement issues that involve greenwashing. Management of environmental sustainability involves insurance and regulatory frameworks as well as sustainable development goals. Social sustainability encompasses ethics, fairness, inequality, and human rights matters. This book covers a diverse set of chapters that tackle these critical problems that are present across the world. Successful management of sustainability is critical to the future of our planet. By critically assessing these issues, the editors and authors of this book have helped us take a significant step forward. I encourage academics, practitioners, and policymakers to reflect on the issues and analyses herein. DeSantis Distinguished Professor, Florida Atlantic University, Boca Raton, FL, USA University of Birmingham, Birmingham, UK 25 June 2023

Douglas Cumming

Contents

Sustainability in International Business: An Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . Pratik Arte, Yi Wang, Cheryl Dowie, Maria Elo, and Salla Laasonen Part I

1

Economic Sustainability

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . M. Karim Sorour and Ahmed El-Sakhawy Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development of Sustainable Foreign Trade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Aldo Alvarez-Risco, Maria de las Mercedes Anderson-Seminario, Nilda Campos-Dávalos, Lucía de los Ángeles Castillo-Butrón, Berdy Briggitte Cuya-Velásquez, Shyla Del-Aguila-Arcentales, Romina Gómez-Prado, and Jorge Sánchez-Palomino

15

35

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN Group Adopting the Circular Economy Concept . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tung Bui, Quan Vu Le, and Jason Nguyen

59

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A Business Model Suggestion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Çağla Demir Pali

83

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News on Internationalizing Firms: The Role of Social Media Capability . . . . . 105 Emmanuel Kusi Appiah Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization in the Social Media Context . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 Emmanuel Kusi Appiah

vii

viii

Part II

Contents

Environmental Sustainability

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation Among International Businesses: A Review and Research Agenda . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 Shadreck Matindike, Stephen Mago, Florah Sewela Modiba, and Amanda Van den Berg Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens of Sustainability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 Anushka Lydia Issac Analyzing Accountability of Weather Index Insurance Service in Attainment of Sustainable Development Goals: A Sustainable Accounting Perspective Review . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Pankaj Singh, Ruchi Kushwaha, and Jyoti Kushwaha Refurbished Products and Green Mindfulness: A Qualitative Study from an Emerging Market . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 Aybegüm Güngördü Belbağ, Cihat Erbil, and Sedat Belbağ Regaining Legitimacy in an MNC After a Socio-Ecological Crisis: An Un(smart) Business Strategy? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 Emilene Leite and Leanne Johnstone Wine Tourism as a Catalyst for the Sustainable Development Goals: The Case of Casa Sicilia Winery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 Javier Martínez-Falcó, Bartolomé Marco-Lajara, Eduardo Sánchez-García, and Patrocinio Zaragoza-Sáez Sense or Sensibility? Managerial Sensemaking and Responsible Business Practices in International Small and Medium-Sized Enterprises . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 Maria Uzhegova, Maria Ivanova-Gongne, and Lasse Torkkeli Part III

Social Sustainability

Business Ethics and Corporate Social Responsibility: Translating Theory into Action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353 Anastasia Sofia Alexiadou Multinational Enterprises as Bridging Institutional Actors Toward Sustainability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379 Cristina Leone, Pasquale Massimo Picone, and Arabella Mocciaro Li Destri Sustainable Development Goals and the Mining Industry . . . . . . . . . . . . 403 Triantafyllos Papafloratos, Ioannis Markidis, Tania Pantazi, and Vasileios Vlachos

Contents

ix

Socio-Technical Imaginaries of Cultural Transformation Toward Sustainable Development . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433 Olga Dziubaniuk, Maria Ivanova-Gongne, and Rumy Narayan Why Am I (Not) Struggling? Career Prospects of Migrant Academics at British and Finnish Higher Education Institutions . . . . . . 459 Rose Quan, Pratik Arte, and Cheryl Dowie Immigrant Entrepreneurs Out of the Shell? An Investigation of Individual Characteristics on the Propensity to Seek External Advice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483 Alessandra Tognazzo, Simona Leonelli, and Diego Campagnolo Sustainable International Business: A Retrospection and Future Research Direction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 513 Pratik Arte, Yi Wang, Cheryl Dowie, Maria Elo, and Salla Laasonen Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 519

Sustainability in International Business: An Introduction Pratik Arte , Yi Wang and Salla Laasonen

, Cheryl Dowie

, Maria Elo

,

1 Background In the year 2015, the United Nations (UN) presented 17 Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs) to be achieved by 2030. The goals were set following a wide-scale consultation with stakeholders including governments, private firms, academic institutions, consumers, and non-governmental organizations. The SDGs are a blueprint for achieving a better and sustainable future for all. In its SDG agenda, the UN (2023) laid a special emphasis on international business as an agent of transformation. Despite this motivation, international business literature “has not kept pace with the expanding role of companies in sustainable development” (van Zanten & van Tulder, 2018, p. 209). There is an overwhelming majority of studies focusing on developed economies (Kolk & van Tulder, 2010) when regions such as the Global South are in need of scholarly attention along the lines of sustainable development (Cruz & Boehe, 2010; Idemudia, 2011). Moreover, various academic outlets have laid a greater emphasis on ethics and responsible governance than on corporate social responsibility (CSR), sustainable development, and environmental

P. Arte (✉) Northumbria University, Newcastle-upon-Tyne, United Kingdom e-mail: [email protected] Y. Wang · M. Elo University of Southern Denmark, Odense, Denmark e-mail: [email protected]; [email protected] C. Dowie University of Houston-Downtown, Houston, TX, USA S. Laasonen Technical University of Denmark, Kongens Lyngby, Denmark e-mail: [email protected] © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2023 P. Arte et al. (eds.), Sustainable International Business, Contributions to Management Science, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-43785-4_1

1

2

P. Arte et al.

issues (Egri & Ralston, 2008). To summarize, it is safe to conclude that eight years since the introduction of the SDGs, international business scholars are yet to realize their full potential. Sustainable International Business is a new book that adopts a global approach to studying international business and its implications for sustainable development. It stimulates research and rethinking among scholars and practitioners to understand how businesses operate internationally into lucrative markets, its role in sustainable business growth, glocal value creation, and economic development. The book covers many topics and issues that one would be familiar within international business. It provides insights into how international firms, entrepreneurs, family businesses, and other stakeholders balance the act of value creation and sustainable business. The book covers three key pillars of sustainability: economic, social, and environmental. It addresses capacity building and the grand challenges that international business needs to develop solutions for. While this book could be comprehensive and easy to understand for undergraduates and graduates, it will need supplementary resources (e.g. HBR, FT, The Economist, etc.) to keep abreast with the current situations within the international context. The book is structured in three parts, each representing the three pillars of sustainability. We have carefully selected 19 original works after a rigorous double-blind review process. The 19 chapters are spread evenly across the three parts of the book. The authors and topics provide a wide international representation and illustrate multi-layered sustainable business perspectives that cover developing, emerging, and developed country contexts as well as multiple directions of international business flows. In terms of methodology, the chapters range from theoretical and conceptual pieces to quantitative empirical works. Authors that have conducted systematic literature reviews have adopted both qualitative (e.g. chapter “Analyzing Accountability of Weather Index Insurance Service in Attainment of Sustainable Development Goals: A Sustainable Accounting Perspective”) and quantitative (e.g. chapter “Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation Among International Businesses: A Review and Research Agenda”) methods. Similarly, the empirical chapters have adopted both qualitative and quantitative methods. Some qualitative chapters have relied on secondary data (e.g. chapters “Regaining Legitimacy in an MNC After a Socio-ecological Crisis: An Un(smart) Business Strategy?” and “Multinational Enterprises as Bridging Institutional Actors Towards Sustainability”) to construct a case-study, others have analysed primary data collected through interviews (e.g. chapters “Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization in the Social Media Context” and “Why Am I (Not) Struggling? Career Prospects of Migrant Academics at British and Finnish Higher Education Institutions”). Further, authors of chapters “Sense or Sensibility? Managerial Sensemaking and Responsible Business Practices in International Small and Medium-Sized Enterprises” and “Immigrant Entrepreneurs Out of the Shell? An Investigation of Individual Characteristics on the Propensity to Seek External Advice” have survey data to conduct quantitative analyses. In terms of geographical diversity, the authors represent institutions from both Global South and Global North. The richness of geographical diversity is further

Sustainability in International Business: An Introduction

3

highlighted by representation of institutions from thirteen countries including Finland, Greece, Italy, Peru, South Africa, Spain, Sweden, Turkey, U.A.E., U.K., U.S. A, and Vietnam. The scope of analysis of the chapters also represents a rich geographic diversity where the focus has been on low-income countries/regions (e.g. chapters “Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development of Sustainable Foreign Trade” and “Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation Among International Businesses: A Review and Research Agenda”), middle-income countries/regions (e.g. chapters “Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News on Internationalizing Firms: The Role of Social Media Capability” and “Refurbished Products and Green Mindfulness: A Qualitative Study from an Emerging Market”), and high-income countries/regions (e.g. chapters “Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News on Internationalizing Firms: The Role of Social Media Capability” and “Wine Tourism as a Catalyst for the Sustainable Development Goals: The Case of Casa Sicilia Winery”). The book follows a logical structure that is intended to provide readers with an intellectually stimulating experience. Part 1 comprises 6 chapters that contribute to economic sustainability.

2 Part 1: Economic Sustainability With the recent global pandemic, individuals and society are increasingly worried about large-scale job losses, growing social insecurities, and uncertainty in financial markets (Choi & Ng, 2011). Sheth et al. (2011) have delineated two distinct aspects of economic sustainability. The first pertains to traditional economic and financial performance, while the second concerns the economic interests of external stakeholders such as economic well-being and living standards in local community, broader society, and planet as a whole. Firms are increasingly called upon to contribute to the broader economic sustainable development, and this call is even more salient for internationalizing firms given their global activities in different institutional environments. In chapter “Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach”, Sorour and El-Sakhawy have attempted to answer the question of: How the constructs of SDGs and political CSR (PCSR) for development can be conceptualized in relation to the African context to maximize the impact of international businesses in society? Through a multi-theoretical framework by integrating political CSR, neo-institutional theory, and pragmatic and legitimacy notions, the authors develop a conceptual model that shows how IB can contribute to the achievement of SDGs in an African context. Chapter “Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development of Sustainable Foreign Trade” by AlvarezRisco and colleagues aims to identify the impact of the role of various stakeholders in the development of sustainable foreign trade incorporating the SDGs. The chapter shows that the development of various sustainable strategies significantly impacts corporate reputation and provides better management in various areas of a company.

4

P. Arte et al.

At the same time, sustainability in an organization increases competitive advantage by generating an improvement in global value chains, as well as the perception of consumers and other stakeholders. In chapter “Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN Group Adopting the Circular Economy Concept”, Bui and colleagues addressed the question of, “What should Vietnam do in terms of economic and business strategies to navigate its economy out of the pandemic crisis and position itself in the upcoming new world order”? The authors develop a conceptual framework that allows emerging economies to embrace the concept of circular economy and develop resilient and self-reliant supply chains. The paper advocates that incorporating circular economy concept enables a supply chain system that shifts from a quasi-linear one-way supply chain arrangement to a honeycomb-like web of circular structure. In chapter “Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A Business Model Suggestion”, Demir analyses the dyed fabric purchasing processes of a company producing garments. It is determined that there were significant disruptions and inefficiencies in the purchasing processes. Since those problems are the subject of both sustainability studies and the work of the internal audit department, a business model is proposed integrating the two functions. With this model, it is aimed to bring together different areas of expertise, prevent overlapping and duplication of tasks, and improve interdepartmental communication. In chapters “Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News on Internationalizing Firms: The Role of Social Media Capability” and “Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization in the Social Media Context”, Kusi Appiah explores the critical, yet sensitive, link between social media and the internationalization of firms. In chapter “Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News on Internationalizing Firms: The Role of Social Media Capability”, Appiah analyses how internationalizing firms mitigate legitimacy challenge caused by fake social media news. The author argued that fake news on social media adversely impact legitimacy of internationalizing firms in a foreign market because they impair consumers’ brand trust. Moreover, the author contends that social media capability of internationalizing firms can mitigate the negative impact of social media fake news on international legitimacy because it can keep the consumers and other stakeholders in the foreign markets well-informed. In chapter “Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization in the Social Media Context”, Appiah analyses how internationalizing SMEs strengthen their organizational-level network ties in the social media context and the associated entrepreneurial opportunity realization in a foreign market. Drawing from four Finnish case companies, the author found that tactical social media initiatives such as tweeting customers’ stories, retweeting stories, posting comments, and commenting on posts by followers are likely to strengthen network ties in dimensions such as duration, intimacy, and reciprocity. Moreover, social media help SMEs recognizing international opportunity such as expanding into foreign networks, creating brand awareness, and accessing to market information.

Sustainability in International Business: An Introduction

5

3 Part 2: Environmental Sustainability Environmental or ecological sustainability has traditionally been at the core of business and society having to re-evaluate the negative impact they have on the environment. At the heart of the dilemma of environmental degradation lies the economic notion of externalities; costs that cannot be attributed in monetary terms. The biosphere has long served the role of an externality to human development, with overexploitation leading to the tragedy of the commons (Hardin, 1968). Up until the environmental awakening in the 1970s, nature was considered as an unlimited resource, or at worst, an open-ended sewer. Despite concerted scientific efforts to challenge the paradigm of unlimited growth, we have, to date, not been able to revise our exploitative incentive to externalize the natural environment. Fast forwarding to the 1980s and 1990s, the environmental harm caused by industrial processes began to make way to the general awareness of citizens, especially in the industrialized countries. The era of end-of-pipe solutions, eco-efficiency, the triple bottom line, and reducing negative environmental impact still form the basis for the majority of corporate environmental practices today. Environmental management, and the notion that the environment can indeed be managed, became an institutionalized corporate practice. Going for the low-hanging fruit of pollution prevention has taken corporations well into the new millennium, and as also Matindike (chapter “Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation Among International Businesses: A Review and Research Agenda”) finds, green solutions are coupled with its unwanted companion greenwashing. Similarly, as Leite and Johnstone discuss in chapter “Regaining Legitimacy in an MNC After a Socio-ecological Crisis: An Un(smart) Business Strategy?”, corporate communication strategy and social licence to operate remain very relevant challenges when addressing negative environmental impact, especially in extractive industries. At the global lelvel, we know that insufficient environmental protection, treating nature as an externality and sewer has led to serious and on some dimensions irreversible harm. The warnings of climate science and climate change have been slow and unsuccessful in motivating for radical change, and we now have scientific evidence of humanity exceeding some of the safe thresholds of the nine critical planetary boundaries (Rockström et al., 2009). The planetary boundary framework, brought forward by the Stockholm Resilience Centre, addresses the thresholds, feedback loops, resilience, and uncertainties related to safe operating spaces (green zones), the zones of uncertainty and where a likely threshold is to exist (yellow zones), and high-risk areas. Since the 2009 introduction of the boundary framework, we have only continued to move closer to high-risk areas (Steffen et al., 2015), with the latest worrying news of exceeding the safe threshold on chemical pollution and plastics (Persson et al., 2022). Given that climate change and environmental degradation have not been motivating enough, scientists are increasingly highlighting the adverse effects of climate change and environmental degradation on human health. The 2022 report of the Lancet Countdown on health and climate change (Romanello

6

P. Arte et al.

et al., 2022) quite provocatively yet accurately states that “the health of people around the world is at the mercy of a persistent fossil fuel addiction”. In conclusion, the scientific evidence on the state of the environment continues to point towards degradation and overexploitation. Therefore, all the solutions solving negative environmental impact continue to be necessary to develop and adopt further. Eco-efficiency and green entrepreneurship (chapter “Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation Among International Businesses: A Review and Research Agenda”), sustainable business practices (chapters “Wine Tourism as a Catalyst for the Sustainable Development Goals: The Case of Casa Sicilia Winery” and “Sense or Sensibility? Managerial Sensemaking and Responsible Business Practices in International Small and Medium-Sized Enterprises”), circular solutions (chapters “Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens of Sustainability” and “Refurbished Products and Green Mindfulness: A Qualitative Study from an Emerging Market”), and financial and digitalization instruments (chapters “Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation Among International Businesses: A Review and Research Agenda”) all continue to be needed to create the necessary transformation towards a more environmentally sustainable world.

4 Part 3: Social Sustainability Social sustainability refers to the ability to meet the needs of members of a society, while ensuring social justice and equity are met (Michalos, 2014). Prioritizing human rights, equality, and inclusion and creating an environment where individuals have access to the basics like education, healthcare, and employment opportunities are important. While sustainability has achieved prominence in many areas, the social dimensions are often the neglected component of sustainability (Cuthill, 2010; Kandachar, 2014). On the other hand, socially sustainable societies can foster stronger social connections, trust and encourage engagement and participation among individuals and groups, to address present societal challenges such as poverty, discrimination, marginalization, gender equality, and other human rights’ issues. Studies support the notion that this participatory approach promotes inclusivity, empowers marginalized voices, and fosters a sense of responsibility within communities (Dillard et al., 2008; Koning, 2001). Social sustainability has gained increasing interest in private and public sector as well as in our societies for good reason. Its impacts are connected and spread in a society influencing its fundaments and functioning. The United Nations Global Compact defines social sustainability as a phenomenon that “is about identifying and managing business impacts, both positive and negative, on people”. This links to the responsibility and accountability of private sector, in international business and entrepreneurship as well as in local business operations. Hence, the relationships and stakeholder management of companies are crucial as companies have a direct influence on their employees, customers, partners, value chain members, nature,

Sustainability in International Business: An Introduction

7

and the communities around them. Recently, the turmoil experienced in global supply chains highlighted the sensitivities of supply chain context in terms of social sustainability. Whether the trigger is Covid-19 or an accident in the Suez channel, the impact diffuses across countries. This underlines the need to address social dimensions beyond measures related to the flow of products and goods (Hutchins & Sutherland, 2008). The global proposal from the United Nations, known as the 2030 Agenda, requires global action to be taken by the governments, businesses, and societies to achieve shared prosperity and sustainability goals (Manzi et al., 2010). It comprises 17 sustainable development goals (SDGs) that were released in 2015. This agenda sees migration as a key driver of sustainable development. Migration involves highly skilled individuals seeking better economic opportunities, and in turn contributing to the economic development and innovation in their host countries. It has significant social, economic, and cultural implications for both the migrants and the communities they become a part of. Contributing to the diversity and multiculturalism of societies can stimulate economic growth through labour market dynamics and further foster cultural exchange and enrichment (Yong, 2019). Migration is thus multifaceted as it involves numerous stakeholders including private and public sector organizations, migrants, and their communities as well as civil society. Migration functions as a source of skills and labour market resource-base, but it also brings with it different capitals and investments. In addition, migrants shape markets and contribute with their diversity and cultural plurality to the markets, innovation, and development. These mechanisms are seen to bring benefits and positive outputs when resources are appropriately employed and institutions are functioning well, supporting safe, orderly, and regular migration as the Global Compact suggests. However, when migration governance fails the results tend to be negative, and these may reflect not only the individual migrant level, but also organizations and respective societies. The Global Compact for Safe, Orderly and Regular Migration underlines the multi-dimensional reality of migration that requires orchestrated policies and approaches (International Organization for Migration, 2023). Human rights and migration are deeply linked as migrants are not only successful talents working as international entrepreneurs and investors or in highly skilled positions, but they also represent subjects for unsustainable, illicit practices and criminality, such as exploitation and human trafficking. Exploitative working conditions, low wages, lack of legal protection, and limited access to justice systems can trap individuals in situations of labour exploitation, including cases of human trafficking. For example, in Europe, the victims trafficked are mainly adults who are trafficked for labour or sexual exploitation. The vulnerabilities are higher for females, as women and girls represent a significant majority of over 80% of all trafficked individuals. This vulnerability is rooted in various factors, including gender inequality, limited access to resources and other support systems, socio-economic disparities, and so on. The counter trafficking data collaborative (CTDC) data collaboration of IOM shows that much of human trafficking is related to labour and linked to even close recruiter relationships while the phenomenon of labour exploitation per se has increased over time (CTDC, 2023). Interestingly,

8

P. Arte et al.

some of these business practices may evolve under the lens of institutions and governance, partly due to lack of resources and partly due to lack of understanding of the phenomenon and its relevance (Elo & Juntunen, 2021). These developments illustrate the unsustainable shadow of business and the fact that these mechanisms deserve more attention due to their negative and destructive impact on society and economy. On the positive side, many countries and businesses benefit greatly from their migration and diasporas abroad, which contribute to home country business and economic, social, and institutional development (Elo & Riddle, 2019; Rana & Elo, 2017). Businesses play a particularly important role with their social sustainability efforts that address social development, gender, diversity, inclusion, poverty, disability, and other forms of inequalities. Business ethics and moral values may foster not only market perceptions of the firm, but also the employer’s attractiveness and image. Furthermore, a positive engagement may alleviate internal conflicts, risks, and productivity issues and in international operations sustainable business engagement may contribute to transnational betterment. Social enterprises and non-governmental organizations are particularly relevant actors addressing such problems and provide ample examples of fruitful business engagement even in highly complicated, high psychic distance contexts and environments, like those in the least developed economies. The UN Global Compact suggests that business gets engaged in: • Improving the lives of the people who are their stakeholders, e.g., by decent jobs, goods and services and by making value chains more inclusive. • Contributing to strategic social investments and fostering public policies and programmes on social sustainability. • Partnering across actors and markets for pooling strengths that make positive impact (UN Global Compact, 2023). Yet, many organizations face claims of white- and greenwashing while many of them are trying to develop organizational strategies around social sustainability and migration through their corporate social responsibility strategies, equity, diversity, and inclusion strategies, corporate social performance assessments, and corporate citizenship endeavours. Organizational strategies are intertwined reflecting a firm’s overall orientations, values, and plans. Strategies involve planning, goals and employing respective resources and capabilities to achieve those goals. Typically, strategies related to internationalization, geographic diversification, corporate governance, market and non-market strategies, talent and resource strategies, communication strategies and different forms of philanthropy and even activism form challenges how to tackle with the plethora of stakeholders and complexities while working towards the goals and objectives given. As Napier et al. (2023) note, the new global dynamics, such as geopolitics, digitalization, and activism, may shape corporate social performance in multiple ways. These dynamics create a context in which corporate social performances are strategic imperatives for businesses as companies are increasingly recognizing the need to integrate social and environmental considerations into their operations and respond accordingly to global issues

Sustainability in International Business: An Introduction

9

that can help ensure their actions align with the broader societal expectations (Napier et al., 2023). They also highlight that today corporate social performance must be substantive, unequivocal, inclusive, and efficient calling for practical and operational approaches. In their model, “value creation for the firm” and “for society” is the highest organizational achievement and goal (Napier et al., 2023, p. 68). In a nutshell, private business plays a central role in developing solutions that create such value through business operations, investments, and entrepreneurship. They are also accountable for their activities in front of their stakeholders, similarly as institutions (van Zanten & van Tulder, 2021). Especially in international and transnational context, the complexities of addressing inequalities and vulnerabilities require particular care as one seemingly positive action in one country may actually generate a negative impact in the other country. Issues such as human stickiness impediments, developing country brain drain, human trafficking, and workplace exploitation show how complex and interconnected these flows and impacts are and who little understood the real-life impacts tend to be (Emmanuel et al., 2019).

References Choi, S., & Ng, A. (2011). Environmental and economic dimensions of sustainability and price effects on consumer responses. Journal of Business Ethics, 104, 269–282. Cruz, L. B., & Boehe, D. M. (2010). How do leading retail MNCs leverage CSR globally? Insights from Brazil. Journal of Business Ethics, 91(2), 243–263. CTDC. (2023). International Organization for Migration. Retrieved 6 8, 2023, from https://www. ctdatacollaborative.org/ Cuthill, M. (2010). Strengthening the ‘social’ in sustainable development: Developing a conceptual framework for social sustainability in a rapid urban growth region in Australia. Sustainable Development, 18(6), 362–373. Dillard, J., Dujon, V., & King, M. (2008). Understanding the social dimension of sustainability. Routledge. Egri, C. P., & Ralston, D. A. (2008). Corporate responsibility: A review of international management research from 1998 to 2007. Journal of International Management, 14(4), 319–339. Elo, M., & Juntunen, A. (2021). Challenges for the host society—Human trafficking, slavery and abuse in the work context. In P. Aerni, M. Stavridou, & I. Schluep (Eds.), Transitioning to decent work and economic growth (pp. 39–66). MDPI. Elo, M., & Riddle, L. (2019). Diaspora business. Oxford University Press. Emmanuel, N. D., Elo, M., & Piekkari, R. (2019). Human stickiness as a counterforce to brain drain: Purpose-driven behaviour among Tanzanian medical doctors and implications for policy. Journal of International Business Policy, 2, 314–332. Hardin, G. (1968). The tragedy of the commons: The population problem has no technical solution; it requires a fundamental extension in morality. Science, 162(3859), 1243–1248. Hutchins, M. J., & Sutherland, J. W. (2008). An exploration of measures of social sustainability and their application to supply chain decisions. Journal of Cleaner Production, 16(15), 1688–1698. Idemudia, U. (2011). Corporate social responsibility and developing countries: Moving the critical CSR research agenda in Africa forward. Progress in Development Studies, 11(1), 1–18. International Organization for Migration. (2023). Retrieved 6 7, 2023, from https://www.iom.int/ Kandachar, P. (2014). Materials and social sustainability. Materials Experience, 91–103. Kolk, A., & van Tulder, R. (2010). International business, corporate social responsibility and sustainable development. International Business Review, 19(2), 119–125.

10

P. Arte et al.

Koning, J. (2001). Social sustainability in a globalizing world: context, theory and methodology explored. UNESCO/MOST meeting. Manzi, T., Lucas, K., Lloyd-Jones, T., & Allen, J. (2010). Understanding social sustainability: Key concepts and developments in theory and practice. In T. Manzi, K. Lucas, T. Lloyd-Jones, & J. Allen (Eds.), Social sustainability in urban areas: communities, connectivity, and the urban fabric (pp. 19–52). Routledge. Michalos, A. C. (2014). Encyclopedia of quality of life and well-being research. Springer. Napier, E., Knight, G., Luo, Y., & Delios, A. (2023). Corporate social performance in international business. Journal of International Business Studies, 54(1), 61–77. Persson, L., Carney Almroth, B. M., Collins, C. D., et al. (2022). Outside the safe operating space of the planetary boundary for novel entities. Environmental Science and Technology, 56(3), 1510–1521. Rana, M. B., & Elo, M. (2017). Transnational diaspora and civil society actors driving MNE internationalisation: the case of Grameenphone in Bangladesh. Journal of International Management, 23(1), 87–106. Rockström, J., Steffen, W., Noone, K., Persson, Å., Chapin, F. S., III, Lambin, E., et al. (2009). Planetary boundaries: exploring the safe operating space for humanity. Ecology and Society, 14(2), 33. Romanello, M., Di Napoli, C., Drummond, P., Green, C., et al. (2022). The 2022 report of the Lancet Countdown on health and climate change: Health at the mercy of fossil fuels. The Lancet, 400(10363), 1619–1654. Sheth, J. N., Sethia, N. K., & Srinivas, S. (2011). Mindful consumption: A customer-centric approach to sustainability. Journal of the Academy of Marketing Science, 39, 21–39. Steffen, W., Richardson, K., Rockström, J., Cornell, S. E., et al. (2015). Planetary boundaries: Guiding human development on a changing planet. Science, 347(6223), 1259855. UN Global Compact. (2023). Social Sustainability, Do business in ways that benefit society and protect people. Retrieved 6 7, 2023, from https://unglobalcompact.org/ van Zanten, J. A., & van Tulder, R. (2018). Multinational enterprises and the Sustainable Development Goals: An institutional approach to corporate engagement. Journal of International Business Policy, 1(3–4), 208–233. van Zanten, J. A., & van Tulder, R. (2021). Towards nexus-based governance: defining interactions between economic activities and Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs). International Journal of Sustainable Development and World Ecology, 28(3), 210–226. Yong, E. L. (2019). Understanding cultural diversity and economic prosperity in Europe: A literature review and proposal of a culture–economy framework. Asian Journal of German and European Studies, 4(1), 5.

Pratik Arte is an Assistant Professor of International Business at Newcastle Business School, Northumbria University, UK. His research is inclined towards examining the interplay between market dynamics and ownership advantages of global firms, specifically focusing on sustainable firm growth through internationalization with an impact on socio-economic development. His research has been published in Journal of Business Research, International Business Review, International Journal of Entrepreneurial Behaviour and Research, and Progress in International Business Research. Yi Wang is an Associate Professor of International Business (IB) and Entrepreneurship in the Department of Business and Management at the University of Southern Denmark. His research areas include entry strategies (e.g. entry modes) and post-entry survival and growth in Asian emerging markets, focusing on big multinationals and small- and medium-sized firms. Recently, Yi Wang has expanded his research areas into topics such as IB from emerging markets, sustainability and CSR, and Industry 4.0. In particular, he is interested in understanding the impact of

Sustainability in International Business: An Introduction

11

internationalization on adopting proactive environmental strategies in internationalizing firms and their foreign operations and the role of internal firm-specific resources and external stakeholder pressures in driving such a behaviour change. Yi Wang conducted several large sample quantitative studies. His research has appeared in several good IB journals or book chapters in internationally edited books (e.g. EIBA and AIB-UKI chapter-based books). Cheryl Dowie is an Assistant Professor at the Marilyn Davies College of Business, UHD. Her research interests are in Negotiation/Conflict management, group dynamics, management pedagogy, gender, and AI. Prior to this, Dr Dowie worked as an Assistant Professor at the University of Aberdeen, UK, where she co-chaired the Diversity, Equity, and Inclusion (DEI) Committee for the Business School. At Aberdeen, she also received three university-wide teaching awards for her excellence in teaching. Before pursuing a career in academia, Cheryl was part of the mobilization/ transitions team at Hewlett Packard, IBM, and Accenture, where she supported the financial services sector and worked with clients in the US and the UK. Maria Elo , associate professor at the University of Southern Denmark, professor at the BRIIB Institute of International Business at Shanghai University, Senior Fellow, University of Turku, and adjunct professor at Åbo Akademi University, works in the area of international business, -entrepreneurship and -migration with topics such as internationalization, human stickiness, resources of skilled migrants and returnees, migrant and diaspora entrepreneurship, transnational and family businesses, diaspora networks in international business, diaspora investment and remittances. She has published books and articles, for example, in Journal of World Business, Journal of International Management, Journal of International Business Policy, Industrial Marketing Management, Regional Studies, Journal of International Entrepreneurship, and International Journal of Entrepreneurship and Small Business. Salla Laasonen is an Associate Professor of Management at the DTU Technical University of Denmark. She is also an Academic Director of an executive level Master in Sustainable Leadership, which focuses on taking a holistic approach to sustainability strategy and creating sustainability impact. Her research focuses on longitudinal qualitative research on collaborative nature conservation, stakeholder dialogue, and cross-sector partnerships. Before joining DTU, she was an Assistant Professor of Business-Society Management at the Rotterdam School of Management, Erasmus University. Before joining RSM, she was a visiting scholar at Standford University and George Washington University, and she completed her International Business PhD at the University of Turku, Finland. In addition to sustainability-related topics, Dr. Laasonen specializes in scientific research methods and the sociological analysis of statistics.

Part I

Economic Sustainability

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach M. Karim Sorour and Ahmed El-Sakhawy

Abstract The realisation of the Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs) requires input from international business (IB) as a key stakeholder within the society. In an African context, given the sheer complexities impeding sustainable progress towards the SDGs, this input is critical. Whilst corporate social responsibility (CSR) can facilitate IBs’ contribution, the literature shows that that many IB work on ad hoc CSR activities without necessarily considering how far these activities yield tangible developmental benefits. This conceptual paper adopts a theory synthesis approach to answer the following question: How the constructs of SDGs and Political CSR can be conceptualised in relation to the African context to maximise the impact of international businesses in society? Through a multi-theoretical framework based on the PCSR, neo-institutional theory, and legitimacy notions, the rejuvenating SDGs in Africa model shows how IB can contribute to SDGs in their host country via adopting a PCSR approach. In an emerging participatory governance model, IB can achieve moral legitimacy through compliance with normative institutions introduced by the government and society. This model is evolving in nature and is based on an ongoing dialogue between policy makers and IB to formulate effective strategies to ensure PCSR activities are yielding benefit to the society.

1 Introduction and Research Background In 2015, 10% of the world’s population lived in extreme poverty with 11% malnourished, 5% had no access to basic healthcare services, 35% of women were subject to domestic or sexual violence, 36% lacked basic sanitation facilities, and 15% did not have electricity (Kulkarni & Aggarwal, 2022). These disturbing figures are all related to the so-called grand challenges, a term which covers global hunger, M. K. Sorour (✉) Newcastle Business School, Northumbria University, Newcastle Upon Tyne, UK e-mail: [email protected] A. El-Sakhawy Institute of Management Accountants (IMA), Cairo, Egypt © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2023 P. Arte et al. (eds.), Sustainable International Business, Contributions to Management Science, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-43785-4_2

15

16

M. K. Sorour and A. El-Sakhawy

poverty, labour exploitation, diseases, corruption, inequality, gender biases, climate change (Jamali et al., 2021). In this context, sustainable development score for Africa was more startling with poverty rates close to 59% in many countries at the rate of 3.2$/day (UNCTAD, 2021). Given the grand nature of these ongoing sustainable development challenges, the world leaders have agreed to combat these staggering conditions at the 2012 United Nations Conference on Sustainable development (Rio +20) which was articulated in the outcome document “The Future We Want” indicating the benefit of creating the sustainable development goals (SDGs) as a focused and coherent approach to address these challenges and become the successor of the Millennium Development Goals (MDGs) (UNECA, 2015). The development of the SDGs was of crucial importance as the continent was off track in achieving most of MDGs goals, with slow progress achieved in relation to health, gender, and women empowerment indicators, whilst poverty, inequality and extreme hunger, basic infrastructural service, quality of education as well as poor social protection remain a tremendous responsibility that the SDGs must address (UNECA, 2015). In 2019 (just before COVID-19), Africa scored an SDG progress score of 52.8% highlighting a gap of more than 47%; indeed, different African regions have performed slightly differently, with North and South Africa showing higher progress scores compared with East, West, and Central regions (ASDGR, 2022). Unfortunately, COVID-19 as well as the Ukraine-Russia crisis has further slowed down the progress on achieving the SDGS with the African GDP expected to decline by a negative of 3.3% score (ASDGR, 2022). Of note, the Ukraine-Russia war has a negative direct impact on Africa in terms of “trade disruption, food and fuel price spikes, macroeconomic instability, and security challenges . . . At the same time, food grain prices continued to rise even higher as supply disruptions from Russia and Ukraine (actual and anticipated) rocked global markets . . . the pass through of consequent inflation will be swift and hard-hitting, especially for vulnerable groups like women and children” (UNDP, 2022, p.i). Overall, the latest Africa SDG report published in November 2022, concludes that most African countries are currently struggling to achieve most of their SDG targets (ASDGR, 2022). Clearly, measures have to be taken to enhance domestic resources mobilisation, as Africa requires around $200 billion annually to achieve required progress towards their SDGs with climate finance adaptation costs about $30 to $50 billion annually, as such the “path towards sustainable development requires significant policy shifts and the scale of resources required . . . will be immense” (UNECA, 2015, p. 67). Sustainable development generally refers to “a development which meets the needs of the present without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs” (WCED, 1987). Sustainable development concept is based on three interlinked dimensions: economic growth, social development, and environmental sustainability (UNECA, 2015; Harris, 2009; Nwozor et al., 2021). As increasing economic growth incurs inevitable environmental and social costs (Muniz & Cruz, 2015), sustainable development can only happen if economic growth is socially sustainable and environmentally responsible. As with the increased GDP growth comes an increased pressure on “biodiversity, climate change and the

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach

17

undermining of human livelihoods” (Martines-Alier, 2012, p. 62). This requires making radical political and environmental changes that alleviate serious socioenvironmental impediments (Muniz & Cruz, 2015) for Africa and the developing world in general. Not only that, but to mobilise all members of the society to contribute towards the UN 2030 agenda (Bardal et al., 2021) including “public, private sector, civil society, youth organizations, and women’s organizations [with] . . . Leaders in all sectors of the economy and society must actively steer the sustainable development agenda and ensure commitment by all stakeholders” (UNECA, 2015, p. 68). One pivotal concept which has received an increased attention in the extant literature as a facilitator in the realisation of the SDGs is corporate social responsibility (CSR) (Kulkarni & Aggarwal, 2022; Huber & Gibert, 2017; Mitra & Chatterjee, 2019; Rendtorff, 2019). CSR can be defined as an umbrella term that encompasses a range of concepts and practices; however, the essence of CSR is that businesses should have responsibility for their impact on natural environment and society which goes beyond the letter of law (Blowfield & Frynas, 2005, p. 503). While the conventional CSR theorising and practices could potentially compliment governments’ efforts to achieve the SDGs targets, the complexity of the grand challenges in hand, renders it ineffective (Kulkarni & Aggarwal, 2022; Jamali et al., 2021; Blowfield & Doian, 2014). This is because, CSR can be perceived as a facet of “economic and cultural imperialism by local suppliers in developing countries” (Jamali et al., 2015, p. 460) where international companies set the target price and quantity in response to fierce competition and then pass these demanding requirements to local suppliers, hence creating small margin for nearly ceremonial CSR activities. Therefore, CSR is to a great extent overshadowed by instrumental short-termism which focuses on the bottom line and is inspired by the business case for CSR, instead of genuinely contributing to the sustainable development narrative (Adelopo et al., 2015; Sorour et al., 2021a). Furthermore, the Western-centric assumptions and construction of the CSR concept are problematic in the context of developing countries, “where notions of ‘private’ sector, ‘civil society, ‘stakeholders’ and ‘transparency’ are not always clearly delineated” (Sorour et al., 2021b, p. 89). The peculiarity of developing countries context, i.e., such as Africa adds a further dimension of complexity based on the different set of institutional factors and unique socio-political dynamics (Sorour et al., 2021a); hence, non-western contexts provide a fertile ground for exploration of how CSR could be conceptualised differently to enable impactful contribution of businesses to the SDGs in Africa. Due to these impediments, this CSR perspective is insufficiently utilised in practice (Kulkarni & Aggarwal, 2022) and not adequately understood in the extant literature (El Alfy et al., 2020), highlighting a gap in our understanding and conceptualisation of how CSR could practically work as a sustainable development tool and hence facilitate the realisation of the SDGs in an African environment. As such it becomes significant to address such gap in the literature and to find some answers to the fundamental question of how CSR programmes could yield “tangible development benefits in communities” (Jamali et al., 2017, p. 3).

18

M. K. Sorour and A. El-Sakhawy

Against this background, this chapter focuses on the role of a key stakeholder group, international businesses in Africa and how their CSR can be an effective tool which systematically contribute to social development and hence to the SDGs. Here, international businesses could align their CSR plans with national SDGs priorities. This conceptual paper argues that the role of international business in the realisation of SDGs in Africa could be effective, if understood through a combined theoretical lens (Sorour et al., 2021a) that encompasses the political CSR (PCSR) framework (Scherer & Palazzo, 2011), the neo-institutional theory, and the notions of organisational legitimacy (Suchman, 1995). First, the PCSR concept distances itself from the neo-liberal notions of economic rationality that perceives businesses as economic rather than political player in the economy (Scherer & Palazzo, 2011). It posits that businesses should perform the two roles, i.e. economic and political, and give back to the society which in the first place offered them the license to operate and profit from its members. PCSR “. . . entails those responsible business activities that turn corporations into political actors, by engaging in public deliberations, collective decisions, and the provision of public goods or the restriction of public bads in cases where public authorities are unable or unwilling to fulfil this role” (Scherer et al., 2016 p. 276). The PCSR concept captures the dynamic relationship between international businesses and the institutional context which affects and is affected by these businesses as political actors (Scherer, 2018). As political actor, international businesses play an effective role to address deficits in public services (normally considered as a state responsibility) (Sorour et al., 2021a). Second, CSR expressions must be understood within the African institutional environment where these businesses operate and respond to institutional pressures (Scott, 2014) rather than considered in institutional vacuum. Here, neo-institutional theory is key to understand the idiosyncrasies of the institutional environments in which these businesses operate. Third, it is important to note that a key motivation for international businesses’ engagement in enhancing the social welfare of the communities in which they operate is to achieve moral legitimacy (Scherer & Palazzo, 2011; Scherer, 2018; Sorour et al., 2021b). This is a type of legitimacy which goes beyond the logic of instrumentality and the notion of pragmatic legitimacy1 which no longer suffices as an acceptable means of giving back to the society (Brammer et al., 2012; Adelopo et al., 2015; Marquis et al., 2016; Sorour et al., 2021a). Given that international businesses might not be familiar with the developmental priorities in their host country, the SDGs would offer a distinct opportunity for international businesses to impactfully contribute to sustainable development. Specifically, the national 2030 agendas provide a detailed plan for a country’s priorities

1

Moral legitimacy reflects a positive normative evaluation of the organization and its activities (e.g. Aldrich & Fiol, 1994; Parsons, 1960). Unlike pragmatic legitimacy, moral legitimacy . . . rests not on judgments about whether a given activity benefits the evaluator, but rather on judgments about whether the activity is “the right thing to do” (Suchman, 1995, p. 579).

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach

19

to achieve the SDGs by 2030. As such, this could facilitate international businesses’ engagement in development through explicitly aligning their CSR plans with national 2030 agenda in their host country. This means that international businesses could redirect their investments towards SDGs serving initiatives that can change lives and maximise value creation in their host countries (El Alfy et al., 2020). However, and as mentioned earlier, this CSR perspective as a tool for systematic implementation of SDGs still not adequately understood in the extant literature (El Alfy et al., 2020) and practice (Kulkarni & Aggarwal, 2022). This chapter, hence, offers an integrated conceptualisation of the SDGs implementation in Africa based on these three concepts. We argue that without this multiperspective understanding, policy making will fail to unleash the huge potential role of international businesses in society. Especially with emerging normative institutions gaining momentum, non-compliance would impair international businesses’ legitimacy in their host countries. Here few attempts such as Huber & Gilbert (2017) discussed PCSR and how through multiple stakeholder initiatives, firms can contribute towards social development in Bangladesh. However, given the complexities posed by the African situation in relation to the progress towards the SDGs as well as the prevalent business case-driven CSR, the conceptualisation of PCSR requires further consideration of the institutional environment and motives behind CSR engagement. We unpack PCSR in terms of institutionalisation and legitimatisation constructs that could mobilise international businesses to assume their political responsibilities in a more systematic way. In doing so, we heed El Alfy et al. (2020) call for future research to investigate the role of MNC’s CSR in SDGs in more detail. As such, this chapter contributes to the CSR for development as well as the international business literature by conceptualising how PCSR can be adopted by international businesses to enhance their social impact via systematically contributing to the realisation of the SDGs and hence improve their moral legitimacy within their host countries. Against this background, this chapter poses the following research question: RQ1: How the constructs of SDGs and Political CSR can be conceptualised in relation to the African context to maximise the impact of international businesses in society? This chapter has developed a model for rejuvenating the SDGs in Africa using impactful PCSR. The model offers a realistic, theoretically dense conceptualisation which contributes to the CSR for development literature and can assist policy makers and practitioners in formulating effective strategies that can nurture progress towards the SDGs and other African developmental agendas. This model hence applies to the 17 SDGs. It shows the importance of international businesses’ engagement with the host country government and local community to agree a strategy to address specific SDGs by 2030. This approach could potentially shift the focus of international businesses working on ad hoc CSR activities that they consider important, to CSR activities that yield “tangible development benefits in communities” (Jamali et al., 2017, p. 4) and hence contribute to the realisation of the SDGS in African countries. This is particularly important to international businesses as non-compliance with emerging normative institutions could negatively affect

20

M. K. Sorour and A. El-Sakhawy

their legitimacy. Finally, this model can also underpin knowledge exchange endeavours between academia and practice. The rest of this chapter is organised as follows: Sect. 2 provides an overview of the progress and challenges in achieving the 2030 agenda SDGs in Africa and the role of international business. Section 3 discusses the research methodology. Section 4 discusses the theoretical framework based on the concepts of PCSR, neo-institutional theory, and legitimacy. Section 4.1 discussed how the integrated theoretical framework could further our understanding of the symbiotic relationship of sustainable development and CSR, hence offering an opportunity to rejuvenate the SDGs in Africa. Finally, Sect. 5 offers the conclusion and future research agenda.

2 The African Progress Towards The 2030 Agenda This section provides an overview of Africa’s progress on the 2030 agenda, highlighting the impact of COVID-19 and the Ukraine-Russia crisis and sets the scene for the potential role of international businesses towards sustainable development in their host African countries. The African continent is rich in natural resources such as crude oil, natural gas, minerals, forests, and wildlife, holding a significant share of the world’s renewable and non-renewable natural resources; nonetheless, unsustainable use/extraction alongside corruption costs around $195 billion annually in wasted resources (UNECA, 2015). Hence, it is not surprising that the African continent is facing “extreme poverty, rampant corruption, human rights abuse, environmental degradation (due to extractive industry activities), extreme inequalities, HIV/Aids, conflicts, and weak rule of law” (Mangena et al., 2023, p. 2). The 2020 Africa sustainable development report (2022) thoroughly analysed the performance of 52 African countries across all five SDGs pillars: people, prosperity, planet, peace, and partnerships. The results show that four North African countries; Tunisia, Morocco, Algeria, and Egypt as well as the Island states of Mauritius, Cabo Verde, Botswana, and Ghana are ahead of other countries in the continent, having said that these top performers are 35% away from achieving the SDGs by 2030. Africa has achieved an average staggering score of 53.82% which means that the continent is only halfway towards achieving the SDGs. According to the same report, no African country has been categorised as progress is on track (known as green category), with the greatest challenges related to SDG 3 (good health and wellbeing), SDG9 (industry, innovation and infrastructure), and SDG 16 (peace, justice and strong institutions), whilst the strong performance was recorded against SDG 13 (climate change) and SDG 12 (responsible consumption and production). In relation to corruption and transparency, the report shows there were some improvements achieved; however, the continent scored 17.1 on transparency related to the laws and records of state-owned companies, which suggests that corruption is severely impacting the effectiveness of both the private and public sectors.

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach

21

In a further update, the 2022 Africa Sustainable Development Report evaluated Africa’s performance in relation to SDG 4: Education and shows that the continent made slow progress in the provision of quality education for all; SDG 5: gender equality and empowerment of all women and girls and highlighted that progress towards inclusivity is slow and the institutional infrastructure to protect women and girls is weak; SDG 14: life below water with a key takeaway that the organic and chemical pollutants remain a risk to Africa’s marine ecosystem; SDG 15: life on Land, here the report warned that loss of forests, biodiversity, and land degradation is prevailing and hinders progress on this aspect. Finally, SDG 17: partnerships, here the report emphasised the importance of this objective in underpinning successful progress in other SDGs, through domestic resources mobilisation. Finally, the report assessed the impact of COVID-19 and Ukraine-Russian crisis, which had unfortunately reversed some of the progress made on achieving the SDGS. Of essence here is to ask who should take the responsibility of implementing the UN agenda 2030 and the SDGs? The Africa regional report on the Sustainable Development goals (2015) attempted to answer this question, when the authors recommended that “the process of implementing the sustainable development goals should be led at the highest level of political leadership at local, country, subregional and regional levels. Effective political leadership is crucial for ownership, commitment, galvanizing support, mobilizing resources and ensuring accountability . . . Effective participation of all stakeholders public, private sector, civil society, youth organizations, and women’s organizations – should be vigorously cultivated, encouraged and sustained” (UNECA, 2015, P. 68, emphasis by the authors). As such, implementing the SDGs on ground remains a joint responsibility between the government, society, and the private sector. Here, the role of the government is crucial in offering the vision and policies which instigate and foster the participation of various stakeholders in this agenda, as the SDGs resemble a social contract between African governments and the governed (Odusola, 2017).

3 Research Methodology A research design is related to the “decisions about how to achieve research goals, linking theories, questions, and goals to appropriate resources and methods” (Flick, 2018, p. 102). Thus, it is a plan on how to collect evidence that enable researchers to answer the research in hand (Jaakkola, 2020). This chapter utilises a conceptual research design in order to answer the research question. In doing so, the chapter follows Jaakkola (2020) theory synthesis’s template which suggests that a conceptual paper starts from a “focal phenomenon that is observable but not adequately addressed in the existing research . . . and then argue that the aspect of interest is best addressed in terms of particular concepts or theories” (P. 19). The focal phenomenon in this chapter is twofold: first, the grand developmental challenges in Africa expressed in the slow (in some cases stagnant) growth and realisation of the

22

M. K. Sorour and A. El-Sakhawy

SDGs in many African countries. Challenges that cannot be simply left to the African governments to deal with solely. Second, whilst the CSR concept sets some expectations from international businesses contribution to alleviate these grand challenges, the “pre-occupation has been mostly with types of CSR programs and processes, rather than the more fundamental question of how CSR programs are yielding (or not) tangible development benefits in communities” (Jamali et al., 2017, p. 4). In this situation, the business case motivation for engaging with CSR is more prevalent than the moral case, i.e. doing the right thing. Moreover, research on the relationship between CSR and development is inconclusive (Huber & Gilbert, 2017). This led many scholars to highlight the need to further investigate and better understand the role of international businesses’ CSR in development (El Alfy et al., 2020). We heed these calls by mobilising a multitheoretical framework (Sorour et al., 2021a) based on the integration of PCSR (Scherer & Palazzo, 2011), neo-institutional theory (Scott, 2014), and legitimacy notions (Suchman, 1995) to conceptualise addressing grand SDGs challenges in Africa through international business’ impactful CSR expressions. The aim here is to offer an overall understanding that applies to all SDGs. Jaakkola (2020) opines that the choice of concepts in a conceptual paper is based on “their fit to the focal phenomenon” (p. 19). Hence, we argue that our multi-theoretical framework offers a unique understanding and appreciation of the phenomenon of sustainable development, taking into consideration the political role of international businesses, as well as the complex institutional environment within African countries and competing logics for achieving organisational legitimacy. The relevance of each element of our multi-theoretical framework to our focal is discussed in Sect. 4. Finally, linking the structure and process is a key element of theorising exercises (Strauss & Corbin, 1992). The quality of our model can be judged against “thick description” as a useful tool for “performative rethinking” (Gibson-Graham, 2014, P. 147) of the CSR concept. Thick description is attentive to the details, context, and social relations pertaining to a phenomenon (Ponterotto, 2006; Denzin, 1989). Good thick description (1) . . . gives the context of an act; (2) it states the intentions and meanings that organise the action; (3) it traces the evolution and development of the act (Denzin, 1989, p. 33). In Sect. 4.1, we elaborate how these criteria are fulfilled by rejuvenating the SDGs in Africa through Impactful PCSR model.

4 Theoretical Framework This chapter adopts a multi-theoretical framework which integrates Scherer & Palazzo (2011) PCSR, Scott’s (2014) neo-institutional theory, and Suchman’s (1995) notions of pragmatic and moral legitimacy as a lens to synthesise an understanding to inform policy making and practice around the role of international businesses as a salient political player that can further facilitate the realisation of any of the 17 SDGs in Africa as deemed relevant to the circumstances of the country in question.

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach

4.1

23

PCSR

There is no single accepted definition of PCSR; however, the most notable work in this area is of Scherer & Palazzo (2011) who highlight the challenging nature of engaging businesses in CSR. They suggest that this engagement cannot be satisfactory unless we think of the “corporate” social responsibility differently. Corporations and businesses in general are considered purely economic actors within the society and this what limits their engagement with CSR, as the businesses case and neo-liberal notion of economic rationality underpin businesses motivation to engage with CSR. Hence, to change this, the corporate role should be extended to include political responsibilities that clearly includes contribution to the sustainable development agenda (Wettstein & Baur, 2016; Luyckx & Janssens, 2016; Acosta & Pérezts, 2019). Essentially, this requires adopting a more inclusive governance model that allows business firms to systematically provide community services (Boddewyn & Doh, 2011; Acosta & Pérezts, 2019), adopt self-regulatory behaviour (Slager et al., 2012; Maier, 2021), and contribute towards regulatory changes through political channels (Den Hond et al., 2014; Acosta & Pérezts, 2019). This extended role of corporations, particularly international businesses will directly facilitate the implementation of SDGs (Selsky & Parker, 2010) in Africa, for instance engaging MNCs in community services to reduce poverty and hunger, achieving food security and promoting citizens’ well-being or in other words filling the institutional voids (Amaeshi et al., 2016; Sorour et al., 2021a). Here, in this case, international businesses are in essence providing resources and financial support for development (Jo et al., 2018; Onsongo, 2019; Lind et al., 2022). Of note, that according to PCSR, providing community services is driven by adopting a selfregulatory approach (Bartley, 2007; Slager et al., 2012; Scherer et al., 2016). This approach can then offer the flexibility of integrating their global culture and values with the local one (Filatotchev & Stahl, 2015). So, international businesses could mentor their employees in every country where they operate (Camilleri, 2016; Mirvis & Googins, 2018) and hence not only live up to the normative ideals of PCSR within a particular society, but also contributes to building such ideals (Slager et al., 2012), following a transnational approach to PCSR (Filatotchev & Stahl, 2015). This would also accelerate the development and help addressing institutional voids signifying absent or weak institutional arrangements (Chakrabarty & Bass, 2013) (further discussed at the end of this section). Through the same logic, international businesses can also affect the regulatory process in host country as “companies can sometimes act as governments, or as citizens in the administration of aspects of citizenship rights for individuals in the community” (Lind et al., 2022, p. 212). Of note, that moving from usual instrumental self-serving CSR to political CSR is not a straightforward (Sorour et al., 2021a) and requires the collaboration of governments, international businesses, local communities, NGOs and consumers, and all parties to overcoming barriers that hinder development.

24

4.2

M. K. Sorour and A. El-Sakhawy

Neo-institutional Theory and Notions of Legitimacy

Second, neo-institutional theory emphasises the importance of the wider environment on organisational behaviour (Scott, 2001) and is not necessarily in the form of technological or material influence but can be based on cultural and symbolic aspects (DiMaggio & Powell, 1983). Of note, that neo-institutional theory discounts the idea that organisation adopts a certain practice because it is the most efficient or rationale but because it is “culturally specific practices akin to myth and ceremonies devised by many societies and assimilated into organizations” (Hall & Taylor, 1996, p. 946). Extant literature on CSR in developing countries has paid attention to the role of institutions in predicting organisational engagement/disengagement with CSR (Sorour et al., 2021b; Jamali & Neville, 2011; Li & Belal, 2018). Two institutional pillars that could instigate organisational responses are of interest here, the regulative and the normative pillar (Scott, 2014). The latter is based on societal obligations, moral expectations and a logic of appropriateness (Scott, 2014). The notion of legitimacy is central to the neo-institutional theory and how the institutional pillars function, as organisations do not only compete for resources and customers but also for “political power and institutional legitimacy” (DiMaggio & Powell, 1983, p. 150). Legitimacy refers to “a generalised perception or assumption that the actions of an entity are desirable, proper, or appropriate within some socially constructed system of norms, values, beliefs, and definitions” (Suchman, 1995, p. 574). As such, legitimacy is a key construct that affects how companies respond to institutional pressures. The neo-institutional theory has been utilised to understand and theorise CSR within developing countries (Scott, 2008; Matten & Moon, 2008; Jamali & Neville, 2011; Muthuri & Gilbert, 2011). Legitimacy is key to establish a dialogue between organisations and their salient stakeholders (Soobaroyen & Ntim, 2013). Two types of legitimacy are of interest here and are aligned with the regulative and normative institutional pillars (Scott, 2014). Pragmatic legitimacy is the basis for propagation of the regulative pillar on the basis of “self-interested calculation” (Suchman, 1995, p. 598). Conversely, moral legitimacy is based on normative basis and granted on the basis that the organisational behaviour is deemed right and appropriate, by its salient stakeholders (Suchman, 1995). In the context of CSR, companies might engage with CSR expressions to achieve pragmatic legitimacy based on a business case justification and calculated gains whether to further its reputation or in the form of rent seeking (Brammer et al., 2012; Adelopo et al., 2015). Alternatively, companies can engage with CSR expressions on moral and normative grounds to enhance the social welfare of the society in which it operates (Scherer, 2018).

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach

4.3

25

Institutional Voids and Development

Finally, it is worth noting that in Africa, the working of PCSR within a nearly effective institutional environment can be faced with a problem known as institutional voids. Institutional voids are a main hindrance of African development and cause of suffering faced by both individuals and businesses operating therein (Chakrabarty & Bass, 2013; Mair & Marti, 2009). As Chakrabarty & Bass (2013) explain “Institutional voids exists where institutional arrangements[s] that support markets are either absent or weak” (p. 546). Examples of institutional voids include unreliable sources of information, inefficient judiciaries, high levels of corruption, the influence of the state, and weak law enforcement (Chakrabarty, 2009; Khanna & Palepu, 2010). While institutional voids can be a counterproductive force that could make it easier for businesses to evade CSR activities (Jamali & Karam, 2016), it can also offer some opportunities to fill such voids (Lam et al., 2017). Moreover, solutions provided by powerful actors to minimise these voids are “idiosyncratic to the institutional fabric of the countries they are working in. Each is derived from a complex cultural, political and economic legacy” (Mair et al., 2007, p. 39). In the same vein, organisations follow CSR adaptive mechanisms and strategies which are voluntary and normatively driven to build an institutional immunity that mitigates the negative consequences of institutional voids (Amaeshi et al., 2016).

5 Rejuvenating the SDGs in Africa Through Impactful PCSR This section contemplates how our theoretical framework (Sect. 4) would offer a nuanced synthesis of the CSR concept that transcends the business case as a prime justification for CSR engagement (Brammer et al., 2012; Adelopo et al., 2015). Instead, CSR expressions are sought on moral and normative grounds to enhance the social welfare of the society in which it operates (Scherer, 2018). While African nations are currently at different stages of their SDG journeys, as discussed in Sect. 2, COVID-19 and the Ukraine-Russian crisis have further slowed down the progress on achieving the SDGs in African nations. As a result, we have proposed this model to rejuvenate the SDGs in Africa. Our rejuvenating the SDGs in Africa through Impactful PCSR model shown in Fig. 1 delivers a careful depiction that captures the dynamics between key entities in the PCSR for development scene, namely: UN agenda 2030 expressed in the SDGs, the African national governments as the policy makers in their respective states and who collectively and individually shown commitment to the SDGs in 2017 and finally the international businesses representing the private sector in this chapter. The model also situates PCSR within a sole African country context, this is crucial as this model makes no attempt to suggest a one-size-fits-all perspective but offers a transferable model which can vary between one country and another as we will

26

M. K. Sorour and A. El-Sakhawy

Fig. 1 Rejuvenating the SDGs in Africa through impactful PCSR

elaborate in the rest of this section. In the following, we elaborate how the three criteria for good thick description (mentioned in Sect. 3) have been fulfilled by rejuvenating the SDGs in Africa through Impactful PCSR model.

5.1

The Context of PCSR for Development in Africa

Political CSR is the main phenomenon within our model shown in Fig. 1. This phenomenon is contextualised by two key intervening factors which act as barriers for international businesses to play their political role (Scherer, 2018). The first barrier is “the business case” thinking which is evident in African business environment (Adelopo et al., 2015; Sorour et al. 2021a). Here, companies might engage with CSR expressions to achieve pragmatic legitimacy through calculated gains whether to further its reputation as a public relation exercise (Michelon et al., 2015; Soobaroyen & Mahadeo, 2016, Sorour et al., 2021b) or in the form of rent seeking from immediate salient stakeholders (Brammer et al. 2012; Adelopo et al., 2015). Having said that, the reality might be slightly more complicated as engagement with PCSR for development can be seen as a continuum, with some companies engage with CSR expressions for their immediate benefit, few others consider themselves as a “true development agents” and many other lies in-between over this continuum (Jamali et al., 2017, p. 3). The reason for this behaviour can be understood in relation to institutional pressures that these companies are facing and how this affects their legitimacy (Crowther & Rayman-Bacchus, 2004) which takes us to the second barrier, the institutional voids. As mentioned earlier, institutional voids are a main hindrance of African development and cause of suffering faced by both individuals and businesses operating

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach

27

therein (Chakrabarty & Bass, 2013; Mair & Marti, 2009). Essentially, institutional voids create a “responsibility-free space” for businesses, thus further complicating their motivation to adopt CSR activities (Jamali & Karam, 2016). Institutions are what “provide stability and meaning to social life” (Scott, 2001, pp. 48–49). As such, when these institutions and in particular the regulative and normative institutional pillars do not exist, every company is left to make their own choices. In such case, the likelihood that companies favour self-interest and utilise CSR to further their competitive position is high (Sorour et al., 2021a). The counterargument here is that in developing countries, societal norms and cultural influences may motivate businesses to actively engage in addressing these voids, thereby furthering their value creation objectives and legitimacy (Lam et al., 2017; Mair et al., 2007; Mair and Marti, 2009). However, because of the risk that businesses address such voids on an ad hoc basis, institutions remain a key element for sustaining businesses’ contribution to the development agenda. A recent review of CSR literature in Africa, supports this limitation, as it shows that MNCs take advantage of weak institutions to focus on philanthropic CSR activities instead of contributing to sustainable development; simply due to weak bargaining powers of stakeholders and absence of threats to their legitimacy (Ahen & Amankwah-Amoah, 2018). In terms of the context of political CSR, there are two further factors which act as drivers, i.e., work in the opposite direction of the two barriers identified (business case logic and institutional voids). These are the emerging institutional pillars introduced to support the SDGs in Africa and namely the regulatory and normative pillars (Scott, 2014). The importance of institutions has been well recognised by the latest Africa SDG report (2022) which stressed that “there is an acute need to strengthen institutional capacities” (p. viii). Developing institutions has also been identified as a top priority to enable the realisation of the SDGs in Africa (ASDGR, 2022). In terms of regulative pillar, it is based on expedience and instrumentality logics, facilitated by coercion through rules, laws, and sanctions (Scott 2001, 2014). This is not really what PCSR seeks to promote and, Scherer & Palazzo (2011) highlighted that when CSR becomes “rules-driven” through government regulation and hard rules, this can only instigate more instrumental CSR. This is also influenced by the prevailing corporate governance model and whether it is shareholders or stakeholders orientated (Sorour & Howell, 2012; Amodu, 2020; Scherer & Palazzo, 2011). Even changes in favour of stakeholder protection in national legislation eventually can end as ineffective, one example here is Nigeria’s updated corporate legislative framework, the Companies and Allied Matters Act, 2020 (CAMA, 2020) is deemed to have minimal substantive stakeholder protection (Amodu, 2020). So, it is worth noting here that whilst the regulatory pillar is an important institution that could fuel PCSR, a major caveat is its promotion of an instrumental CSR logic that focus on ticking the box, instead of supporting the development cause. As such, the second driver, the normative institution, plays a pivotal role to instigate genuine commitment by international businesses to play their political role effectively. A relevant example is Egypt, where whilst the Egyptian banks have faced a combination of regulatory and normative institutional pressures to report on their CSR activities, improved CSR engagement and

28

M. K. Sorour and A. El-Sakhawy

disclosures were driven by moral obligation and businesses sensing that they should align more with social expectations (Sorour et al., 2021a).

5.2

Dynamic Nature of PCSR for Development: The Role of Institutions and Moral Legitimacy

In relation to Denzin’s (1989) second criteria, and as mentioned earlier, institutions are what “provide stability and meaning to social life” (Scott, 2001, pp. 48–49), in addition to the regulative and normative institutions, public governance is a critical institution at the macro level which affects the quality of corporate governance system within any country (Sorour, 2011) and consequently its CSR. As ineffective regulatory framework can not enforce corporate governance rules and establish accountability (Kimani et al., 2021). It goes without saying that promotion of good governance and transparency are the foundations for establishing accountable political leadership (UNECA, 2015). This was also recognised in the Busan Partnership agreement (ibid.). Yet, in the latest Africa SDG report (2022), “creating the enabling governance, legal, and judicial frameworks for enhanced accountability, transparency and participation” was still a key area for improvement (p. XXII). Notably, governance not only has to be transparent for PCSR to operate and flourish, but it also has to be inclusive (Scherer & Palazzo, 2011). This means that governance moves from a highly single player, i.e. the state (ibid.) to a more of role sharing setting between the state, civil society, and businesses (Raimi et al., 2015). Here, the role of normative institutional pressures should not be overlooked, as it enables a participatory governance model that facilitates the co-creation of a common understanding of the role that each party plays to foster long-term growth and development focused partnerships (Scherer & Palazzo, 2011). This also establishes clear moral legitimacy expectations for international businesses to meet. An example for these partnerships is the creation of national-level government bodies to oversee and orchestrate these partnerships. Of note, that countries such as Egypt have implemented this idea by creating the National Institute for Governance and Sustainable Development (NIGSD). This “is a public economic organization, with advisory, training and research identity. . . its vision . . . to serve Egypt’s Vision 2030 and to promote the concepts of governance and good governance . . . to facilitate procedures and develop rules for dealing with State institutions and bodies and to coordinate the relevant bodies at both the central and local levels, in accordance with the standards of good governance. The Institute will monitor and follow up Egypt national and international classification in Governance, Competitiveness and Sustainable Development. The Institute will be responsible for setting national strategy and action plan in coordination with different GOE agencies” (NIGSD, 2023) [online]. Within NIGSD, there is a specialist sustainable development unit which aims to “Monitor progress in the implementation of the Sustainable Development Goals; Raising awareness of the concept and importance of

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach

29

sustainable development and clarifying its relationship to governance; Fostering partnerships between all sectors (government, private, civil society) to achieve the Sustainable Development Goals” (ibid.). Moreover, this institute has offered women leadership programmes in 2022 for 58 African woman from 20 African countries in 2022; delivered the Governance and Sustainable development course to its third cohort, initiated Egypt Impact Lab (JPAL) to measure impact and combat poverty and organised more than 14 workshop to raise awareness about governance with participation of 1100 participants from governmental, civil society organisations, private sector. Similarly, trained more than 815 trainees on sustainable development and Egypt’s Vision 2030 (ibid.). This is a remarkable example for the government’s systematic interaction with various stakeholders and building a growing normative expectation that everyone should participate in achieving the SDGs. Finally, it is worthwhile to mention that international businesses are not a passive receiver here in this model, they are actually a key player in the global governance setting (Scherer & Palazzo, 2011) and sometimes act as governments (Lind et al., 2022). Given the nature of international businesses and the fact they operate within their global CSR policies , a transnational CSR approach would strike a balance between complaince with global policies and responsivness to local developmental needs (Filatotchev & Stahl, 2015). Rejuvenating the SDGs in Africa model is not meant to be a static depiction or a snapshot, but as it links processes (contextual factors, institutional voids, businesses case logic) with actions/interactions of the state, international business, and UN agenda 2030 it is continuously evolving. This dynamic nature is captured in the model through the actions shown on the arrows as well as in the circular motion of feedback between different entities. This keeps this model in a state of flux. This state of flux gains momentum from actions and interactions of the key players, namely: international businesses, governments, and the United Nations. Meanwhile, institutional voids and the business case CSR logic create a space where international businesses can act irresponsibily. This is counter-acted by institutional pressures from policy makers in the form of the introduction of new governance and accountability frameworks, as well as emerging norms introduced by SDGs awareness raising and education. This in turn upgrades the legitimacy expectations to include moral legitimacy and not pragmatic legitimacy only, as such driving international business to engage more meaningfully with a PCSR practice, which if aligned with the SDG vision 2030 of the host country, could lead to impactful CSR expressions. As such, key to the success of this model is the interaction between various entities as they co-create the CSR reality and agree legitimate business practices that could meaningfully contribute to the creation of developmental space in which a transitional CSR approach contributes to the sustainable development agenda. This state of flux could be maintained till the fully institutionalisation of the PCSR practice in a given context.

30

M. K. Sorour and A. El-Sakhawy

6 Conclusion and Agenda for Future Research The chapter has attempted to answer the question of: How the constructs of SDGs and PCSR for development can be conceptualised in relation to the African context to maximise the impact of international businesses in society? In doing so, the chapter has formulated rejuvenating the SDGs in Africa through impactful PCSR model. This model is underpinned by the PCSR, neo-institutional theory, and notions of pragmatic and moral legitimacy. The model offers a careful integration of these theoretical constructs that can guide impactful CSR realisation in the African continent. The model was developed using thick descriptionas an effective tool of performative rethinking of the concepts in question. The model links the contextual realities prevailing in Africa, including the business case logic and institutional voids, which creates a responsibility free space, where the logic of self-serving instrumentality rules, making CSR expressions akin to a public relation exercise unlinked to the developmental needs. However, these intervening factors are counterbalanced by an emerging normative narrative, propagated by the normative pressures created by actions/interactions of the African governments’ commitment to the UN 2030 agenda and international businesses’ transnational PCSR approach. This model is further facilitated by changing governance mode which has moved from a local governance system, where the government is the sole player to a global governance model which is participatory in nature. This setting creates an increasing awareness raising opportunities where international businesses along with national development focused organisations can foster a wider culture of sustainable development. The model is evolving in nature and there is a feedback loop between these constituents. The model offers a realistic, theoretically dense conceptualisation which contributes to the CSR for development literature and can assist policy makers and practitioners in formulating effective strategies that can nurture progress with SDGs and other African developmental agendas. Finally, this model can also underpin knowledge exchange endeavours between academia and practice. Future research work could include testing this model against empirical data in Africa whether qualitatively or quantitatively. Whilst the model by no means supports a one-size-fits-all approach, it aims for transferability and further refinement when tested empirically in different contexts.

References Acosta, P., & Pérezts, M. (2019). Unearthing sedimentation dynamics in political CSR: The case of Colombia. Journal of Business Ethics, 155, 425–444. Adelopo, I., Yekini, K., & Raimi, L. (2015). Political corporate social responsibility and development. In D. Jamali, C. Karam, & M. Blowfield (Eds.), Development-oriented corporate social responsibility (pp. 29–49). Greenleaf Publishing. Ahen, F., & Amankwah-Amoah, J. (2018). Institutional voids and the philanthropization of CSR practices: Insights from developing economies. Sustainability, 10(7), 2400–2427.

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach

31

Aldrich, H. E., & Fiol, C. M. (1994). Fools rush in? The institutional context of industry creation. Academy of Management Review, 19, 645–670. Amaeshi, K., Adegbite, E., & Rajwani, T. (2016). Corporate social responsibility in challenging and non-enabling institutional contexts: Do institutional voids matter? Journal of Business Ethics, 134, 135–153. Amodu, N. (2020). Stakeholder protection and corporate social responsibility from a comparative company law perspective: Nigeria and South Africa. Journal of African Law, 64(3), 425–449. ASDGR. (2022). Africa sustainable development report building back better from the coronavirus disease, while advancing the full implementation of the 2030 Agenda for Sustainable Development. Bardal, K. G., Reinar, M. B., Lundberg, A. K., & Bjørkan, M. (2021). Factors facilitating the implementation of the sustainable development goals in regional and local planning – experiences from Norway. Sustainability, 13(8), 4282–4301. Bartley, T. (2007). Institutional emergence in an era of globalization: The rise of transnational private regulation of labor and environmental conditions. American Journal of Sociology, 113(2), 297–351. Blowfield, M., & Doian, C. S. (2014). Business as a development agent: Evidence of possibility and improbability. Third World Quarterly, 35(1), 22–42. Blowfield, M., & Frynas, J. G. (2005). Editorial Setting new agendas: Critical perspectives on Corporate Social Responsibility in the developing world. International Affairs, 81(3), 499–513. Boddewyn, J., & Doh, J. (2011). Global strategy and the collaboration of MNEs, NGOs, and governments for the provisioning of collective goods in emerging markets. Global Strategy Journal, 1(3–4), 345–361. Brammer, S., Jackson, G., & Matten, D. (2012). Corporate social responsibility and institutional theory: New perspectives on private governance. Socio-Economic Review, 10(1), 3–28. CAMA. (2020). Companies and allied matters act. Camilleri, M. A. (2016). Reconceiving corporate social responsibility for business and educational outcomes. Cogent Business and Management, 3(1), 1–25. Chakrabarty, S. (2009). The influence of national culture and institutional voids on family ownership of large firms: A country level empirical study. Journal of International Management, 15(1), 32–45. Chakrabarty, S., & Bass, A. E. (2013). Encouraging entrepreneurship: Microfinance, knowledge support, and the costs of operating in institutional voids. Thunderbird International Business Review, 55(5), 545–562. Crowther, D., & Rayman-Bacchus, L. (Eds.). (2004). Perspectives on corporate social responsibility. Gower Publishing, Ltd. Den Hond, F., Rehbein, K. A., de Bakker, F. G., & Lankveld, H. K. V. (2014). Playing on two chessboards: Reputation effects between corporate social responsibility (CSR) and corporate political activity (CPA). Journal of Management Studies, 51(5), 790–813. Denzin, N. K. (1989). Interpretive interactionism. Sage. DiMaggio, P. J., & Powell, W. W. (1983). The iron cage revisited: Institutional isomorphism and collective rationality in organizational fields. American Sociological Review, 48(2), 147–160. El Alfy, A., Palaschuk, N., El-Bassiouny, D., Wilson, J., & Weber, O. (2020). Scoping the evolution of corporate social responsibility (CSR) research in the sustainable development goals (SDGs) era. Sustainability, 12(14), 1–21. Filatotchev, I., & Stahl, G. K. (2015). Towards transnational CSR. Corporate social responsibility approaches and governance solutions for multinational corporations. Organizational Dynamics, 44(2), 121–129. Flick, U. (2018). Designing qualitative research. Sage. Gibson-Graham, J. K. (2014). Rethinking the economy with thick description and weak theory. Current Anthropology, 55(9), 147–153. Hall, P. A., & Taylor, R. C. (1996). Political science and the three new institutionalisms. Political Studies, 44(5), 936–957.

32

M. K. Sorour and A. El-Sakhawy

Harris, J. M. (2009). Basic principles of sustainable development. In K. S. Bawa & R. Seidler (Eds.), Dimensions of sustainable development (pp. 21–40). Eolss Publishers. Huber, K., & Gilbert, D. U. (2017). Political CSR and social development: Lessons from the Bangladesh garment industry. In Development-oriented corporate social responsibility (pp. 228–246). Routledge. Jaakkola, E. (2020). Designing conceptual articles: Four approaches. AMS review, 10(1–2), 18–26. Jamali, D., & Karam, C. (2016). CSR in developed versus developing countries: A comparative glimpse. In Research handbook on corporate social responsibility in context (pp. 89–110). Edward Elgar Publishing. Jamali, D., & Neville, B. (2011). Convergence versus divergence of CSR in developing countries: An embedded multi-layered institutional lens. Journal of Business Ethics, 102, 599–621. Jamali, D., Karam, C., & Blowfield, M. (2015). Development-oriented corporate social responsibility: Volume. Greenleaf Publishing. Jamali, D., Karam, C., & Blowfield, M. (Eds.). (2017). Development-oriented corporate social responsibility: Volume 2: Locally led initiatives in developing economies. Routledge. Jamali, D., Leigh, J., Samara, G., & Barkemeyer, R. (2021). Grand challenges in developing countries: Context, relationships, and logics. Business Ethics, the Environment and Responsibility, 30, 1–4. Jo, M. H., Dongsung, C., & Boyoung, K. (2018). Creating shared value based on relational benefits: A case of Korean CJ Group’s Project in Vietnam. International Journal of Management Cases, 20(2), 1–23. Khanna, T., & Palepu, K. G. (2010). Winning in emerging markets: A road map for strategy and execution. Harvard Business Press. Kimani, D., Ullah, S., Kodwani, D., & Akhtar, P. (2021). Analysing corporate governance and accountability practices from an African neo-patrimonialism perspective: Insights from Kenya. Critical Perspectives on Accounting, 78, 1–19. Kulkarni, V., & Aggarwal, A. (2022). A theoretical review of whether corporate social responsibility (CSR) complement sustainable development goals (SDGs) needs. Theoretical Economics Letters, 12(2), 575–600. Lam, S., Zhang, W., & Chien, C. Y. K. (2017) Can Corporate Social Responsibility Fill Institutional Voids? Asia Centre for Social Entrepreneurship and Philanthropy Basic Research Working Paper No. 6. Li, T., & Belal, A. (2018, June). Authoritarian state, global expansion and corporate social responsibility reporting: The narrative of a Chinese state-owned enterprise. Accounting Forum, 42(2), 199–217. Lind, C. H., Kang, O., Ljung, A., & Rosenbaum, P. (2022). Involvement of multinational corporations in social innovation: Exploring an emerging phenomenon. Journal of Business Research, 151, 207–221. Luyckx, J., & Janssens, M. (2016). Discursive legitimation of a contested actor over time: The multinational corporation as a historical case (1964–2012). Organization Studies, 37(11), 1595–1619. Maier, A. L. (2021). Political corporate social responsibility in authoritarian contexts. Journal of International Business Policy, 4, 476–495. Mair, J., & Marti, I. (2009). Entrepreneurship in and around institutional voids: A case study from Bangladesh. Journal of Business Venturing, 24(5), 419–435. Mair, J., Martí, I., & Ganly, K. (2007). Institutional voids as spaces of opportunity (No. hal-02311879). Mangena, M., Sorour, K., & Mathuva, D. M. (2023). Introduction to special issue on corporate governance and sustainable development goals in Africa. Corporate Governance: The International Journal of Business in Society, 23(2), 289–297. Marquis, C., Toffel, M. W., & Zhou, Y. (2016). Scrutiny, norms, and selective disclosure: A global study of greenwashing. Organization Science, 27(2), 483–504.

Realisation of SDGs in Africa: An Impactful Political CSR Approach

33

Martines-Alier, J. (2012). Environmental justice and economic degrowth: an alliance between two movements. Capitalism Nature Socialism, 23(1), 51–73. Matten, D., & Moon, J. (2008). “Implicit” and “explicit” CSR: A conceptual framework for a comparative understanding of corporate social responsibility. Academy of Management Review, 33(2), 404–424. Michelon, G., Pilonato, S., & Ricceri, F. (2015). CSR reporting practices and the quality of disclosure: An empirical analysis. Critical Perspectives on Accounting, 33, 59–78. Mirvis, P., & Googins, B. (2018). Engaging employees as social innovators. California Management Review, 60(4), 25–50. Mitra, N., & Chatterjee, B. (2019). India’s Contribution to the Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs) with respect to the CSR mandate in the Companies Act, 2013. In The Future of the UN Sustainable Development Goals: Business Perspectives for Global Development in 2030 (pp. 383–396). Springer International Publishing. Muniz, R., & Cruz, M. J. (2015). Making nature valuable, not profitable: Are payments for ecosystem services suitable for degrowth? Sustainability, 7(8), 10895–10921. Muthuri, J. N., & Gilbert, V. (2011). An institutional analysis of corporate social responsibility in Kenya. Journal of Business Ethics, 98, 467–483. NIGSD. (2023). http://nigsd.gov.eg/ Nwozor, A., Okidu, O., & Adedire, S. (2021). Agenda 2063 and the feasibility of sustainable development in Africa: Any silver bullet? Journal of Black Studies, 52(7), 688–715. Odusola, A. (2017). Fiscal space, poverty and inequality in Africa. African Development Review, 29(S1), 1–14. Onsongo, E. (2019). Institutional entrepreneurship and social innovation at the base of the pyramid: The case of M-Pesa in Kenya. Industry and Innovation, 26(4), 369–390. Parsons, T. (1960). Structure and process in modern societies. Free Press. Ponterotto, J. G. (2006). Brief note on the origins, evolution, and meaning of the qualitative research concept thick description. The Qualitative Report, 11(3), 538–549. Raimi, L., Akhuemonkhan, I., & Ogunjirin, O. D. (2015). Corporate Social Responsibility and Entrepreneurship (CSRE): Antidotes to poverty, insecurity and underdevelopment in Nigeria. Social Responsibility Journal, 11(1), 56–81. Rendtorff, J. D. (2019). Philosophy of management and sustainability: Rethinking business ethics and social responsibility in sustainable development. Emerald Group Publishing. Scherer, A. G. (2018). Theory assessment and agenda setting in political CSR: A critical theory perspective. International Journal of Management Reviews, 20(2), 387–410. Scherer, A. G., & Palazzo, G. (2011). The new political role of business in a globalized world: A review of a new perspective on CSR and its implications for the firm, governance, and democracy. Journal of Management Studies, 48(4), 899–931. Scherer, A. G., Rasche, A., Palazzo, G., & Spicer, A. (2016). Managing for political corporate social responsibility: New challenges and directions for PCSR 2.0. Journal of Management Studies, 53(3), 273–298. Scott, W. (2001). Institutions and organizations. Sage. Scott, W. R. (2008). Approaching adulthood: the maturing of institutional theory. Theory and Society, 37, 427–442. Scott, W. R. (2014). Institutions and organizations: Ideas, interests, and identities. Sage. Selsky, J. W., & Parker, B. (2010). Platforms for cross-sector social partnerships: Prospective sensemaking devices for social benefit. Journal of Business Ethics, 94, 21–37. Slager, R., Gond, J. P., & Moon, J. (2012). Standardization as institutional work: The regulatory power of a responsible investment standard. Organization Studies, 33(5–6), 763–790. Soobaroyen, T., & Mahadeo, J. D. (2016). Community disclosures in a developing country: insights from a neo-pluralist perspective. Accounting, Auditing and Accountability Journal. Soobaroyen, T., & Ntim, C. G. (2013, June). Social and environmental accounting as symbolic and substantive means of legitimation: The case of HIV/AIDS reporting in South Africa. Accounting Forum, 37(2), 92–109.

34

M. K. Sorour and A. El-Sakhawy

Sorour, M. K. (2011). An exploration and analysis of the evolving bank corporate governance practices in Egypt: A grounded theory approach. Sorour, K., & Howell, K. (2012). Corporate governance, substantive theory and sociological institutionalism: the case of the Egyptian banking sector. Corporate Ownership and Control, 10(1), 647–658. Sorour, M. K., Shrives, P. J., El-Sakhawy, A. A., & Soobaroyen, T. (2021a). Exploring the evolving motives underlying corporate social responsibility (CSR) disclosures in developing countries: The case of “political CSR” reporting. Accounting, Auditing and Accountability Journal, 34(5), 1051–1079. Sorour, M. K., Boadu, M., & Soobaroyen, T. (2021b). The role of corporate social responsibility in organisational identity communication, co-creation and orientation. Journal of Business Ethics, 173, 89–108. Strauss, A., & Corbin, J. (1992). Basics of qualitative research techniques and procedures for developing grounded theory. Sage. Suchman, M. C. (1995). Managing legitimacy: Strategic and institutional approaches. Academy of Management Review, 20(3), 571–610. UNCTAD. (2021). Economic Development in Africa Report 2021: Reaping the potential benefits of the African Continental Free Trade Area for inclusive growth. https://unctad.org/press-material/ facts-and-figures-7 UNDP. (2022). The impact of the war in Ukraine on sustainable development in Africa. UNECA. (2015). Africa Regional Report on the Sustainable Development Goals. WCED, S. W. S. (1987). World commission on environment and development. Our common future, 17(1), 1–91. Wettstein, F., & Baur, D. (2016). “Why should we care about marriage equality?”: Political advocacy as a part of corporate responsibility. Journal of Business Ethics, 138, 199–121.

M. Karim Sorour is a Professor of Accounting and Corporate Governance and Deputy Head of the Accounting & Financial Management Department. He is an internationally recognised expert on corporate governance and CSR and his research focuses on the role of business in society with an emphasis on developing countries. Karim is currently the vice-chair of the British Accounting & Finance Association (BAFA) special interest group on Accounting & Finance in Emerging Economies (AFEE-SIG). His publications have appeared in leading academic international Journals such as the Accounting, Auditing and Accountability Journal, Journal of Business Ethics, Business & Society Journal, and Technological Forecasting and Social Change while his monographs were published by Palgrave MacMillan including a monograph on Corporate Governance in Africa. Karim has a proven track record of knowledge transfer and Research Impact having participated and led more than 30 consultancy and contract research projects. He has also worked closely with senior leaders and board members in public companies and governmental organisations to reform their CSR/Governance systems. Ahmed El-Sakhawy is a Certified Management Accountant (CMA-US) and holds a MSc in Accounting and Finance (Alexandria University-Egypt). He is currently the country manager of the Institute of Management Accountants (IMA), Egypt. Ahmed has worked more than a decade as an Economic Researcher during which he participated in more than 50 research and consultancy projects. His research interests include corporate governance, corporate social responsibility, and performance evaluation.

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development of Sustainable Foreign Trade Aldo Alvarez-Risco , Maria de las Mercedes Anderson-Seminario , Nilda Campos-Dávalos , Lucía de los Ángeles Castillo-Butrón, Berdy Briggitte Cuya-Velásquez , Shyla Del-Aguila-Arcentales , Romina Gómez-Prado , and Jorge Sánchez-Palomino

Abstract Sustainable trends are on the rise within international trade as companies create value for stakeholders based on the needs of each stakeholder but aligned to sustainable flows. Therefore, the article aims to identify the impact of the role of stakeholders in the development of sustainable foreign trade incorporating the SDGs. The article shows that the development of various sustainable strategies significantly impacts corporate reputation and provides better management in various areas of a company. At the same time, sustainability in an organization increases competitive advantage by improving global value chains and the perception of consumers and other stakeholders. Internationalization in companies is very common in today’s highly competitive and saturated markets, in addition to the fact that they must adapt to the goals of the global sustainable agenda. Therefore, companies are developing different sustainable activities that involve stakeholders, government, and organizations.

A. Alvarez-Risco Universidad Tecnológica del Perú, Lima, Peru e-mail: [email protected] M. d. l. M. Anderson-Seminario · N. Campos-Dávalos · L. d. l. Ángeles Castillo-Butrón · B. B. Cuya-Velásquez · R. Gómez-Prado · J. Sánchez-Palomino Universidad de Lima, Santiago de Surco, Peru e-mail: [email protected]; [email protected]; [email protected]; [email protected]; [email protected]; [email protected] S. Del-Aguila-Arcentales (✉) Escuela de Posgrado, Universidad San Ignacio de Loyola, La Molina,, Peru e-mail: [email protected] © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2023 P. Arte et al. (eds.), Sustainable International Business, Contributions to Management Science, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-43785-4_3

35

36

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

1 Introduction International trade is a sure path for economic growth and development (Castellano, 2006). For this, companies are performing strategies that involve stakeholders, such as providing decent jobs to local people (Frey, 2017), labor benefits (Rai et al., 2019), and products or services with quality standards (Díaz-Correa and LópezNavarro 2018, Engida et al., 2018). Strategies are applied to diverse stakeholders because stakeholders involve consumers, workers, suppliers, and communities (Clement, 2005; Silva et al., 2019). Authors Harrison et al. (2015) found that stakeholder theory helps address relevant aspects of international business. Companies are incorporating objectives in the field of social responsibility and care for natural resources demonstrating a high level of commitment to sustainability and to different stakeholders to obtain economic profitability (Pérez-Espinoza et al., 2016; Polanco et al., 2016; Stubbs, 2017). In other words, the dimensions of the development objective are included in the trade of goods and services by strengthening the multilateral trading system (Jindřichovská et al., 2020). In this sense, a strong relationship between companies and their stakeholders is vital for the success of a company since it allows for responding appropriately to the competitiveness of the international market, in addition to building a sustainable corporate identity (Darskuviene & Bendoraitiene, 2013; Dentoni et al., 2016; Tregidga et al., 2018). International trade needs to be consistent with the SDGs through the investments made in each country and the solutions implemented in companies of all sizes. Proper management of these investments and solutions enables poverty reduction, clean environments for society, and opportunities for economic growth (Hidalgo, 2018). Companies’ value creation is aligned with stakeholders’ needs, which leads to commercial sustainability that excludes less sustainable social and labor activities (Husted et al., 2015; Del Campo et al., 2020).

2 Origin and Definition Business models have undergone many changes in recent years due to new market demands. Parliamentarians around the world have been promoting a sustainable agenda with different objectives, such as the adherence to Corporate Social Responsibility (CSR) policies, a reinvention of a linear to circular economy, a greater acceptance by stakeholders, among others (Halkos & Nomikos, 2021; Lewandowski, 2016; Witjes & Lozano, 2016). In this way, societies can adapt many of these initiatives and thus become more sustainable (Montalvo, 2008). Implementing such sustainable practices to the economic activities of a company or organization generates a joint synergy in companies. Several studies call it “shared value” (Porter & Kramer, 2011), combined value (Emerson, 2003), or new value creation (Lepak et al., 2007), a term that refers to the additional contribution or

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

37

extra economic value after assisting some socioeconomic need or challenge (Porter & Kramer, 2011; Austin & Seitanidi, 2012). The potential for value creation also lies in collaboration between organizations, as this benefits from the partners’ combined skills, resources, and knowledge (Gray & Stites, 2013; Le Pennec & Raufflet, 2018). Another perception of value creation can be seen in the differential positioning of the brand and the loyalty it can generate in customers (Smith & Colgate, 2007; Woodall, 2003). The figure that also generates value for a company is the stakeholder, a term that is highly questioned because it comprises many definitions. Both Gallie (1955) and Miles (2012) argue that there is no consensus on its definition for theoretical and empirical analysis. Stakeholders can be shareholders, beneficiaries, suppliers, recipients, participants, and many other roles as these agents are involved or benefit from a company’s work. In addition, it can offer benefits, capital, positioning, cooperation, or any other added value for the company itself (Miles, 2017). Inclusively, stakeholders can also be governments, competitors, and advocates (Fassin, 2009). This concept comes from the business science literature by philosopher Robert Edward Freeman (1984), where he explains the stakeholder theory as any person, group, or individual that may be affected or benefit from the execution of a project. Likewise, Freeman argues that such stakeholders should prioritize the maximization of capital and be concerned about the interests of the other stakeholders in corporate decision-making (Mainardes et al. 2011; McGrath & Whitty 2017). Another turning point in today’s business models is their impetus to internationalization. Many markets today are saturated by over-demand or price fights, so many brands decide to migrate to other more competitive or higher value-added markets. Therefore, foreign trade is a way to diversify risk and improve economic activity (Perée & Steinherr, 1989). According to Heckscher–Ohlin and their trade theory, developing countries must specialize in productive factors such as labor or natural resources, while developed countries focus on human and manufactured capital in a free trade market (Halicioglu, 2009). In this way, each region is a specialist in what it abounds with and allows a better commercial fluidity. On the other hand, foreign trade also has certain disadvantages. Global market uncertainty and exchange rate variability often discourage terms of trade and consequently reduce trade volume (Perée & Steinherr, 1989). This sustainable movement also involves foreign trade, which must adapt to new technologies, sustainable innovations, social value creation, and integration of social, commercial, and environmental work (Boons & Lüdeke-Freund, 2013; Schaltegger et al., 2012). For this, it is essential that the business operates according to sustainable principles and standards and thus achieves a better sustainable performance in the company (Schaltegger & Wagner, 2011). The classic linear economic model represents a threat to sustainable goals; consequently, it is being displaced by the Circular Economy (CE) model, which seeks to be a regenerative economy from its inception (Ellen MacArthur Foundation, 2013). Its objectives are to mitigate environmental damage and economic savings and generate greater

38

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

awareness and environmental and sustainable values (Lewandowski, 2016). As a result, many practices within foreign trade are being reoriented toward sustainability.

3 Importance of Sustainability in International Trade International trade has demonstrated its important role in promoting sustainable development in today’s globalized world, contributing at different levels to the fulfillment of the SDGs within the framework of the 2030 Agenda, which has been demonstrated in the growth and development achieved by the economies of the world offering new opportunities for business growth, as well as the decrease in poverty levels and therefore, the increase in the welfare of the population (Organización Mundial del Comercio, 2018). Trade influences higher income generation in a country and more excellent employment opportunities. International trade exchange allows access to new technologies and foreign investments, the generation of global value chains, integration of developed and developing economies, creation of a broader portfolio of products in the market, and offering consumers different price and quality options to satisfy their needs. International trade has become a proactive instrument allowing the attraction of investments for development in infrastructure, education, public health, productive capacity, increased exports, and promotion of sustainable investments (Organización Mundial del Comercio, 2018). Additionally, trade openness allows countries to make efficient use of resources, given the specialized development of goods and services in which there are more significant comparative advantages and allow the generation of economies of scale and, therefore, the development of more competitive products. In turn, specialization in production and exports in natural resource sectors can generate a certain degree of vulnerability to price fluctuations in the international market and also negative impacts on the environment, as evidenced in the results of greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, among other adverse effects, so that the strategies applied to mitigate the negative effects vary in each country (Frohmann et al., 2020). Although international trade offers various important benefits for the economy’s growth in a country, it also generates specific cross-cutting effects in other areas, given the concatenation of the different sectors (Organización Mundial del Comercio, 2018). For this reason, specific instruments, such as trade policies and development plans, must maintain a coherent integration among themselves and all stakeholders for the proper sustainable development of an economy. Multiple actors are involved in developing instruments that promote sustainable development in the commercial world, including the government, private companies, academia, and society (Frohmann et al., 2020). The impact generated by international trade is subject to trade, macroeconomic (fiscal and monetary) and macroeconomic (industrial, innovation, and education) policies, which make it possible to regulate various aspects that influence to mitigate the negative impacts and enhance the positive effects of trade on sustainable

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

39

development. Likewise, the countries generate an additional link through multiple bilateral and multilateral agreements, which address trade facilitation issues between the parties and regulatory aspects related to labor, environmental, public health, and cooperation, among others. All this affects each country differently since each party has its legislation and international agreements (Frohmann et al., 2020). Some argue that trade and sustainability contradict each other, given that the excessive use of resources and increasing scarcity are at the root of questions about the impact it generates. However, other authors argue for the ability to create trade based on economic, social, and environmental dimensions, i.e. a company can create synergies between environmental and social problem-solving according to the core business. Nowadays, the ecological field has taken great relevance, and therefore more and more companies are implementing strategies based on sustainable development that benefit not only the company but also all stakeholders (Schaltegger et al., 2019). In this sense, trade generates ample opportunities for economic and social growth and supports the creation of national, regional, sectoral, and international sustainable development policies (Organización Mundial del Comercio, 2018). As a critical element for socioeconomic development, trade requires action and high efforts from all stakeholders, including the public and private sectors. Likewise, the basis of the scope and achievements reached must be evidenced; the ability to measure results and statistics is critical to achieving a correct improvement process in all dimensions. It is worth highlighting that given the constant world evolution and globalization, the generation of partnerships between countries has become an important means for the combination of efforts for the achievement of the objectives of each country (Organización Mundial del Comercio, 2018). According to Organización Mundial del Comercio (2018), to achieve expediting the positive impact of international trade on the fulfillment of the SDGs is the act of mainstreaming trade within national general and sectoral strategies, strengthening the multilateral system, reducing costs through the WTO trade facilitation agreement, the creation of trade infrastructure in developing countries, greater focus on export product diversification through value-added creation, enhancing and boosting the services sector to a greater extent, making e-commerce a tool for inclusion, and generating more significant efforts for the internationalization of MSMEs. Businesses have great power in the world’s economies and society, so their proactive participation in sustainable development is critical to achieving positive results and sustainable economic, social, and environmental benefits. A sustainable company is a small, medium, or large business that contributes to development by providing sustainable benefits comprehensively and simultaneously in all three dimensions, which also includes good corporate governance and value creation for all stakeholders, adopting strategies and a holistic, long-term vision and integrating sustainable systems based on ethical principles into its processes and operations (Hart & Milstein, 2003; American Management Association, 2007; Tafra-Vlahović, 2016). At the beginning of the history of the business world, the traditional thinking and priority focus were on the benefits provided to shareholders (Friedman, 1970).

40

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

However, the approach of business people evolved, and they broadened their vision by recognizing the value of each of the company’s stakeholders (Freeman, 1984, 1999). The success of a company in a competitive international market depends not only on the value returned to shareholders but also on the correct outcome of the value chain, from suppliers delivering the proper orders at the right time at the right price, employees willing to work and motivated, the company making efficient use of resources, customers willing to buy its products, the company generating revenue, shareholders willing to contribute capital to the company and generating a positive impact on society (Karlsson et al., 2018). In this context, the fundamental objective of a sustainable business is to create value for all stakeholders (Freeman, 1984), which is why it is essential to know how stakeholders think to generate adequate and comprehensive strategies that allow satisfying the expectations of each stakeholder (Schaltegger et al., 2019). Furthermore, integrating the environmental and social aspects in decision-making for economic and social development in the public and private sectors is essential to achieve sustainable development (WCED, 1987). According to Preghenella and Battistella (2021), the three essential characteristics of a sustainable business model are based on (1) a long-term business vision; (2) the integration of sustainable value generated and captured at the economic, social, and environmental levels; and (3) the interaction and integration of all stakeholders (Hörisch et al., 2014). In a business, the value stream initiates with value intention (Barth et al., 2017), value proposition, value creation, value delivery, and value capture (Bocken et al., 2014; Short et al., 2014).

4 Strategies for Value Creation It is important to consider the corporate reputation strategy as a value creation form within marketing strategies. One of the terms associated with value is reputation (Dolphin, 2004). The evidence that many organizations are concerned about their reputation is increasing (Goldsmith et al., 2000), especially its effect on market behavior (Cornelissen and Thorpe, 2002). This is based on understanding the signals that customers consider important as values of a company. In this sense, managers should initiate activities aimed at improving the perception of the organization by customers and interested groups (Caruana, 1997). For example, in the Coca-Cola company, it demonstrated strategic leadership by expanding internationally, since this was thanks to the improvement of the organization’s global reputation (Petrick, 1999). On the other hand, there are strategic alliances for creating value. The companies associated with this management redesign and update their systems to align them with the improved business strategy for value creation (Petrick, 1999). The development and alignment of these electronic systems with strategic alliances can help to understand what the information requirements are and how dependent the partners

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

41

are on each other; however, it should be emphasized that initiatives to develop organizational knowledge are of little value if they are not explicitly linked to the overall business strategy aimed at value creation. In the same way, the strategic process must demonstrate the continuous learning capacities of the organization strengthened by strategic alliances directed to more sustainable management (Hackney et al., 2004). A company that carries out a strategic plan without understanding the impact on the ecosystem ignores the reality of the environment in which it operates (Iansiti & Levien, 2004). It must be understood that non-commercial social activities are different from commercial ones. The potential for value creation through non-commercial social actions increases when competing with companies that do not consider corporate social responsibility a competitive advantage (Husted, 2015). It is worth mentioning that this social aspect also demands the company’s behavior since it must provide attributes of the product or service that create value and a social good (Husted, 2015). In other words, focusing on such social responsibility opens a competitive space in which there are new opportunities but additional demands to satisfy.

5 Impact of Value Creation Strategy on International Trade The impact of the generation of value is directed to the competitive advantages that they bring to a company, especially if it is involved in global trade (Grahovac & Miller, 2009), which occurs if the company’s resources generate a margin between the variable cost and the customer’s willingness to pay greater than its competitors’ margins (Adner & Zemsky, 2006). The effect on a company’s performance has also been verified, considering that they pay in the factor markets, as well as what they later appropriate in the product market. This performance evolves when a company acquires a resource at a justified cost; in this sense, the company appropriates based on that resource (Grahovac & Miller, 2009). The findings provided a new perspective on creating value in business-to-business relationships, especially from suppliers to customers (Ryssel et al., 2004). Value creation greatly influences relationship management, sustainable management, and intra- and inter-organizational information technology (Baldwin & Evenett, 2014). These have different effects on the atmosphere of the relationship and its value creation. This value creation has also affected the field of accounting in trade companies since these when addressing social, environmental, and sustainability reports encounter challenging problems that are predicated as an extension of the financial information model and as a potential source of “value creation” (Tinker et al., 1991; Neu et al., 1998; Owen et al., 2000; Gray, 2006). Likewise, this area questions how said reports contribute to “creating shareholder value” and whether this action is

42

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

feasible and desirable. It is worth mentioning that these reports usually have quite the opposite relationship with the standard assumptions of companies as “value-creating entities” (Gray, 2006). The impact, in general, resides in the fact that the multiple interested parties, who are the focus of value creation, provide resources, have influence in the business industry, benefit from it and, therefore, are the cause of changes in efficiency and impact, to company profits (Donaldson & Preston, 1995). In this sense, it is concluded that the collective efforts of these parties are at the center of value creation (Haslam et al., 2015). Therefore, the culmination of this support by the interested parties could put the company’s life at risk (Freeman, 2010). It should be noted that corporations are built based on clear objectives that form the ground for stakeholders to cooperate and establish relationships with them (Freudenreich et al., 2020). Therefore, managing a business model that does not have strong relationships with both internal and external stakeholders is not possible.

6 The SDGs in International Trade The world is going through significant challenges that cross national borders and cause negative effects of great magnitude on society and the environment, which demonstrates the need to combine the collaborative efforts of stakeholders to find solutions to various issues (Wettstein et al., 2019). In this context, in 2015, through the Paris Agreement on Climate Change, 197 countries committed to making a transformative change in the search for a world with smaller social and economic differences and mitigating climate change’s effects (UN, 2015). As of 2017, these member-states approve a framework of goals and targets as global indicators to develop a more sustainable world and promote public policies and planning instruments (UN, 2018). The Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs) are the initiatives proposed by the UN to measure each individual or entity’s actions to contribute to sustainable development (Laing & Moonsammy, 2021). With 17 goals and 169 targets, the SDGs address issues such as poverty, hunger, health care, responsible consumption, and economic growth (Fuso-Nerini et al., 2019). The SDGs are shown below in Fig. 1. Fuso Nerini et al. (2018) highlight that a team is required, which comprises all the actors that play an important role in achieving sustainable development. For this, the public and private sectors must get involved and work to achieve the goals proposed by the UN (Van Zanten & Van Tulder, 2018). Likewise, it is necessary to have a more level playing field since developing countries must improve their capacities related to energy production, distribution, and consumption, among others (Fuso Nerini et al., 2018). According to a survey of CEOs in 2016, it was noted that 87% of all CEOs consider the SDGs as an opportunity to reorient approaches to sustainable value creation, while 70% consider the SDGs as a clear framework for structuring sustainability efforts, i.e. they provide a better overview of the goals to be met and how

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

43

Fig. 1 The sustainable development goals. Note. Adapted from 17 goals to transform our world, by the United Nations, 2022 (https://www.un.org/sustainabledevelopment/)

to distribute the efforts needed to achieve them (Accenture and United Nations Global Compact, 2016). For its part, the World Business Council for Sustainable Development (WBCSD) encourages companies to materialize such actions in conjunction with government policies and the strategies of non-governmental organizations (NGOs) (WBCSD, 2015; Hajer et al., 2015; UN Global Compact, 2017). It is considered essential to highlight business involvement in the path toward achieving the SDGs, which is reflected in various research that focuses on delving into actual actions that contribute to sustainable development by companies (e.g., Kolk, 2016; Kolk et al., 2017; van Tulder et al., 2014) as well as the case of Van Zanten & Van Tulder (2018) that highlights the contribution of multinational enterprises (MNEs) as indispensable for the achievement of these goals.

7 Implications of the SDGs for Sustainable International Trade in Its Three Dimensions 7.1

Economic Dimension

Pilgrim and Bohnet-Joschko (2022) classified the SDGs in the economic dimension group. This classification is shown in Fig. 2. These SDGs 8, 9, 10, 12, and 17 are present in all three dimensions simultaneously, which is explained in more detail below. About SDG 8: Decent work and economic growth, the world still faces many challenges that significantly affect job recovery and economic development.

44

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

Fig. 2 SDG that encompasses the economic dimension of sustainability. Note. Adapted from Corporate Social Responsibility on Twitter: A Review of Topics and Digital Communication Strategies’ Success Factors, by Pilgrim & Bohnet-Joschko, 2022 (https://doi.org/10.3390/ su142416769)

Although in 2021, the global economy showed some growth after the effects of COVID-19, this increase remains weak in contrast to previous years. Furthermore, such labor volatility was more noticeable in developing and developed countries, so their recovery may take longer than in other regions with lesser impacts on their economies (UN, 2023). Labor and growth are directly proportional indicators: the valorization of both is necessary to ensure sustainable development. However, the current economic model ensures that aspects such as price prevail and do not destabilize the market while labor conditions remain precarious and minimum wages remain constant. These inequalities do not encourage fair trade or create significant progress in achieving the SDGs (Franco et al., 2020). Globalization has undoubtedly allowed the acceleration of all economies; its prosperity is effective and necessary. However, it must be inclusive for all stakeholders, from governments to communities. Such a global strategy must focus primarily on those who do not have the necessary instruments to enjoy its benefits. This call for socioeconomic and sustainable responsibility makes it possible to assertively achieve the goals proposed by the United Nations (Franco et al., 2020). Responsible consumption is how society makes use of resources without going overboard. Unfortunately, this practice is rare due to low environmental awareness and a lack of recognition of the scarcity of non-renewable materials. Even before the pandemic, there were extremely high levels of material footprint, e-waste, and GHG emissions (UN, 2020). SDG 12 mentions production as an element linked to responsible consumption, so both must address the same deficiency to develop without harming the planet’s resources. Such work must address obstacles such as lack of interest in quality education, misinformation or lack of long-term vision. To

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

45

this end, Vaidya and Chatterji (2020) proposed a multidisciplinary approach that seeks to encourage diverse communities to entrepreneurship to promote different sustainable practices for the benefit of society (Franco et al., 2020). Such a multidisciplinary approach encompasses economic, social, cultural, environmental, spiritual, and other aspects. It seeks the development of an entrepreneurial capacity that contributes significantly to social sustainability, causing more agents of change and development (Franco et al., 2020). This, in order to develop this entrepreneurial capacity, calls for responsible corporate producers, who can encourage and support underdeveloped but resource-abundant cities to grow with the community’s well-being in mind.

7.2

Social Dimension

According to the Organización Mundial del Comercio (2018), incorporating the SDGs into business policies can contribute to achieving socially sustainable goals such as inclusive growth, jobs, and poverty reduction. Companies with a high public impact place greater importance on social activities within their business policies and financing structure (García-Meca et al., 2021). Many companies have transformed their ways of interacting with their stakeholders to align the objectives that benefit them (Servera-Francés et al., 2020). For a better overview of the social dimension, there are SDGs 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 7, 11, 16, and 17, a total of nine that are linked to sustainable business performance in various organizations (Pilgrim & Bohnet-Joschko, 2022). SDG 1 refers to eradicating extreme poverty where the purchasing power of each individual is $1.90 or less. SDG 4 suggests citizens receive quality and inclusive education worldwide (Sachs, 2015). SDG 5 addresses issues of gender equality and female empowerment so that women can get decent jobs (Tahir et al., 2018; Moya-Clemente et al., 2019; GünzelJensen et al., 2020). SDG 7 seeks people to access modern energy services because more than 1500 million people do not have this benefit. To do this, companies must transform their production model from a more sustainable perspective (Sachs, 2015). At the same time, companies that develop sustainable businesses, including all stakeholders, can obtain economic profitability and social welfare. Figure 3 shows the new goals of the social dimension of the SDGs.

7.3

Environmental Dimension

There is an increasingly strong trend toward the care and protection of the environment, which is reflected in consumer preferences and in the strategic plans of companies that demonstrate their responsibility toward the environment in the use of biodegradable materials, in their recycling practices, in the implementation of natural resource saving systems, among others. Pilgrim & Bohnet-Joschko’s

46

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

Fig. 3 SDG that encompasses the social dimension of sustainability. Note. Adapted from Corporate Social Responsibility on Twitter: A Review of Topics and Digital Communication Strategies’ Success Factors, by Pilgrim & Bohnet-Joschko, 2022 (https://doi.org/10.3390/su142416769)

classification (2022) states that the environmental SDGs cover SDGs 6, 13, 14, and 15, and SDG 17 interrelates all dimensions. These SDGs relate to the environmental performance of companies that adopt new environmentally friendly practices in their businesses. The previous text highlights the importance of the SDGs with an environmental focus. Figure 4 shows the SDGs belonging to the environmental dimension of sustainability. SDG 6 focuses on the excellent use of water and sanitation. The misuse of water resources causes significant problems, often found in the operations carried out by companies in different sectors (Franco et al., 2020). The mining sector comes to be the primary sector that provides the necessary supplies of essential raw materials and energy for various industries; thus, mining and related activities capture people’s attention as it is also a sector causing a tremendous negative impact on the environment (Franco et al., 2020). Some negative effects they cause are the destruction of ecosystems, GHG emission and pollution (Vintró et al., 2014; Bustamante et al., 2016). Given this reality, mining companies are under social pressure that forces them to accept significant commitments regarding responsible and sustainable management,

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

47

Fig. 4 SDG that encompasses the environmental dimension of sustainability. Note. Adapted from Corporate Social Responsibility on Twitter: A Review of Topics and Digital Communication Strategies’ Success Factors, by Pilgrim & Bohnet-Joschko, 2022 (https://doi.org/10.3390/ su142416769)

emphasizing achieving SDG 6 (Botín & Vergara, 2015; Franco et al., 2020). Therefore, this sector must achieve the goal of transforming mineral wealth into development opportunities while safeguarding the needs of future generations. To do so, they must apply new strategies focused on efficiently using resources such as water, which is used as an energy source in their operations. It is recommended that companies and their stakeholders test their impact on water resources and how this may affect the environment and surrounding communities (Franco et al., 2020). On the other hand, SDG 13 binds all governments of the world and leads them to confront and stop man-made climate change (Sachs, 2015). A growing consensus is being recognized that stakeholders from educational institutions and businesses are in favor of better introducing and guiding students throughout their academic journey until they enter the world of work, as they can then be agents of change with new ideas and strategic actions that promote the achievement of the climaterelated SDG 13 (Franco et al., 2020). Creating greater environmental awareness should start from the educational system, so curricula linked to sustainable development and good practices in international trade should be added so that future generations can put them into practice (Franco et al., 2020). Some topics have been incorporated, such as the “3Rs,” “responsible consumption,” (Mahat et al., 2016; Sidiropoulos, 2014) or “disaster risk management” more seen in business curricula (Apronti et al., 2015; Brundiers, 2018; Herrera, 2016; Naoufal, 2014). Similarly, Colliver (2017) notes that the relationship between water flow and climate has been probed by deepening questions on “cleaner production” and GHG emissions (Franco et al., 2020).

48

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

The previous text shows that international trade, which encompasses companies, governments, industries, suppliers, customers, and all interested parties, is affected by the actions of each of these stakeholders. Therefore, negative effects on the environment have an impact on society and the economy of each country. International trade is conditioned to sustainable trends and must adopt practices that ensure the protection of the environment so that it does not affect their business through their sales and net income. In this sense, the connection with the economic SDGs is demonstrated. Even with all the efforts made by the United Nations to show progress in each SDG, the involvement of many other organizations is essential to achieve significant progress. Working together is much more profitable than working unilaterally, so SDG 17 makes available the different collaborations it can receive to continue supporting the human cause (United Nations, 2020). For example, in Africa alone, conservation activities generate more than $29 billion annually, employing 3.6 million people. These funds are targeted to disadvantaged areas or people to promote their development and conservation and give them a means of income of their own (Obrecht et al., 2021).

8 Cases Applied in the Sustainable Business World The challenges are different for each business and depend on uncontrollable and controllable variables such as the micro and macroeconomic context, the industry, the sector, new consumer demands and preferences, society and communities. As an example of a company committed to the engagement of the SDGs through stakeholders interaction, there is LG Electronics [LGE], a global company founded in 1958 in Korea, which belongs to the “Computers/Consumer Electronics” industry of the technology sector, the leader in sustainability in South Korea and the world. LGE focused on transparency and innovation as the cornerstones of the company. Subsequently, it was among the world’s top 100 sustainable companies recognized by the Corporate Knights Global Index. The company is among the 100 most substantial companies in terms of corporate reputation and credibility and is included in the Dow Jones Sustainability World Index [DJSI] (Jun & Kim, 2021). LGE opted for new global operating and corporate governance systems to establish new factories on the European continent and other neighboring countries on the Asian continent. Additionally, in 2008, the company decided to take action for corporate sustainability management [CSM] by implementing new strategies based on the SDGs, creating a new vision focused on cooperation toward a better life for all and with the mission to be a market leader, provide benefits to all stakeholders and be recognized as an economically, socially, and environmentally responsible company (Jun & Kim, 2021). The company made great efforts to identify key internal and external stakeholders to establish effective communication strategies with each of them. They identified external stakeholders: (1) shareholders and investors, (2) consumers, (4) the government, (5) NGOs and civic groups, (6) communities, (7) Industry alliances include

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

49

LGE’s alliance with RBA (Responsible Business Alliance) for implementing sustainable practices, and (8) Academia through research and knowledge exchange. On the other hand, they identified internal stakeholders: (1) employees, (2) subsidiaries, and (3) affiliates of the LG group. In this sense, LGE focused on knowing the needs and interests of each of the parties and achieving participation in terms of information feedback, interacting in a provocative way in assemblies, committees, interviews, surveys, fairs, and official sustainability reports, among others (Jun & Kim, 2021). Sustainable growth and success of the company would be possible through the creation of value for stakeholders, for which it implemented 4 essential activities: (1) sustainability governance; (2) risk management; (3) stakeholder engagement; and (4) strategic social contribution (Jun & Kim, 2021). Another example is IKEA, a multinational corporation founded in 1943 in Sweden, dedicated to manufacturing and retailing household products. The company has demonstrated its commitment and value given to stakeholders, prioritizing valuing the care of people and the planet through sustainable solutions for a better daily life and affordability through the proper and innovative management of limited resources. The company is aligned with the SDGs, both the brand and the value chain, and advocates commitment and joint work with stakeholders regarding strategic alliances for strengthening and co-creation through interaction in forums, meetings, and partnerships (Sebhatu & Enquist, 2022). In its journey, the company faced different challenges to achieve its transformation and incursion into sustainable development, all this through the procurement of recycled materials, sustainable consumption, improvements in the working conditions of its collaborators within the entire value chain, actions to combat climate change, and the inclusion of vulnerable communities in its strategies (Sebhatu & Enquist, 2022). The Swedish company wishes to balance economic growth with positive impacts on people, society, and the environment. In addition, given the continuous transformation in the business world, it always seeks to align itself to changes, adapting its processes and transforming the business according to new needs, such as digitalization. On the other hand, the circular economy is also part of IKEA’s principles, participating in the regeneration of resources to protect the ecosystem and care for the planet (Sebhatu & Enquist, 2022). As an example of communication strategy between companies and their stakeholders, there are international fairs which are exciting scenarios to consider as a means of connecting them. A clear example is the international fair BIOFACH 2018 in Nuremberg-Germany, which specializes in commercializing certified organic agricultural products, which becomes a space for feedback and meeting with the participants of the integral value chain, allowing interaction and cooperation between the parts. Producers, marketers, distributors, associations, control authorities, and the government join together, who fulfill the role of promoting ecological practices in agriculture together with the German Ministry of Agriculture [Bundesministerium für Ernährung und Landwirtschaft Deutschland] (López & Vera, 2019).

50

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

Another interesting sector to analyze is mining companies, which require viable strategic plans to achieve sustainable growth, mainly considering national and international legal standards and social and ecological factors (Matar et al., 2021). A study of mining companies in Quebec-Canada determined that the mining sector has diverse impacts on the ecosystem, highlighting that it is an interesting source of employment and export. However, the price of metals fluctuates in the international market; likewise, the environment and society are vital actors that require implementing strategies to achieve a sustainable business (Matar et al., 2021). The study demonstrated the decisive role played by the early identification and involvement of interested parties in the evaluation of the development of sustainable mining projects, especially in the community that should be at the center of the process, which is paramount so that the tools for analysis and definition of social and economic indicators can be used to guide the mining project, guaranteeing economic viability and minimizing the negative effects of activities on local communities and the environment (Matar et al. 2021).

9 Closing Remarks The business world is affected by the trends that the international market constantly adapts, so it is necessary to keep up to date and develop strategies that provide greater value to customers. For this, it is important to highlight the role of each interested party involved in the business. Stakeholders can contribute to achieving the goals indicated in each dimension of the SDGs by creating an objective with the same direction with actions that allow them to face the various problems of foreign trade from poverty, inequality, and environmental problems in the value chain. On the other hand, the provided analysis of value creation as well as its concept should also be investigated through business models, which should include the different types of value created with and for different stakeholders and the different types of value that are exchanged between the company and the parties’ stakeholders, better known as the resulting value portfolio. In this case, value creation through sustainability applies to businesses that focus on social responsibility, a growing tendency on stakeholders’ interests. Companies have the power within the growth and development of a country at different levels. Early stakeholder identification, ongoing interaction, and cooperation are vital to sustainable business development. The challenges are different for each business, but they all should have the same objective if they want to survive in the competitive international market, and they can do it by being a sustainable business and supporting the development of the economies, implementing a sustainable vision and practices creating synergies to affront economic, social, and ecological problems. International trade positively impacts the global economy, allowing the generation of new business opportunities, employment, poverty reduction, higher income, GDP growth, and well-being of the population. In the business world, a good long-term relationship with suppliers allows access to better prices and

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

51

therefore reduces costs without affecting quality. A good relationship with employees results in more efficient processes. Correct corporate management attracts more investors. Implementing sustainable strategies, such as the circular economy model, allows more efficient use of its resources and, in turn, generates positive impacts on society.

References Accenture and UN Global Compact. (2016). Agenda 2030: A window of opportunity. The UN Global Compact-Accenture Strategy CEO Survey 2016. Accenture. https://pactoglobal.org.py/ uploads/cUb8nF.pdf Adner, R., & Zemsky, P. (2006). A demand-based perspective on sustainable competitive advantage. Strategic Management Journal, 27(3), 215–239. https://doi.org/10.1002/smj.513 American Management Association [AM]. (2007). Creating a Sustainable Future, a Global Study of Current Trends and Possibilities (2007–2017). http://view2.fdu.edu/legacy/ amawebcastreport.pdf. Apronti, P. T., Osamu, S., Otsuki, K., & Kranjac-Berisavljevic, G. (2015). Education for disaster risk reduction (DRR): Linking theory with practice in Ghana’s basic schools. Sustainability, 7(7), 9160–9186. https://doi.org/10.3390/su7079160 Austin, J. E., & Seitanidi, M. M. (2012). Collaborative value creation: A review of partnering between nonprofits and businesses: Part I. Value creation spectrum and collaboration stages. Nonprofit and Voluntary Sector Quarterly, 41(5), 726–758. https://doi.org/10.1177/ 0899764012450777 Baldwin, R. E., & Evenett, S. J. (2014). Value creation and trade in 21st century manufacturing. Journal of Regional Science, 55(1), 31–50. https://doi.org/10.1111/jors.12175 Barth, H., Ulvenblad, P. O., & Ulvenblad, P. (2017). Towards a conceptual framework of sustainable business model innovation in the agri-food sector: A systematic literature review. Sustainability (Switzerland), 9(9), 1–15. https://doi.org/10.3390/su9091620 Bocken, N. M. P., Short, S. W., Rana, P., & Evans, S. (2014). A literature and practice review to develop sustainable business model archetypes. Journal of Cleaner Production, 65(4), 42–56. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jclepro.2013.11.039 Boons, F., & Lüdeke-Freund, F. (2013). Business models for sustainable innovation: state-of-theart and steps towards a research agenda. Journal of Cleaner Production, 45, 9–19. https://doi. org/10.1016/j.jclepro.2012.07.007 Botín, J. A., & Vergara, M. A. (2015). A cost management model for economic sustainability and continuous improvement of mining operations. Resources Policy, 46, 212–218. https://doi.org/ 10.1016/j.resourpol.2015.10.004 Brundiers, K. (2018). Educating for post-disaster sustainability efforts. International Journal of Disaster Risk Reduction, 27, 406–414. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ijdrr.2017.11.002 Bustamante, N., Danoucaras, N., McIntyre, N., Díaz-Martínez, J. C., & Restrepo-Baena, O. J. (2016). Review of improving the water management for the informal gold mining in Colombia. Revista Facultad de Ingeniería Universidad de Antioquia, 79, 163–172. http://www.scielo.org. co/pdf/rfiua/n79/n79a16.pdf Caruana, A. (1997). Corporate reputation: Concept and measurement. Journal of Product & Brand Management, 6(2), 109–118. Castellano, R. L. (2006). International trade and economic growth. A proposal for discussion. World Village, 11(20), 49–55. http://www.saber.ula.ve/handle/123456789/18219 Clement, R. W. (2005). The lessons from stakeholder theory for US business leaders. Business Horizons, 48(3), 255–264. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.bushor.2004.11.003

52

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

Colliver, A. (2017). Education for climate change and a real-world curriculum. Curriculum Perspectives, 37(1), 73–78. https://doi.org/10.1007/s41297-017-0012-z Cornelissen, J., & Thorpe, R. (2002). Measuring a business school’s reputation: Perspectives, problems and prospects. European Management Journal, 20(2), 172–178. https://doi.org/10. 1016/S0263-2373(02)00027-0 Darskuviene, V., & Bendoraitiene, E. (2013). The stakeholder concept analysis. Management of Organizations: Systematic Research, 68, 41–51. http://ejournals.vdu.lt/index.php/managementorganizations/article/view/734/664 Del Campo, A. G., Gazzola, P., & Onyango, V. (2020). The mutualism of strategic environmental assessment and sustainable development goals. Environmental Impact Assessment Review, 82, 106383. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.eiar.2020.106383 Dentoni, D., Bitzer, V., & Pascucci, S. (2016). Cross-sector partnerships and the co-creation of dynamic capabilities for stakeholder orientation. Journal of Business Ethics, 135, 35–53. https:// doi.org/10.1007/s10551-015-2728-8 Díaz-Correa, J. E., & López-Navarro, M. A. (2018). Managing sustainable hybrid organisations: A case study in the agricultural sector. Sustainability, 10(9), 3010. https://doi.org/10.3390/ su10093010 Dolphin, R. R. (2004). Corporate reputation – A value creating strategy. Corporate Governance: The International Journal of Business in Society, 4(3), 77–92. https://doi.org/10.1108/ 14720700410547521 Donaldson, T., & Preston, L. (1995). The stakeholder theory of the corporation: Concepts, evidence, and implications. The Academy of Management Review, 20(1), 65–91. https://doi. org/10.2307/258887 Ellen MacArthur Foundation. (2013). Towards the Circular Economy: Economic and business rationale for accelerated transition. Journal of Industrial Ecology, 23–44. https:// ellenmacarthurfoundation.org/towards-the-circular-economy-vol-1-an-economic-and-businessrationale-for-an Emerson, J. (2003). The blended value proposition: Integrating social and financial returns. California Management Review, 45(4), 35–51. https://doi.org/10.2307/41166187 Engida, T. G., Rao, X., Berentsen, P. B., & Lansink, A. G. O. (2018). Measuring corporate sustainability performance–the case of European food and beverage companies. Journal of Cleaner Production, 195, 734–743. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jclepro.2018.05.095 Fassin, Y. (2009). The stakeholder model refined. Journal of Business Ethics, 84(1), 113–135. https://doi.org/10.1007/s10551-008-9677-4 Franco, I., Chatterji, T., Derbyshire, E., & Tracey, J. (2020). Actioning the global goals for local impact. Science for Sustainable Societies. https://doi.org/10.1007/978-981-32-9927-6_16 Freeman, R. E. (1984). Strategic management: A stakeholder approach (Vol. 1). Pitman. http:// www.mendeley.com/research/strategic-management-astakeholder-approach-2 Freeman, R. E. (1999). Divergent stakeholder theory. The Academy of Management Review, 24(2), 233–236. https://www.jstor.org/stable/pdf/259078.pdf Freeman, E. (2010). Managing for stakeholders: Trade-offs or value creation. Journal of Business Ethics, 96, 7–9. http://www.jstor.org/stable/29789749 Freudenreich, B., Lüdeke-Freund, F., & Schaltegger, S. A. (2020). Stakeholder theory perspective on business models: Value creation for sustainability. Journal of Business Ethics, 166, 3–18. https://doi.org/10.1007/s10551-019-04112-z Frey, D. F. (2017). Economic growth, full employment and decent work: The means and ends in SDG 8. The International Journal of Human Rights, 21(8), 1164–1184. https://doi.org/10.1080/ 13642987.2017.1348709 Friedman, M. (1970). A Friedman doctrine-The social responsibility of business is to increase its profits. The New York Times Magazine, 13. https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-540-70818-6_14 Frohmann, A., Mulder, N., & X. Olmos (2020). Incentivos a la sostenibilidad en el comercio internacional. Documentos de Proyectos (LC/TS.2020/160), Santiago, Comisión Económica para América Latina y el Caribe (CEPAL). https://repositorio.cepal.org/bitstream/handle/113 62/46604/1/S2000778_es.pdf

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

53

Fuso Nerini, F., Tomei, J., To, L. S., Bisaga, I., Parikh, P., Black, M., et al. (2018). Mapping synergies and trade-offs between energy and the Sustainable Development Goals. Nature Energy, 3(1), 10–15. https://doi.org/10.1038/s41560-017-0036-5 Fuso-Nerini, F., Sovacool, B., Hughes, N., Cozzi, L., Cosgrave, E., Howells, M., Tavoni, M., Tomei, J., Zerriffi, H., & Milligan, B. (2019). Connecting climate action with other Sustainable Development Goals. Nature Sustainability, 2(8), 674–680. https://doi.org/10.1038/s41893-0190334-y Gallie, W. (1955). Essentially contested concepts. In Proceedings of the Aristotelian society (Vol. 56, pp. 167–198). Aristotelian Society, Wiley. https://www.jstor.org/stable/4544562 García-Meca, E., Martínez-Ferrero, J., & Sánchez-Ballesta, J. P. (2021). Compliance with the SDGs and their effects on economic profitability in the Spanish listed company. Accounting and Taxation Magazine, 464, 195–220. https://doi.org/10.51302/rcyt.2021.7463 Goldsmith, R. E., Lafferty, B. A., & Newell, S. J. (2000). The influence of corporate credibility on consumer attitudes and purchase intent. Corporate Reputation Review, 3(4), 304–318. https:// doi.org/10.1057/palgrave.crr.1540122 Grahovac, J., & Miller, D. J. (2009). Competitive advantage and performance: The impact of value creation and costliness of imitation. Strategic Management Journal, 30(11), 1192–1212. https:// doi.org/10.1002/smj.778 Gray, R. (2006). Social, environmental and sustainability reporting and organisational value creation? Whose value? Whose creation? Accounting, Auditing & Accountability Journal, 19 (6), 793–819. https://doi.org/10.1108/09513570610709872 Gray, B., & Stites, J. (2013). Sustainability through partnerships. Capitalizing on Collaboration. Network for Business Sustainability, Case Study, 24, 1–110. http://www.wageningenportals.nl/ sites/default/files/resource/nbs-systematic-review-partnerships.pdf Günzel-Jensen, F., Siebold, N., Kroeger, A., & Korsgaard, S. (2020). Do the United Nations’ Sustainable Development Goals matter for social entrepreneurial ventures? A bottom-up perspective. Journal of Business Venturing Insights, 13, 1–8. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jbvi.2020. e00162 Hackney, R., Burn, J., & Salazar, A. (2004). Strategies for value creation in electronic markets: towards a framework for managing evolutionary change. The Journal of Strategic Information Systems, 13(2), 91–103. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jsis.2004.02.006 Hajer, M., Nilsson, M., Raworth, K., Bakker, P., Berkhout, F., De Boer, Y., et al. (2015). Beyond cockpit-ism: Four insights to enhance the transformative potential of the sustainable development goals. Sustainability, 7(2), 1651–1660. https://doi.org/10.3390/su7021651 Halicioglu, F. (2009). An econometric study of CO2 emissions, energy consumption, income and foreign trade in Turkey. Energy Policy, 37(3), 1156–1164. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.enpol.2008. 11.012 Halkos, G., & Nomikos, S. (2021). Revisión del estado del marco legal de la responsabilidad social empresarial (RSE). Administrar Reinar, 32, 700–716. https://doi.org/10.1108/MEQ-042021-0073 Harrison, J. S., Freeman, R. E., & Abreu, M. C. S. D. (2015). Stakeholder theory as an ethical approach to effective management: Applying the theory to multiple contexts. Revista brasileira de gestão de negócios, 17, 858–869. https://doi.org/10.7819/rbgn.v17i55.2647 Hart, S. L., & Milstein, M. B. (2003). Creating sustainable value. Academy of Management Executive, 17(2), 56–69. https://doi.org/10.5465/ame.2003.10025194 Haslam, C., Tsitsianis, N., Andersson, T., & Gleadle, P. (2015). Accounting for business models: Increasing the visibility of stakeholders. Journal of Business Models, 3(1), 62–80. https://doi. org/10.5278/ojs.jbm.v3/1.1066 Herrera Cano, C. (2016). Disaster risk management in business education entrepreneurial formation for corporate sustainability. AD-Minister, 28, 33–48. https://doi.org/10.17230/ad-minister.28.2 Hidalgo, R. (2018). Trends in international trade in goods, trade policies and multilateral negotiations. Economy and Development, 159(1), 135–153. http://scielo.sld.cu/scielo.php?script=sci_ arttext&pid=S0252-85842018000100009&lng=es&tlng=en

54

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

Hörisch, J., Freeman, E., & Schaltegger, S. (2014). Applying stakeholder theory in sustainability management: Links, similarities, and a conceptual framework. Organization and Environment, 27(4), 1–19. https://doi.org/10.1177/1086026614535786 Husted, B. W., Allen, D. B., & Kock, N. (2015). Value creation through social strategy. Business and Society, 54(2), 147–186. https://doi.org/10.1177/0007650312439187 Iansiti, M., & Levien, R. (2004). Strategy as ecology. Harvard Business Review, Boston March, 68–78. https://hbr.org/2004/03/strategy-as-ecology Jindřichovská, I., Kubíčková, D., & Mocanu, M. (2020). Case study analysis of sustainability reporting of an agri-food giant. Sustainability, 12(11), 4491. https://doi.org/10.3390/ su12114491 Jun, H., & Kim, M. (2021). From stakeholder communication to engagement for the sustainable development goals (SDGs): A case study of LG electronics. Sustainability, 13, 8624. https://doi. org/10.3390/su13158624 Karlsson, N. P., Laurell, H., Lindgren, J., Pehrsson, T., Andersson, S., & Svensson, G. (2018). A cross-country comparison and validation of firms’ stakeholder considerations in sustainable business practices. Corporate Governance, 18(3), 408–424. https://doi.org/10.1108/CG-072017-0131 Kolk, A. (2016). The social responsibility of international business: From ethics and the environment to CSR and sustainable development. Journal of World Business, 51(1), 23–34. https://doi. org/10.1016/j.jwb.2015.08.010 Kolk, A., Kourula, A., & Pisani, N. (2017). Multinational enterprises and the sustainable development goals: What do we know and how to proceed? Transnational Corporations, 24(3), 9–32. https://ssrn.com/abstract=2988607 Laing, T., & Moonsammy, S. (2021). Evaluating the impact of small-scale mining on the achievement of the sustainable development goals in Guyana. Environmental Science and Policy, 116, 147–159. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.envsci.2020.11.010 Le Pennec, M., & Raufflet, E. (2018). Value creation in inter-organizational collaboration: An empirical study. Journal of Business Ethics, 148, 817–834. https://doi.org/10.1007/s10551-0153012-7 Lepak, D., Smith, K., & Taylor, M. (2007). Value creation and value capture: A multilevel perspective. Academy of Management Review, 32(1), 180–194. https://doi.org/10.5465/amr. 2007.23464011 Lewandowski, M. (2016). Designing the business models for circular economy—Towards the conceptual framework. Sustainability, 8(1), 43. https://doi.org/10.3390/su8010043 López, H. I., & Vera, L. D. (2019). Identificación de los stakeholders y la cadena de valor agregado para alimentos ecológicos certificados comercializados en la Feria Biofach-2018. Lúmina, 20, 54–74. https://doi.org/10.30554/lumina.20.3446.2019 Mahat, H., Yusri, M. S., & Ngah, C. (2016). 3R practices among Moe preschool pupils through the environmental education curriculum. In SHS web of conferences (Vol. 23, p. 04002). EDP Sciences. https://doi.org/10.1051/shsconf/20162304002 Mainardes, E., Alves, H., & Raposo, M. (2011). Stakeholder theory: Issues to resolve. Management Decision, 49(2), 226–252. https://doi.org/10.1108/00251741111109133 Matar, G. E. H., Adel, B., & Boudreau-Trudel, B. (2021). Sustainable development in the mining industry: Towards the development of tools for evaluating socioeconomic impact in the Canadian context. Environment, Development and Sustainability, 23(5), 6576–6602. https:// doi.org/10.1007/s10668-020-00948-y McGrath, S., & Whitty, S. (2017). Stakeholder defined. International Journal of Managing Projects in Business. https://doi.org/10.1108/IJMPB-12-2016-0097 Miles, S. (2012). Stakeholder: Essentially contested or just confused? Journal of Business Ethics, 108, 285–298. https://doi.org/10.1007/s10551-011-1090-8 Miles, S. (2017). Stakeholder theory classification: A theoretical and empirical evaluation of definitions. Journal of Business Ethics, 142(3), 437–459. https://doi.org/10.1007/s10551-0152741-y

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

55

Montalvo, C. (2008). General wisdom concerning the factors affecting the adoption of cleaner technologies: A survey 1990–2007. Journal of Cleaner Production, 16(1), S7–S13. https://doi. org/10.1016/j.jclepro.2007.10.002 Moya-Clemente, I., Ribes-Giner, G., & Pantoja-Díaz, O. (2019). Configurations of sustainable development goals that promote sustainable entrepreneurship over time. Sustainable Development, 28(4), 1584–1596. https://doi.org/10.1002/sd.2009 Naoufal, N. (2014). Peace and environmental education for climate change: Challenges and practices in Lebanon. Journal of Peace Education, 11(3), 279–296. https://doi.org/10.1080/ 17400201.2014.954359 Neu, D., Warsame, H., & Pedwell, K. (1998). Managing public impressions: Environmental disclosures in annual reports. Accounting Organizations and Society, 23(3), 265–282. https:// doi.org/10.1016/S0361-3682(97)00008-1 Obrecht, A., Pham, M., Spehn, E., Payne, D., Brémond, A. C., Altermatt, F., Fischer, M., Passarello, C., Moersberger, H., Schelske, O., Guntern, J., Prescott, G. W., & Geschke, J. E. (2021). Achieving the SDGs with biodiversity. In Akademie der Naturwissenschaften Schweiz (SCNAT). Forum Biodiversität Schweiz. https://boris.unibe.ch/156991/1/SDG_Factsheet_E_ DEF.pdf Organización Mundial del Comercio. (2018). Incorporar el comercio para lograr los Objetivos de Desarrollo Sostenible. (ISBN: 978-92-870-4276-7). https://www.wto.org/spanish/res_s/ booksp_s/sdg_s.pdf Owen, D. L., Swift, T., Bowerman, M., & Humphreys, C. (2000). The new social audits: accountability, managerial capture or the agenda of social champions? European Accounting Review, 9(1), 81–98. https://doi.org/10.1080/096381800407950 Perée, E., & Steinherr, A. (1989). Exchange rate uncertainty and foreign trade. European Economic Review, 33(6), 1241–1264. https://doi.org/10.1016/0014-2921(89)90095-0 Pérez-Espinoza, M. J., Espinoza-Carrión, C., & Peralta-Mocha, B. (2016). Corporate social responsibility and its environmental approach: A sustainable vision for the future. University and Society Magazine, 8(3), 169–178. https://rus.ucf.edu.cu/index.php/rus/article/view/430 Petrick, J. F. (1999). An examination of the relationship between golf travelers’ satisfaction, perceived value and loyalty and their intentions to revisit. Clemson University. Pilgrim, K., & Bohnet-Joschko, S. (2022). Corporate social responsibility on Twitter: A review of topics and digital communication strategies’ success factors. Sustainability, 14(24), 16769. https://doi.org/10.3390/su142416769 Polanco, J., Ramírez, F., & Orozco, M. (2016). Incidence of international standards on corporate sustainability: a senior management perspective. Management Studies, 32(139), 181–192. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.estger.2016.05.002 Porter, M., & Kramer, M. (2011). Shared value: How to reinvent capitalism—And unleash a wave of innovation and growth. Harvard Business Review, 89(1/2), 62–77. http://www.relativimpact. com/downloads/HBR-Shared-value.pdf Preghenella, N., & Battistella, C. (2021). Exploring business models for sustainability: A bibliographic investigation of the literature and future research directions. Business Strategy and the Environment, 30, 2505–2522. https://doi.org/10.1002/bse.2760 Rai, S. M., Brown, B. D., & Ruwanpura, K. N. (2019). SDG 8: Decent work and economic growth– A gendered analysis. World Development, 113, 368–380. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.worlddev. 2018.09.006 Ryssel, R., Ritter, T., & Georg Gemünden, H. (2004). The impact of information technology deployment on trust, commitment and value creation in business relationships. Journal of Business and Industrial Marketing, 19(3), 197–207. https://doi.org/10.1108/ 08858620410531333 Sachs, J. D. (2015). Achieving the sustainable development goals. Journal of International Business Ethics, 8(2), 53–62. Schaltegger, S., & Wagner, M. (2011). Sustainable entrepreneurship and sustainability innovation: categories and interactions. Business Strategy and the Environment, 20(4), 222–237. https://doi. org/10.1002/bse.682

56

A. Alvarez-Risco et al.

Schaltegger, S., Lüdeke-Freund, F., & Hansen, E. (2012). Business cases for sustainability: The role of business model innovation for corporate sustainability. International Journal of Innovation and Sustainable Development, 6(2), 95–119. https://doi.org/10.1504/IJISD.2012.046944 Schaltegger, S., Hörisch, J., & Freeman, R. E. (2019). Business cases for sustainability: A stakeholder theory perspective. Organization and Environment, 32(3), 191–212. https://doi. org/10.1177/1086026617722882 Sebhatu, S. P., & Enquist, B. (2022). Values and multi-stakeholder dialog for business transformation in light of the UN Sustainable Development Goals. Journal of Business Ethics, 180, 1059–1074. https://doi.org/10.1007/s10551-022-05195-x Servera-Francés, D., Fuentes-Blasco, M., & Piqueras-Tomás, L. (2020). The importance of sustainable practices in the creation of value and the commitment of consumers with the commercial format of companies. Sustainability, 12(23), 9852. https://doi.org/10.3390/su12239852 Short, S. W., Bocken, N. M. P., Barlow, C. Y., & Chertow, M. R. (2014). From refining sugar to growing tomatoes. Journal of Industrial Ecology, 18(5), 603–618. https://doi.org/10.1111/jiec. 12171 Sidiropoulos, E. (2014). Education for sustainability in business education programs: A question of value. Journal of Cleaner Production, 85, 472–487. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jclepro.2013. 10.040 Silva, S., Nuzum, A. K., & Schaltegger, S. (2019). Stakeholder expectations on sustainability performance measurement and assessment. A systematic literature review. Journal of Cleaner Production, 217, 204–215. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jclepro.2019.01.203 Smith, J., & Colgate, M. (2007). Customer value creation: A practical framework. Journal of Marketing Theory and Practice, 15(1), 7–23. https://doi.org/10.2753/MTP1069-6679150101 Stubbs, W. (2017). Characterising B Corps as a sustainable business model: An exploratory study of B Corps in Australia. Journal of Cleaner Production, 144, 299–312. https://doi.org/10.1016/ j.jclepro.2016.12.093 Tafra-Vlahović, M. (2016). In the world guide to sustainable enterprise Volume 3 – Europe. Greenleaf. (Ed) Wayne Visser. Greenleaf Publishing Limited . (ISBN 9781783535149). Tahir, M. W., Kauser, R., Bury, M., & Bhatti, J. S. (2018). “Individually-led” or “female-male partnership” models for entrepreneurship with the BISP support: The story of women’s financial and social empowerment from Pakistan. Women’s Studies International Forum, 68, 1–10. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.wsif.2018.01.011 Tinker, T., Lehman, C., & Neimark, M. (1991). Corporate social reporting: Falling down the hole in the middle of the road. Accounting, Auditing and Accountability Journal, 4(1), 28–54. https:// doi.org/10.1108/09513579110000504 Tregidga, H., Milne, M. J., & Kearins, K. (2018). Ramping up resistance: Corporate sustainable development and academic research. Business and Society, 57(2), 292–334. https://doi.org/10. 1177/0007650315611459 UN Global Compact. (2017). Making global goals local business: A new era for responsible business. United Nations Global Compact. https://www.unglobalcompact.org/library/4321 United Nations General Assembly. (2015). Resolution adopted by the General Assembly on 25 September 2015. https://www.un.org/en/development/desa/population/migration/ generalassembly/docs/globalcompact/A_RES_70_1_E.pdf United Nations. (2018). Progress towards the Sustainable Development Goals: Report of the Secretary-General. https://digitallibrary.un.org/record/1627573 United Nations. (2020). Sustainable Development Goals Report 2020. https://unstats.un.org/sdgs/ report/2020/The-Sustainable-Development-Goals-Report-2020_Spanish.pdf United Nations. (2023). Sustainable Development Goals. https://www.un.org/ sustainabledevelopment/ United Nations General Assembly. (2015). Resolution adopted by the General Assembly on 25 September 2015. https://www.un.org/en/development/desa/population/migration/ generalassembly/docs/globalcompact/A_RES_70_1_E.pdf Vaidya, H., & Chatterji, T. (2020). SDG 11 sustainable cities and communities: SDG 11 and the New Urban Agenda: Global sustainability frameworks for local action (pp. 173–185).

Value Creation Impact: Role of Stakeholders in the Development. . .

57

Actioning the Global Goals for Local Impact: Towards Sustainability Science, Policy, Education and Practice. Van Tulder, R., Verbeke, A., & Strange, R. (Eds.). (2014). International business and sustainable development. International Business and Sustainable Development, iii. doi:https://doi.org/10. 1108/S1745-8862(2013)0000008030. Van Zanten, J. A., & Van Tulder, R. (2018). Multinational enterprises and the Sustainable Development Goals: An institutional approach to corporate engagement. Journal of International Business Policy, 1(3), 208–233. https://doi.org/10.1057/s42214-018-0008-x Vintró, C., Sanmiquel, L., & Freijo, M. (2014). Environmental sustainability in the mining sector: Evidence from Catalan companies. Journal of Cleaner Production, 84, 155–163. https://doi. org/10.1016/j.jclepro.2013.12.069 WBCSD. (2015). Reporting matters: Redefining performance and disclosure. WBCSD. https:// www.wbcsd.org/Programs/Redefining-Value/Reporting-matters/Resources/Reporting-mat ters-2015 Wettstein, F., Giuliani, E., Santangelo, G., & Stahl, G. (2019). International business and human rights: A research agenda. Journal of World Business, 54(1), 54–65. https://doi.org/10.1016/j. jwb.2018.10.004 Witjes, S., & Lozano, R. (2016). Towards a more circular economy: Proposing a framework linking sustainable public procurement and sustainable business models. Resources, Conservation and Recycling, 112, 37–44. Woodall, T. (2003). Conceptualizing value for the customer: An attributional, structural and dispositional analysis. Academy of Marketing Science Review, 12(1), 1–42. https://acortar. link/1iaTnC World Commission on Environment and Development [WCED]. (1987). Report of the world commission on environment and development: Our common future. Oxford University Press. https://sustainabledevelopment.un.org/content/documents/5987our-common-future.pdf

Aldo Alvarez-Risco is a Professor of Research at Universidad Tecnológica del Perú. Maria de las Mercedes Anderson-Seminario is a Professor of International Business at Universidad de Lima and a Coordinator of the International Business research volunteer team. Nilda Campos-Dávalos obtained her Bachelor of International Business at Universidad de Lima. She is a Member of the International Business research volunteer team. Lucía de los Ángeles Castillo-Butrón obtained her Bachelor of International Business at Universidad de Lima. She is a Member of the International Business research volunteer team. Berdy Briggitte Cuya-Velásquez obtained her Bachelor of International Business at Universidad de Lima. She is a Member of the International Business research volunteer team. Shyla Del-Aguila-Arcentales is a Researcher in Escuela de Posgrado at Universidad San Ignacio de Loyola. Romina Gómez-Prado obtained her Bachelor of International Business at Universidad de Lima. She is a Member of the International Business research volunteer team. Jorge Sánchez-Palomino obtained his Bachelor of International Business at Universidad de Lima. He is a Member of the International Business research volunteer team.

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN Group Adopting the Circular Economy Concept Tung Bui

, Quan Vu Le

, and Jason Nguyen

Abstract As a repercussion of the Sino-American trade war and the global outbreak of the COVID-19 pandemic, major economies are seeking ways to reduce dependence on China’s production prowess. East Asian economies, including Vietnam, are actively lobbying industrialized economies to consider them as alternate or expanded suppliers in the new global supply chain system. We argue that the current relocalization of factories is at best a political move that might soothe the current protectionism mood and at worst an inefficient business decision. We advocate that the reshaping of the global supply system would be best achieved by engaging all members of the supply chain to embrace the circular economy (CE) core principles to ensure sustainable and equitable economic and social development, both locally and globally. We present a case study of the PAN Group, a dynamic, unconventional, and growing agricultural conglomerate in Vietnam that has been aggressively taking strategic moves toward the circular economy. By examining the implications of PAN Group’s accomplishments, we can gain valuable insights into how the principles of the circular economy can be applied to diverse sectors, driving sustainable growth and economic advancements.

T. Bui APEC Study Center and Shidler College of Business, University of Hawaii, Honolulu, HI, USA e-mail: [email protected] Q. V. Le (✉) Institute for Circular Economy Development, Vietnam National University, Ho Chi Minh City, Vietnam HKU in Vietnam, University of Hong Kong, Ho Chi Minh City, Vietnam e-mail: [email protected] J. Nguyen Ivey Business School, Western University, London, ON, Canada e-mail: [email protected] © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2023 P. Arte et al. (eds.), Sustainable International Business, Contributions to Management Science, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-43785-4_4

59

60

T. Bui et al.

1 Introduction The supply shock triggered by the lockdown of Wuhan, China in February 2020 raised significant concerns about the sustainability of globalization and its impact on global supply chains. The heavy reliance on China as the world’s manufacturing hub, coupled with the relentless pursuit of cost reduction through offshoring, inventory minimization, and asset maximization, left little room for resilience and adaptability in the face of a global crisis like the COVID-19 pandemic (Pandey, 2020). In this chapter, we examine a case study of a dynamic and unconventional agricultural conglomerate in Vietnam, focusing on the need for a comprehensive national approach that integrates proactive firm-level international business strategies and supportive governmental trade policies. By leveraging the current efforts to redefine the global supply chain system, we aim to propose a sustainable framework that addresses the challenges of the future. Recent evidence suggests that the pandemic and global political move to reduce the trade surplus from China have not worked (Setser, 2020). Thanks to its manufacturing agility, China has responded to the protectionism move from the USA, Europe, and Japan with a substantial export increase. With millions of people working from home and students attending school online during the lockdowns, worldwide strong demand for personal protective equipment, cleaning products, home improvement goods, electronic products for working from home, and e-commerce goods, the trade balance has leaned in favor of China again (Mashayekhi, 2020; Tian, 2021). The U.S. Biden administration announced in January 2021 a review of the global supply chains for critical components such as batteries for electric vehicles, medical gears, computer chips, and minerals as U.S. manufacturers are severely affected by the shortage of raw materials. It would take months for the review outcome and follow recommendations to come out. But the executive order from President Biden is the latest sign that a new world order that has been the U.S.-China trade dispute triggered by the Trump administration for global supply chain management will take place. Any shake-up of the well-oiled China-dependent production system involves building an all-new multinational reliable supply chain network with a diversified supply base as well as exploring and establishing new, reliant demand markets. The task has become even more critical for nations with close trade ties with China. Take, for example, the case of Vietnam, which has suffered devastating economic impacts during the pandemic due to close trade ties with China on both ends of the supply chain. At the demand end, many of Vietnam’s key industries, including textile and garment, leather, that rely heavily on Chinese raw materials were paralyzed in March and April of 2020 due to the lockdown of raw materials imported from China. As a result, Vietnamese firms were forced to rotate, cut down their workforce, or even shut down their business, resulting in thousands of lost jobs. At the supply end, China remains the largest export market for Vietnam, accounting for more than US $43.1 billion in 2020, creating a sizable revenue loss during the pandemic. One of

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

61

the hardest-hit industries is Vietnam’s agricultural sector, which recorded an almost 10% reduction (approx. US$1 billion in value) in export revenue to China in 2020. Given the unsettling and uncertain business climate, what should Vietnam do in terms of economic and business strategies to navigate its economy out of the pandemic crisis and position itself in the upcoming new world order? We postulate in this case study that Vietnam—like any other developing economy in the upstream of the supply chain—needs to strategize beyond the low-cost production model that has helped China become the world’s second-largest economy. The unprecedented uncertainty leads to an undesirable, but timely, wake-up call for many countries to re-assess and transform their economic strategies to be more resilient and avoid overreliance on any country, or even a region. In this chapter, we advocate that adopting the Circular Economy (CE) concept in reshaping the global supply chain would create a more sustainable and equitable economy for all participating economies.

2 Sustainability and Circular Economy Sustainability refers to the commitment to meeting the present needs while ensuring the ability of future generations to meet their own needs (United Nations, 1987). When applied to supply chains, sustainability encompasses long-term economic viability, minimizing negative environmental impacts and embracing social responsibility on a global scale. To achieve sustainable development within supply chain management, both private and public must prioritize resource conservation, waste reduction, and environmental pollution mitigation. This approach considers the entire lifecycle of products and services, from sourcing raw materials to end-of-life disposal, to optimize efficiency and minimize ecological footprints. As explored further in this chapter, the circular economy presents an economic model that seeks to eliminate waste and promote the continuous use of resources. It advocates for the reuse, repair, and recycling of materials instead of discarding them as waste. The current global supply chain, centered around China as a major production hub and the rest of the world as consumption platforms, has demonstrated unsustainable practices, such as dangerous dependence on finite resources and a lack of viable alternative sourcing opportunities. In contrast, the foundation of a circular economy lies in responsible sourcing practices, ethical labor conditions, efficient logistics, and crucially, collaboration with suppliers and consumers to drive social responsibilities. By prioritizing transparency, traceability, and accountability, the circular economy not only mitigates disruption risks but also creates shared value for all stakeholders involved (Bui, 1999). It is evident that the existing supply chain arrangement falls short in terms of sustainability and long-term viability. Embracing a circular economy framework can address these shortcomings by redefining the relationship between production, consumption, and waste management. This transition requires collaborative efforts from both the public and private sectors to establish the necessary frameworks, policies, and incentives for circularity. Ultimately, integrating sustainability and

62

T. Bui et al.

circular economy principles within the supply chain not only ensures a more resilient and responsible system but also contributes to the well-being of future generations. However, implementing sustainability within the global economy presents various challenges and difficulties. However, implementing sustainability within the global economy presents various challenges and difficulties described in Seuring and Muller (2008). The current network of supply chains presents a complex and fragmented landscape, involving numerous stakeholders, processes, and geographical locations. This complexity often hampers effective communication and collaboration among suppliers, manufacturers, distributors, customs authorities, and retailers, hindering the implementation of sustainable practices. One of the significant challenges is the limited availability of shared data from all involved parties. This lack of data transparency poses difficulties in monitoring performance and tracking progress toward sustainability goals. Without comprehensive and accurate data, it becomes challenging to assess the environmental impacts of supply chain activities and identify areas for improvement. Stakeholders within the supply chain often have their own priorities, limitations, and resistance to change. This can make it difficult to establish consistent and widespread compliance with best sustainable practices, especially in a global supply chain context. Suppliers may cite financial constraints and concerns about increased costs as reasons for non-compliance, creating barriers to the adoption of sustainable practices. Furthermore, regulatory and policy frameworks in many countries are insufficient and fragmented, lacking consistent enforcement mechanisms. The absence of robust regulations and policies related to sustainability in supply chains creates challenges for organizations striving to implement sustainable practices. Inadequate regulatory frameworks make it difficult to drive industry-wide change and ensure a level playing field for all participants. The global supply chain with China as a major production hub for the majority of global consumption has demonstrated a failure in sustainability: dangerous dependence on finite resources, lack of adequate alternate sourcing opportunities, and promotion of unsustainable consumption patterns. The foundation of a circular economy relies on responsible sourcing practices, ethical labor conditions, efficient logistics, and last but not least, collaboration with suppliers and customers to drive social responsibilities. Unlike the current supply chain arrangement, transparency, traceability, and accountability embedded in the circular economy not only mitigate risks of disruption but enhance brand reputation and create shared value for all stakeholders involved.

3 Vietnam and the Reshaping of the Global Supply Chain While most world’s economies have experienced a GDP contraction, the World Bank estimated a 2.8% GDP growth for 2020, and the Vietnam Institute for Economic and Policy Research (VEPR) predicts that expansion could be up to

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

63

5.8% for 2021. According to the Japan External Trade Organization (JETRO), Vietnam was the only economy that posted an increase in exports for 2020, up 7% to US$282 billion, outpacing Indonesia, Malaysia, Singapore, Thailand, and the Philippines. Notably, Vietnam’s exports to the world’s top two economies—the USA and China—rose by 25.7% and 18%, respectively. Vietnam has been recognized as one of the most effective countries in the world in containing the spread of COVID-19. Its economic outlook is praised by UBS as one of the brightest in Asia as the world is struggling to sustain its economies with the pandemic looming (Ng, 2020). As major economies are seeking ways to adapt to the new global supply chain system, Vietnam and other East Asian economies are being actively courted to be part of a new global strategy to reduce dependence on China’s production prowess. As evidenced by a recent resurgence in FDI, the unexpected and unprepared opportunity poses a daunting challenge to Vietnam that is to strategically prove itself as a global cost-efficient partner to be at least as competitive as China, India, Malaysia, Thailand, and others. In doing so, the issue at hand is how an economy such as Vietnam would set its firm-level business strategies and economic policies and avoid the common pitfalls of rapid growth and industrialization (World Bank, 2020a, b).

3.1

Low-Hanging Fruit Approach to Relocation

On July 20, 2020, Japan announced its “China Exit” policy. It released a list of 87 manufacturing projects eligible for subsidies to move production out of China (Nikkei Asia 2020).1 Fifteen of them have been designated to be moved to Vietnam, and the Japanese government would subsidize US$567 million to facilitate this migration. The move by Japan and the Western economies has certainly benefited countries like Vietnam, at least in the short run. However, recent trade statistics have shown that since the midst of the 2020 pandemic, China’s exports to developing countries have increased substantially. A closer analysis of the profiles of these Japanese companies suggests that the selection seems to be based on what the Japanese perceive as what Vietnam can produce. The 17% share of the pie (15 out of 87) also indicates Japan’s move to diversify its supply chain network with other South East Asian economies. Japan’s policy seems to be driven more by political moods than by sound economic analysis. Before the COVID-19 outbreak, Google did already take over the Nokia factory outside Ho Chi Minh City to produce their Pixel phones. Less than a year after, in May 2020, Apple announced it would speed up the production of its best-selling AirPods in Vietnam and it is shifting iPad production from China to Vietnam

1 Retrieved from Nikkei Asia: https://asia.nikkei.com/Economy/Japan-reveals-87-projects-eligiblefor-China-exit-subsidies, July 2020.

64

T. Bui et al.

sometime in May 2021 (Ting-Fang & Li, 2020). While Intel remains committed to keeping its production facilities in China, primarily to serve this gigantic market, it joins Nintendo and Puma to open factories in Vietnam.2 There is an apparent correlation between the types of products Vietnam has manufactured as a nation, mostly low-value-added products, and the multinational corporations (MNCs) that have plans to move mass production from China to its southern border (e.g., the 15 Japanese firms being subsidized by the Government of Japan to move to Vietnam and the electronics for Apple and Google). We contend this is a low-hanging fruit solution that requires little structural change in the current supply chain, and all of the 15 Japanese companies already had their limited business presence in Vietnam. An August 2020 study by the Bank of America suggests that moving the locations of some of the low-value manufacturing nodes in the chain out of China to neighboring economies would cost the U.S. and European firms US$1 trillion (Smith, 2020). Since it is an expensive move, it remains to be seen if newly relocated factories could achieve the “low production cost” strategy that took China more than a couple of decades to perfect. In fact, subsidies from governments to attract these shifts would be counterproductive, from an economic perspective. Shifting a complex manufacturing system driven uniquely by tax incentives might cause long-term economic and social costs if the move cannot warrant a more cost-efficient production. In the next section, we briefly describe the importance of Foreign Trade Investment to developing economies like Vietnam.

3.2

The Role of Foreign Trade Investment

National economic policies can help create an international business climate that is conducive to trade and cooperation. In its 2021 assessment, the International Monetary Fund acknowledges the resiliency of Vietnam’s economy thanks to robust economic fundamentals, swift containment measures of the pandemic, and government support in strategic sectors (Dable-Norris & Zhang, 2021). However, it seems that the MNCs have the final say in reshaping global trade. Kim et al. (2020) study the relationships between Vietnamese foreign trade investments in Vietnam and the country’s exports from 2003 to 2017. Their findings show that not only MNCs dictate how factory locations are selected, and consequently, how the production networks and composition of trade of the world are redistributed. But most strategically, location choices may reassign production technologies across countries, in favor of those who manage to attract FDI. Using data provided by Vietnam’s Ministry of Planning and Investment (MPI), Trading Economics reports that FDI contracted by 2% in 2019–2020, but picked up

2

This link provides a list of companies shifting their production from China to other countries, including Bangladesh, Cambodia, India, Indonesia, Malaysia, South Korea, Taiwan, and Vietnam. Retrieved from https://www.lovemoney.com/gallerylist/98705/big-multinational-companies-mov ing-out-of-china, July 2020.

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

65

by 6.5% in 2020–2021.3 It is expected that FDI will rise to US$22 billion, or approximately 8% of the GDP—significantly higher than the world’s average estimated to be between 2 and 3%.

3.3

A National Policy for Sustainable Development Through the Circular Economy

If Vietnam is just seen by MNCs as a partial substitute for China’s low-cost production powerhouse, the nation’s primary challenge would be to change how the world perceives its economic, social, and political environments. With a young but rapidly aging labor force, rising living standards, and inadequate infrastructure, can Vietnam get a larger share of some of its neighboring countries, such as Indonesia, Malaysia, and Thailand? The World Bank reminds that the global environment remains severely affected by the raging pandemic and Vietnam’s economic health which depends on exports is not immune to an economic crisis. It argues that only a competitive and dynamic private sector could mitigate these external risks (World Bank, 2020a, b). In its January 2021 National Assembly meeting, the Vietnamese government passed a resolution to consider the Circular Economy (CE) approach to be a national strategy to sustain economic development through the implementation of the Circular Economy principles. The resolution that encourages the public–private partnership (PPP) model illustrates an offensive–defensive economic strategy. On the defensive side, the country is trying to sustain its exports in a global recession and to expand its domestic market with continuous cost-cutting efforts. On the offensive side, the country is seeking to market itself as a more desirable environment for FDI through an aggressive corporate strategy that includes a business process (re)engineering, HR policies that aim at talent management, and national branding. Throughout the case analysis in the following sections, we will discuss the feasibility of a national effort to become the world’s supplier and buyer that embraces the basic principles of the CE.

4 The Circular Economy and the Reshaping of the Global Supply Chain 4.1

The Emergence of the Circular Economy as a National Economic Strategy

The Circular Economy (CE) has recently emerged as a promising and innovative approach to increasing competitiveness and self-reliance, thanks to its combined 3

Data retrieved from Trading Economics: https://tradingeconomics.com/vietnam/foreign-directinvestment, July 2020.

66

T. Bui et al.

economic, environmental, and social benefits (Murray et al., 2017). China, Japan, the USA, and the European Union were among the earliest nations to issue policies to support the adoption of CE (Ghisellini et al., 2016; Winans et al., 2017). Emerging economies, including Vietnam, have also recently pivoted to CE (Preston et al., 2019). Among the earliest advocates of CE, the Ellen MacArthur Foundation (2012) suggests four fundamental building blocks for the transition toward CE: 1. Circular product designs which aim to maximize the utility and value of raw materials, components, and products by extending the product life, changing to recyclable materials, and adopting an eco-design approach (Mont, 2008; Bakker et al., 2014). 2. Servitized business models which encourage switching from selling to renting, leasing, or sharing technical products, thus promoting better management of product life cycle (Angelis et al., 2018; Batista et al., 2018; Lacy & Rutqvist, 2015). 3. Reverse logistic supply chains that enable “renovation” activities such as repair, reuse, refurbishment, remanufacturing, and recycling, allowing companies to reduce waste and improve profits (Parajuly & Wenzel, 2017; Kazemi et al., 2018). 4. A number of enablers and favorable conditions including users’ awareness toward sharing, policy and regulation, financing, and the creation of a market for secondary products, and digital technologies (Bressanelli et al., 2019; Saidani et al., 2018). CE thus differs from the traditional linear economy based on the “take-makedispose” model, in that it disentangles the economic growth from resource extractions and the associated negative impacts on the environment (Elia et al., 2017). This allows businesses that integrate CE into their supply chains to obtain environmental, social, and economic benefits (Ongondo et al., 2013; Cucchiella et al., 2015; Genovese et al., 2017; Schmid & Ritzrau, 2018; Kuch, 2022). The conceptual framework of supply chain management for CE has been developed by Hazen et al. (2021) and Montag (2022) to support the transition from traditional linear approaches to production and consumption to a more circular approach. The six R’s principles that govern CE models, namely Recover, Reuse, Remanufacture, Recycle, Redesign, and Reduce are expected to improve resource efficiency and sustainable supply chains (Manavalan & Jayakrishna, 2019). Theoretically, recover, recycled, and reusable products could ensure a closed-loop supply chain of inputs, and so improve competitiveness through less reliance on raw materials from external sources. Through remanufacturing, businesses could also reduce emissions and wastes, helping them save money as well as meet environmental regulations. Also, making redesign products could allow businesses to quickly adapt their facilities and shift production to another product allowing them to be more agile and resistant to external shocks. With these potential benefits, CE has recently attracted attention from both academics and practitioners, who have focused mostly on the integration of the

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

67

CE concept into supply chains for its impacts on sustainable development. However, CE’s concern about implementing and developing self-reliant and resilient supply chains is critically overlooked. Moreover, most of the existing works take the perspective of developed economies while insufficient attention has been paid to developing countries. Differences in institutional and political antecedents and the rapid pace of growth and industrial development in emerging nations may require very different approaches for CE integration than those applied in developed countries. For example, the agricultural sector has received minimal attention in global CE discussions to date but may need to take a central role in the CE pathways of many developing countries.

4.2

The Circular Economy and the New Global Supply Chain

The supply disruption during the early months of the COVID pandemic caused a global shock. Manufacturers and their suppliers around the world were reminded how interdependent they are between them. With the increasing complexity of product design and manufacturing, contractors and subcontractors are highly specialized. As an example, Boeing has more than 12,000 supplier-partners, and approximately 6000 of them are small and diverse businesses.4 While the company claims that its dense global network of suppliers has significantly added value to its products and services, it also acknowledges that coordination is time-consuming and expensive. A surprise disruption such as the one caused by the pandemic did temporarily bring many manufacturing projects to a halt. A conventional mitigating strategy would be to increase inventory to face another disruption due to shortage. However, this strategy is equally costly and it would not even work if more and more suppliers are rendered incapacitated due to production interdependence. The CE would alleviate this problem, as the production ecosystem would be broken down into local and tightly-coupled ecosystems, while interdependencies across ecosystems are reduced thanks to a loosely coupled design. The CE would also advocate for a redeployment of markets. Instead of following the decades-long linear supply chain that originates from low-labor economies and ends up in consumption at high-purchasing power economies, CE would have region-centered “sub-systems” to partially turn inward. That is only a proportion of the location production will be exported along the global supply chain, and the rest will be consumed locally. As such, what we contend here is that a CE-driven supply chain system will alter the current structure of supply and demand, from a quasi-linear one-way supply chain architecture to a honeycomb-like web of circular structure that takes into consideration the national and regional geo-political realities, as illustrated in Fig. 1. The historical and conventional supply chain is for developed economies to

4

Retrieved from The Boeing Company: boeing.com, April 2022.

68

T. Bui et al.

Fig. 1 Proposition of a new global supply chain concept based on circular economy. (a) The traditional quasi-linear supply chain, (b) the new CE-based supply chain

take advantage of low-cost off-shore production. In return, the arrangement would allow developing economies to implement their export-driven economic policy (Part a of Fig. 1). In the proposed CE-based supply chain, each node in the supply chain is a business entity (either independent partner-enterprises within a country, or a participating economy as a whole) that is loosely coupled with other nodes as part of the collaboration and coordination of the flow of goods (i.e., raw materials, semi-, and finished goods), financial resources (i.e., investments, equity, profit sharing), and information (i.e., production, R&D, and market data).

5 Vietnam and the Circular Economy Movement 5.1

The Circular Economy Movement

As a developing economy anxious for raising its living standards, Vietnam is facing an increasing amount of waste while raw materials and fossil fuels are exhausted at a rapid rate. As such, the transition to CE would offer Vietnam an opportunity to develop rapidly and sustainably, not only fulfilling its economic, social, and

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

69

environmental potentials but also reducing its dependence on external economies. However, as the CE concept is relatively new to Vietnam, the transition will require policymakers, development agencies, and businesses to understand and address challenges specific to the country’s conditions. This is crucial since differences in each country’s stage of development, economic and structural conditions, capacity and financial constraints, resource endowments, and more importantly, political institutions would necessitate tailored strategic responses that could not be easily replicated from developed-country experiences (Preston et al., 2019). The potential challenge for Vietnam in its CE transition is the lack of institutional capacity and enabling governance frameworks. Preston et al. (2019) caution that the lack of strong governance frameworks could lead to problems with the establishment and enforcement of appropriate regulations and mandatory standards to govern circular activities, as well as result in developing countries installing “cheap but limited-quality technologies and equipment mis-sold under the guise of a CE” approach. There is evidence, for example, that waste-to-energy technologies reliant on incinerators are regularly sold in developing countries that lack proper testing facilities or oversight for the use of such equipment. Access to finance and/or technology is some other potential roadblock in Vietnam’s pathway to CE. Activities associated with “linear” (i.e., non-circular) resource extraction and processing often account for the bulk of financing, foreign exchange earnings, and foreign investment in emerging economies. Resource-led development—which focuses on leveraging the potential investment in, and revenue and jobs from, natural resource sectors—has been a popular goal among foreign investors and even major international donors in recent years. International partners have often been significant supporters of resource-led development: between 2008 and 2015, multilateral development banks (MDBs) provided over US$83 billion in public financing for fossil fuels alone. OECD analysis of private-sector resources mobilized for development reveals that almost half of these resources are focused on energy, industry, mining, and construction (Preston et al., 2019). The above discussion highlights that the restructuring of Vietnam’s economy to enable more “circular” activities will require a major shift in infrastructure, industrial processes, innovation priorities, and more importantly, strong government support. The engagement of many stakeholders, including governmental and nongovernmental organizations, businesses, and research institutes helps to improve supply chain collaboration and sustainability performance in a CE (Sudusinghe & Seuring, 2022). Many steps in the right direction have been taken by Vietnam’s government. In the recent National Congress of Vietnam’s Communist Party in 2021, CE has been fully endorsed as a key national strategic direction in the next decade in order to achieve the SDGs, with emphasis on SDG9 Industry, Innovation, and Infrastructure; SDG11 Responsible Consumption and Production; and SDG13 Climate Change. That is the latest step following national action plans on promoting green, sustainable growth and modernizing rural areas that includes many policies, plans, and actions that fit perfectly with the transition toward a circular economy, especially in the agricultural sector. At a lower level, academic institutions, governmental organizations, and businesses have also been actively involved in the

70

T. Bui et al.

movement. In July 2020, Vietnam National University in Ho Chi Minh City established the Institute of Circular Economy Development, the nation’s first institute on CE. Similar institutes and nongovernmental organizations have also been established such as Da Nang Circular Economy Hub, or the PRO Vietnam (Packaging and Recycling Organization).

5.2

Circular Economy and the Agriculture Sector in Vietnam

Around the world, leading industries have begun to operate on the CE model. According to research by Accenture Strategy, the CE model can open up opportunities worth up to US$4500 billion and create millions of jobs for the global economy by 2030 (Accenture Strategy, 2015). The new job creation is mainly in the manufacturing sector. In Vietnam, CE is more opportunistic in the agriculture sector at present since it is in a transitional phase from producing low-value-added commodities to high-value-added final food products. The application of the CE model is a sustainable development path to achieve two goals: responding to the depletion of resources on the input side and addressing the environmental consequences on the output side. There is relatively minimal attention that has been given to the concept of CE in many low-income and middle-income countries (Halog & Anieke, 2021). Particularly, from a sustainable perspective, CE is hardly applied in developing countries (Ahmed et al., 2022). In the context of resource scarcity and degradation, the CE concept has gained attention in the agricultural sector. In Vietnam, the percentage of people working in the agricultural sector has steadily decreased over time. Yet, it still accounts for 39% in 2020.5 As such, a CE transition in the agricultural sector will take a meaningful and impactful pathway since agriculture contributes to almost 15% of the national GDP and 76% of the population living in rural and mountainous areas (World Development Indicators 2020). In these areas, agricultural labor accounts for 52% of the workforce. Vietnam’s overall agri-food industry (including food processing) is expected to grow further in the coming years, presenting tremendous opportunities for applying CE to realize its full potential and improve the livelihood of small-holder farmers who constitute the majority part of the sector and still produce to earn marginal profits. Vietnam, as a largely agricultural society, does benefit from many traditional practices in agriculture that are naturally circular. For thousands of years, Vietnamese farmers have used cattle manure as organic fertilizers or utilized rice straws for heat and power generation. The challenge thus is to design innovative CE models to systematically scale up these practices and generate tangible benefits for all involved stakeholders.

5

Data retrieved from Statista: https://www.statista.com/topics/5653/agriculture-in-vietnam/, April 2022.

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

71

Over the past 22 years, Vietnam’s agriculture sector has made significant achievements, with an average growth rate of 3.4% per year (World Development Indicators), firmly ensuring domestic food security and agricultural export turnover. During the same period, value-added per worker in the agriculture sector has increased from $541 in 1997 to $1306 in 2019, while the contribution of the sector to national GDP has reduced from 26% to 14% (Word Development Indicators). In recent years between 2015 and 2019, the agriculture sector has shifted positively in the direction of modernization by efficiently reducing the proportion of the farming sector from 49.7% to 46.3%, increasing the proportion of the fishery sector from 22.5% to 25.1%, and increasing the forestry sector from 3% to 4.25% (MARD).6 However, until recent years, the development of the agriculture sector in Vietnam has only been focused on the mass production of output, neglecting the utilization of wastes in the production process, leading to wasteful use of resources and environmental damage. Moving up the value chain, the agriculture sector has the opportunity to integrate the CE model into the production process by utilizing fewer raw materials, reducing the amount of waste to the environment; thus, generating more economic value while achieving sustainable development. It is the nature of the CE to turn waste from producing one product into a resource for producing another product, which is biologically natural in the agriculture sector. For agricultural commodities, CE is applied to the production processes for minimizing, reusing, recycling, and recovering materials at different stages, thus reducing production costs for businesses. This is the main difference from the traditional agricultural economy which is only interested in exploiting resources to maximize production, causing environmental damage. The development of the CE must be associated with technological innovation and R&D. However, because most forms of agricultural production in Vietnam are small-scale and lack forward and backward linkage, there are not many production facilities that apply innovative practices and make use of raw materials efficiently to increase the value-added of agricultural products. For large agricultural production establishments, agribusinesses have applied several technological innovations in the production process to take control of the value chain. However, the number of these businesses is relatively small and currently at different stages of integrating the CE model. Investment activities for building infrastructure to support the CE model only limit to projects that yield immediate and short-term benefits, not including the complete infrastructure system to make the most out of the model in the long run. The next section provides a case study of the PAN Group, one of the most successful agribusinesses in Vietnam that has developed a sustainable development strategy using the CE model.

6

Retrieved from the Ministry of Agriculture and Rural Development (MARD): http://www.mard. gov.vn, April 2022.

72

T. Bui et al.

6 Circular Economy and Sustainable Transformation of the Agricultural Sector: A Case Study of the Pan Group7 6.1

Methodology and Data Collection

In order to thoroughly examine how an emerging economy addresses the concept of circular economy, we deliberately selected a setting that offers a rich context. This context is vital as it can significantly influence the implementation considerations involved in implementing circular economy practices, encompassing unique social, economic, and political factors. We chose Vietnam’s economy as we had access to reliable and trusted sources of information from the company in which we conducted the case study, as well as from primary and secondary external data sources. We conducted an in-depth and interpretive case study approach, focusing on one of the country’s largest and growing agri- and aqua-product companies. This particular company exhibited a proactive and forward-looking management style. However, the group as a whole comprised a diverse range of agricultural farms, some of which were slower in embracing innovation. Due to the relatively new nature of circular economy concepts, limited quantitative data was available. Consequently, employing a qualitative method enabled us to capture the intricacies of this complex industry more effectively. Case studies provide valuable insights into understanding the dynamics of the study (Yin, 2009). We collected primary data through interviews. Through an initial industry analysis and general research on the circular economy in Vietnam, we identified a key informant who guided us in selecting interviewees. This approach is well-documented in the research method literature (Eisenhardt & Graebner, 2007).

6.2

The PAN Group

The PAN Group is an agribusiness established in 1998 with a mission to advance Vietnamese agriculture. As a pioneer, the PAN Group differentiates its business from other large agriculture conglomerates in Vietnam by integrating value chains through acquisitions as an accelerated means to provide people with food security, quality and safety, and nutrition. The company’s vision is an integrated value chain and innovative solutions connecting Farm, Food, Family. Recently, the PAN Group has acquired small- and mid-cap-size companies nationwide and has strategically invested in them with the goal to turn them into sustainable businesses. Acquired companies such as Aquatex Bentre, Bien Hoa Confectionery Corporation (Bibica), 7

This section benefited from interviews with senior executives at the PAN Group and public information available from the company’s website, http://thepangroup.vn. However, the authors are responsible for the information provided in this case study.

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

73

Vinaseed, 554 Nha Trang Seaproduct JSC, Sao Ta Foods JSC, Lafooco, Vietnam Fumigation Company JSC, Golden Beans have become leading sustainable agriculture and food companies under the PAN Group. Green production is the sustainable development strategy of the PAN Group. The PAN Group is a member of the Vietnamese Business Council for Sustainable Development (VBCSD), which is a member of the World Business Council for Sustainable Development. The company is also a member of the Sustainable Trade Project of the World Trade Organization, the UN Food and Agriculture Organization (FAO), and the International Union for Conservation of Nature (IUCN). The Group is committed to economic growth with long-lasting values of sustainability—environmental, social, and corporate governance (ESG). The sustainable development strategy of the PAN Group fits into the framework of CE promoted by the Vietnamese government. One of the main criteria to acquire and invest in companies is the potential to promote CE toward sustainable development. Vietnam currently has approximately 750,000 enterprises, of which only 2000 enterprises are members of VBCSD. This is relatively a small number since CE is still a new concept for many Vietnamese businesses, especially SMEs. The PAN Group is in fact leading the implementation of CE strategies in their business model.

6.3

More Than Meets the Eyes: The Circular Economy in Action

The PAN Group invests in companies through acquisitions to integrate and increase value-added, bringing the highest benefits to all stakeholders while respecting their management, existing resources, and potential development. The PAN Group ensures information transparency and provides the best interests and equality to all shareholders, including minority shareholders. With respect to environmental sustainability, the PAN Group is committed to minimizing negative impacts on the environment. The company has created an environmental management system based on international standards to strictly control the effects of the production process on the environment. Last but not least, the PAN Group’s CSR focuses on creating the best value for employees, customers, partners, suppliers, and communities. The long-term strategy for sustainable growth has yielded significant progress in expanding the agricultural market, developing new products, and strengthening production capacity. The PAN Group’s core business is divided into two subgroups—farm and food, integrating the value chain from inputs to outputs, from local to global through circularity. The Group’s farm business has been built and developed through PAN Farm JSC (PAN Farm), with the comparative advantage of innovative solutions in seeds and agricultural inputs, and advanced farming practices. PAN Farm has partnered with foreign firms and universities in R&D to develop premium inputs, including seeds, sustainable tillage measures, green infrastructure, agritech products,

74

T. Bui et al.

and eco-friendly farming materials that are highly resistant to climate change; thus, addressing the pressing problems of the agricultural sector in Vietnam. On the farming practice side, the Group aims to add value to the products through innovative farming solutions developed internally and acquired from Japanese partners. By applying sustainable certifications in the production process such as Global Gap and Viet Gap to flowers, fruits, vegetables, and rice, the Group provides high quality and safe, traceable products to domestic consumers and exports to high-end markets such as Japan and the EU. The success of PAN Farm is attributed to having a completed and traceable production value chain from seeding, cultivating, processing, preserving, and packaging. The PAN Group’s penetration strategy into the food industry is through PAN Food JSC (PAN Food) with two core segments: everyday food and indulgence food. The everyday food segment targets Vietnamese consumers with traditional products such as packaged rice, frozen seafood, and fish sauces. These products are traceable, high quality, and nutritious at reasonable prices. The indulgence food segment provides products such as confectionery, organic nuts and beans, and other natural foods. This is the strategic segment of the PAN Group in the coming years and is expected to become the fastest-growing segment of the company. The Group has developed a domestic distribution network with more than 137,000 points of sales (POS) and exports to more than 30 countries. There are several challenging factors in the CE-related barrier studies in the food industry, including technological difficulties and R&D deficiency, and problems in innovations (Pannila et al., 2022). A key success of the PAN Group is its commitment to R&D. The R&D team comprises highly respected research institutes and universities in Vietnam and overseas, as well as strategic partners in the agriculture industry, including with leading national university in agricultural research (e.g., Can Tho University, Nong Lam University) and foreign institutions (e.g., KU Leuven, Universiteit Gent, APSA, and Sakata). The Group owns three R&D outlets and 10 testing centers across Vietnam, suitable for testing plant varieties in different climates and soil conditions. In the agricultural sector, R&D emphasis is on plant breeding and biotechnology to develop stable food crops to stabilize the quality and productivity of farmers. In the aquacultural sector, R&D activities focus on fish dietary requirements and nurseries, disease control, efficient aquaculture solutions, and the development of value-added products. In the food sector, the core objectives of R&D are the enhancement of nutrition, food quality and affordability, and the environmental production process through the development of new technology, products, and packaging design. Another example is the effort in the CE that drives the participation of Huro Probiotics, a member of the PAN Group, in a UK research project to develop SPORCOV, a COVID-19 preventive product. Huro Probiotics provides raw materials in the trial stage, but later the company will be responsible for the development of industrial-scale production. The participation of the PAN Group in this scientific research project was the result of the R&D partnership between the Group and researchers at the University of London a few years earlier.

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

75

Both PAN Farm and PAN Food have achieved sustainability in their operations at different stages. In recognizing that these achievements bring tremendous benefits, the model also has its drawbacks. One of the drawbacks is short-term costs. Since the implementation of the CE concept requires substantial initial fixed costs, but the benefits are expected to be materialized over the long run, the company must strike a balance between costs and benefits in order to respond to divergent expectations of its stakeholders, both domestically and internationally. Pannila et al. (2022) argue that one of the most challenges in applying CE concepts to the food supply chain is cost efficiency considerations. Other economic factors mentioned included issues in investments, with respect to scalability and replicability. Economic sustainability must be guaranteed first before social and environmental sustainability can be completed in the CE model. In order to achieve economic sustainability, PAN’s long-term strategy is to penetrate the global markets while sustaining the lucrative local markets, as reflected by the group’s investment portfolio. The Group’s portfolio consists of 55.75% domestic shareholders and 44.25% foreign shareholders. The company seeks to develop strategic partnerships with foreign companies with expertise in agriculture and food, including TAEL Two Partners Ltd. and Sojitz Corporation. These strategic investors support the PAN Group to create a full value chain in the agriculture and food processing industry in Vietnam and to support the company in gaining overseas market access through their global supply chain network. For instance, the business alliance between the PAN Group and Sojitz Corporation provides the opportunity for the company to gain Japanese technological expertise and consumer network in Vietnam at home and abroad in order to create new value. Similarly, Daiwa Security Group’s equity investment in the PAN Group supports the joint venture PAN-SALADBOWL in expanding the market in Japan. The International Finance Corporation (IFC)’s investment in PAN Farm supports the company’s effort on sustainability by applying the strict IFC performance standards on environmental and social responsibility in its agricultural business. In short, by offering equities to international investors, the PAN Group has successfully leveraged best practices in sustainability as well as gained domestic and global market shares. International trade is a core strategic component of the PAN Group. The Group has prepared to capitalize on free trade agreements, including the Vietnam-EU Free Trade Agreement (EVFTA), the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership (CPTPP), and the Regional Comprehensive Economic Partnership (RCEP). In order to gain access to high-end markets in these member countries, businesses in Vietnam must meet the requirements and regulations stipulated in the trade agreements on sanitary and phytosanitary measures such as food safety, animal and plant quarantine; country of origin; rules of origin; environmental and labor standards; and social responsibility. The CE model toward sustainable development has helped the PAN Group position itself as the leading agriculture and food company to enter the toughest export markets. For example, Sao Ta Foods JSC, one of the largest shrimp producers in Vietnam, was immediately capitalized from the EVFTA when the trade agreement came into effect in 2020 thanks to its strict compliance with international standards, including the Aquaculture Stewardship

76

T. Bui et al.

Council (ASC). Only 5% of shrimp producers in Vietnam have this certification. In another example, Vinaseed, a member of the PAN Group, is able to export highquality rice to the EU under its own brands JV Pearl Rice and RVT Fragrant Rice, at a much higher price, due to its comprehensive value chain to ensure the products meet EU standards. Other Vietnamese rice producers export through conventional channels to the EU, involving only hulling and milling, under foreign brands when the products reach the retailers.

6.4

High Cohesion/Low Coupling Strategy as a CE Approach to Supply Chain Design

As an ecosystem, the success of the PAN Group is its respect for the current market structure of the Vietnamese agricultural sector which is historically highly fragmented and firmly anchored in local traditions and best practices. The Group deploys a unique merger-and-acquisition (M&A) strategy that brings in additional financial resources, R&D assistance, and management know-how to assist the businesses that the acquirer to re-invent themselves and to be part of a “group” network to help them reach out to a larger global network. This concept is similar to the design principles in computer software architecture. As a “bottom-up” approach, the Group is, by its very nature, a collection of independent businesses. By bringing new resources—financial, technological know-how, and business best practices— the management “tightens” the cohesiveness of each of the business units so that each could excel in its individual and specific business activity and sustain itself, as a location-dependent business ecosystem. At the corporate level, the PAN Group is a conglomerate of quasi-independent, autonomous farm, and food enterprises with a revamped and tightly cohesive organizational structure. Relationships between all stakeholders of each “local” enterprise are strengthened with a conglomerate policy to promote: (i) shared knowledge, (ii) shared goals, and (iii) mutual understanding and respect. Personnel training to improve the internal quality of communications with a focus on frequency, timeliness, accuracy, and problem-solving (Gittell, 2006). The Group also seeks to ensure best organizational practices promoting cross-functional activities and addressing conflict resolution. The loose coupling between independent business units is to coordinate strategic decisions related to investments, R&D, marketing research, public relations, and coordination mechanisms with an emphasis on synergistic efficiency. In terms of governance, the group plays an advisory role with no major change of management at subsidiaries after the merging. The PAN Group also exerts effort to support management practices consistent with the CE principles. In particular, subsidiarylevel innovation through R&D support, process improvement, quality control, and export market expansion is greatly encouraged. As the Group grows with the acquisition or creation of new business units with new identities and new products,

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

77

Fig. 2 The PAN group CE-based supply chain

the company also attempts to link independent businesses by sharing resources whenever appropriate and opportunistic. This allows for knowledge spill-over and great synergy for mutual benefits among the group members. For example, Shin Cà Phê (Shin Coffee—owned by the Golden Beans) learned greatly from Lafooco’s compliance process to export cashew nuts to Japan. This enables them to gain access to the Japanese market shortly after being acquired by the PAN Group, which would have taken much longer without the knowledge sharing from Lafooco. The high cohesion and low coupling strategy, as illustrated in Fig. 2, allows the PAN Group to establish a corporate structure that facilitates the transformation from a quasi-linear one-directional supply chain structure to a circular one. On the one hand, each “local” node in the supply chain is allowed ample flexibility to craft its own CE strategy based on the very nature of the products it produces and the local ecosystem it is in. Investments are subsidized to develop waste and recycled materials. On the other hand, the synergy at the corporate level enables these nodes to link in a true CE approach where the wastes from one process are utilized as inputs for another. According to the CEO of the PAN Group, the Group has successfully implemented the CE model in the following member companies (The PAN Group)8: • Aquatex Bentre uses pangasius by-products as animal feed and to extract oil. Wastewater from the factories is treated and reused. Water in the ponds is reused according to RAS technology.

8 Retrieved from the PAN Group: https://thepangroup.vn/the-pan-group-from-circular-economy-tosustainable-development-2797.htm, July 2020.

78

T. Bui et al.

• At Sao Ta, shrimp shells and heads are acquired by partners to produce chitin and chitosan which are important materials in agriculture, food, and healthcare industry. • Lafooco’s cashew nut shell has been reused as a kiln fuel. It is also pressed to extract essential oils to use as fuels or film-forming gels in marine paints production and the production of other heat-resistant materials. • 554 Nha Trang sells fish sauce by-products to partners to reuse as fertilizer. • Vinaseed’s rice by-products are reused as a kiln fuel. Rice bran is sold to food and alcohol brewing companies. • At PAN Food and Bibica, confectionery by-products are reused for animal food. The product packaging has a smart design so that consumers can reuse it as utensils or children’s toys. • Solar power systems have been installed at factories to reduce electricity costs and CO2 emissions into the environment. Marketing mix strategies are focused on exports to change production culture to quality versus quantity. The rationale is if the finished products meet the expectations of foreign markets, they would become competitive at home. Fluctuations in production outputs and consumption due to external shocks such as the pandemic and global supply chain disruption can be controlled by promotion planning between domestic and international markets. We close this section with a remark that to secure a sustainable position in a global economy, national companies would not just enter unfamiliar foreign markets as small, unknown, and financially disadvantaged suppliers. The PAN Group has been able to reach out to its foreign partners in a variety of ways, introducing their business units with corresponding foreign investors, international R&D experts, importers, and distributors, to create a self-sustained circular supply chain.

7 Conclusion As if the trade war triggered by the Trump administration has not sufficiently caused chaos to the world’s economy and trade, the looming COVID-19 pandemic has forced individual economies to revisit their respective position in the global supply chain. To reduce interdependence, many companies are looking to repatriate their manufacturing bases or diversify their global manufacturing to more locations beyond China. This strategic move risks being costly and does not necessarily warrant an improvement to the current arrangement. In the short term, replacing the Chinese well-oiled and cost-effective production system is a challenge. In addition, the decades-long supply chain with China relies on a complex modus operandi involving complex air, land, and sea transportation networks, a complex web of financial and trading institutions, and other logistical issues. We argue that attempting to just relocate the Chinese manufacturing system to other neighboring economies would not be enough to capitalize on the new global supply chain.

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

79

We contend that an all-new supply chain system driven by the CE principles would enable the current global structure of supply and demand, from a quasi-linear one-way supply chain arrangement to a honeycomb-like web of circular structure that takes into consideration the national and regional geo-political realities. We conducted a case study of an original agricultural group to explore and propose a conceptual framework for emerging economies to integrate the CE concept and develop a resilient and self-reliant supply chain that minimizes the over-dependence on any trade partners and ensures sustainable development. In just a few years, the PAN Group has acquired an extraordinary comparative advantage. Many of its business units have been able to expand to the global market thanks to its CE-inspired credible value chain traceability from inputs to end-use. A known limitation of a case study is the issue of generalizability. Can the rest of the country duplicate what the PAN Group has successfully done? A typical view from a case study researcher is that it is the reader, and not him/her, to determine what can be learned and applied to his/her context (Stake, 2005). The PAN Group possesses a young cadre of highly-educated leaders with international experience and networking. It also has strong financial backing from solid local and international financial institutions. Success begets success. PAN Group’s CE-inspired model has caught the attention and interest of the highest government-level offices. It remains to be seen how the PAN group will change the entire agricultural sector. It would also be of interest to see how other traditional sectors, e.g., the obsolete manufacturing industry, react to PAN’s successful strategy. In any case, we believe that our proposed CE concept would allow an economy such as Vietnam to move forward, and eventually be able to join the league of advanced economies in Asia.

References Accenture Strategy. (2015). The circular economy could unlock $4.5 trillion of economic growth. Waste to Wealth. Palgrave Macmillan. Ahmed, Z., Mahmud, S., & Acet, H. (2022). Circular economy model for developing countries: Evidence from Bangladesh. Heliyon, 8, e09530. Angelis, D., Roberta, H., Mickey, M., & Joe. (2018). Supply chain management and the circular economy: towards the circular supply chain. Production Planning and Control, 29(6), 425–437. Bakker, C., Wang, F., Huisman, J., & den Hollander, M. (2014). Products that go round: Exploring product life extension through design. Journal of Cleaner Production, 69, 10–16. Batista, L., Bourlakis, M., Liu, Y., Smart, P., & Sohal, A. (2018). Supply chain operations for a circular economy. Production Planning and Control, 29(6), 419–424. Bressanelli, G., Perona, M., & Saccani, N. (2019). Assessing the impacts of circular economy: A framework and an application to the washing machine industry. International Journal of Management and Decision Making, 18(3), 282–308. Bui, T. (1999). Decision support systems for sustainable development: An overview. In G. E. Kersten, Z. Mikolajuk, & A. G. Yeh (Eds.), Decision support systems for sustainable development: A resource book of methods and applications. Kluwer Academic. Cucchiella, F., D’Adamo, I., Koh, L. S. C., & Rosa, P. (2015). Recycling of WEEEs: An economic assessment of present and future e-waste streams. Renewable and Sustainable Energy Reviews, 51, 263–272.

80

T. Bui et al.

Dable-Norris, E., & Zhang, Y. S. (2021). Vietnam: successfully navigating the pandemic. IMF Country Focus. https://www.imf.org/en/News/Articles/2021/03/09/na031021-vietnam-success fully-navigating-the-pandemic Eisenhardt, K. M., & Graebner, M. E. (2007). Theory building from cases: Opportunities and challenges. Academy of Management Journal, 50(1), 25–32. Elia, V., Gnoni, M. M., & Tornese, F. (2017). Measuring circular economy strategies through index methods: A critical analysis. Journal of Cleaner Production, 142, 2741–2751. Ellen MacArthur Foundation. (2012). Towards a circular economy – Economic and business rationale for an accelerated transition. https://ellenmacarthurfoundation.org/towards-acircular-economy-business-rationale-for-an-accelerated-transition. Genovese, A., Acquaye, A. A., Figueroa, A., & Koh, L. S. C. (2017). Sustainable supply chain management and the transition towards a circular economy: Evidence and some applications. Omega, 66, 344–357. Ghisellini, P., Cialani, C., & Ulgiati, S. (2016). A review on circular economy: The expected transition to a balanced interplay of environmental and economic systems. Journal of Cleaner Production, 114, 11–32. Gittell, J. H. (2006). Relational coordination: Coordinating work through relationships of shared goals, shared knowledge and mutual respect. In O. Kyriakidou & M. F. Ozbilgin (Eds.), Regional perspectives in organizational studies. Elgaronline. Halog, A., & Anieke, S. (2021). A review of circular economy studies in developed countries and its potential adoption in developing countries. Circular Economy and Sustainability, 1, 209–230. Hazen, B. T., Russo, I., Confente, I., & Pellathy, D. (2021). Supply chain management for circular economy: Conceptual framework and research agenda. International Journal of Logistics Management, 32(2), 510–537. Kazemi, N., Modak, N. M., & Govindan, K. (2018). A review of reverse logistics and closed loop supply chain management studies. Published in IJPR: A bibliometric and content analysis. International Journal of Production Research, 57(15–16), 4937–4960. Kim, I. S., Liao, S., & Miyan, S. (2020). Why trade and FDI should be studied together? Working Paper. MIT Department of Political Science. Kuch, A. (2022). Building resilience: The impact of the circular economy on global trade and supply chains. Ellen MacArthur Foundation. Retrieved January 12, 2023, from https:// ellenmacarthurfoundation.org/articles/building-resilience Lacy, P., & Rutqvist, J. (2015). The Product as a Service Business Model: Performance over Ownership. In Waste to Wealth. Palgrave Macmillan. Manavalan, E., & Jayakrishna, K. (2019). An analysis of sustainable supply chain for circular economy. Procedia Manufacturing, 33, 477–484. Mashayekhi, R. (2020, December 9). How China has used the pandemic to pull ahead on trade, by the numbers. Fortune. https://fortune.com/2020/12/08/us-china-trade-dynamics-covid-19pandemic/ Ministry of Agriculture and Rural Development (MARD). Retrieved April 2022, from http://www. mard.gov.vn. Mont, O. (2008). Innovative approaches to optimizing design and use of durable consumer goods. International Journal of Product Development, 6(3–4), 227–250. Montag, L. (2022). Circular economy and supply chains: definitions, conceptualizations, and research agenda of the circular supply chain framework. Circular Economy and Sustainability, 3, 35–75. Murray, A., Skene, K., & Haynes, K. (2017). The circular economy: an interdisciplinary exploration of the concept and application in a global context. Journal of Business Ethics, 140(3), 369–380. Ng, A. (2020, July 8). Vietnam’s outlook is ‘one of the brightest’ in Asia, UBS says. CNBC. https:// www.cnbc.com/2020/07/08/vietnams-outlook-is-one-of-the-brightest-in-asia-ubs-says.html Ongondo, F. O., Williams, I. D., Dietrich, J., & Carroll, C. (2013). ICT reuse in socio-economic enterprises. Waste Management, 33(12), 2600–2606.

Reshaping the World’s Supply Chain? A Case Study of Vietnam’s PAN. . .

81

Pandey, A. (2020, April 27). Don’t write off China as world’s factory. DW Made for Minds. https:// www.dw.com/en/after-coronavirus-dont-write-off-china-as-worlds-factory/a-53258107. Pannila, N., Jayalath, M. M., Thibbotwawa, A., Nielsen, I., & Uthpala, T. G. G. (2022). Challenges in applying circular economy concepts to food supply chains. Sustainability, 14, 16536. Parajuly, K., & Wenzel, H. (2017). Potential for circular economy in household WEEE management. Journal of Cleaner Production, 151, 272–285. Preston, F., Lehne, J., & Wellesley, L. (2019). An inclusive circular economy: Priorities for developing countries. Energy, Environment and Resources Department. The Royal Institute of International Affairs, Chatham House. London. Saidani, M., Yannou, B., Leroy, Y., & Cluzel, F. (2018). Heavy vehicles on the road towards the circular economy: Analysis and comparison with the automotive industry. Resources, Conservation and Recycling, 135, 108–122. Schmid, D., & Ritzrau, W. (2018, September). Why the circular economy must link up the whole supply chain. World Economic Forum. https://www.weforum.org/agenda/2018/09/why-thecircular-economy-needs-to-link-up-the-whole-supply-chain. Setser, B.W. (2020, August 20). Falling trade, rising imbalance. Council on Foreign Relations. https://www.cfr.org/blog/falling-trade-rising-imbalances Seuring, S., & Muller, M. (2008). Core issues in sustainable supply chain management – A Delphi study. Business Strategy and the Environment, 17, 455–466. Smith, E. (2020, August 18). U.S. and European firms face $1 trillion in costs to relocate their Chinese supply chains, BofA says. CNBC. https://www.cnbc.com/2020/08/18/bofa-useuropean-firms-face-1-trillion-to-relocate-china-supply-chains.html Stake, R. E. (2005). Qualitative case studies. In N. K. Denzin & Y. S. Lincoln (Eds.), The Sage handbook of qualitative research. Sage. Sudusinghe, J. I., & Seuring, S. (2022). Supply chain collaboration and sustainability performance in circular economy: A systematic literature review. International Journal of Production Economics, 245, 108402. The PAN Group. 2021. From circular economy to sustainable development. http://thepangroup.vn. Tian, W. (2021). How China managed the COVID-19 pandemic. Asian Economic Papers, 20(1), 75–101. Ting-Fang, C., & Li, L. (2020, May 8). Apple to produce millions of AirPods in Vietnam amid pandemic. Nikkei Asia. https://asia.nikkei.com/Business/Technology/Apple-to-produce-mil lions-of-AirPods-in-Vietnam-amid-pandemic. United Nations. (1987). Report of the World Commission on Environment and Development: Our Common Future. UN Brundtland Commission. Winans, K., Kendall, A., & Deng, H. (2017). The history and current applications of the circular economy concept. Renewable and Sustainable Energy Reviews, 68, 825–833. World Bank. (2020a). Vietnam: Doing business 2020, challenges and solutions. The World Bank. https://www.worldbank.org/en/news/speech/2020/01/08/speech-by-ousmane-dione-worldbank-country-director-for-vietnam-at-the-event-vietnam-doing-business-2020-challenges-andsolutions World Bank. (2020b). Vietnam’s development strategy for the next decade must put productivity growth front and center: Report. The World Bank. https://www.worldbank.org/en/news/pressrelease/2020/05/27/vietnams-development-strategy-for-next-decade-must-put-productivitygrowth-front-and-center-report World Development Indicators. (2020). The World Bank, Washington, DC Yin, R. K. (2009). Case study research: Design and methods (4th ed.). Sage.

82

T. Bui et al.

Tung Bui is a Matson Navigation Company Chair of Global Business and a Professor of IT Management, Shidler College of Business, University of Hawaii at Manoa. His research focuses on the effective management of organizations, supply chain management, and sustainable development. Quan Vu Le is an Academic Director of HKU Vietnam, University of Hong Kong, a Professor of Economics, and a Senior Researcher, Institute for Circular Economy Development, VNU-HCMC. His research focuses on entrepreneurship, governance, and sustainability. Jason Nguyen is an Assistant Professor of Operations Management, Ivey Business School, Western University. His research focuses on environmental regulations, policies, and incentive mechanisms that influence businesses’ operational decisions.

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A Business Model Suggestion Çağla Demir Pali

Abstract Sustainable Development Goals, introduced by the United Nations, guide governments and companies in the field of sustainability and draw attention to priority issues. Within the scope of this study, a business model has been developed to integrate internal audit and sustainability functions in order to achieve the goals of Responsible Consumption, and Production, Climate Action, Industry, Innovation, and Infrastructure. The processes regarding the purchase and use of raw materials have been examined, suggestions have been developed to solve the identified problems, and a business model was developed. This business model put into practice in an international textile company operating, and it is aimed that this developed model will guide companies operating in different sectors to develop smart strategies on their sustainability journeys.

1 Introduction Internal audit has the purpose of improving and adding value to the organizations’ operations, as well as evaluating and, if necessary, improving the effectiveness of risk management, control, and governance processes. The changing nature of the business and the demands of the stakeholders are reshaping the internal audit. By preserving the independence of the business audit function, efficient use of internal resources is encouraged by working in cooperation with other departments. Sustainability efforts are one of the areas that internal auditors can benefit to and benefit from by communicating and interacting with other departments. Especially in recent years, the importance attached to sustainability by companies has increased. Establishing sustainability departments, implementing and adopting sustainability practices within the companies, and efforts to achieve the planned results have been one of the main focuses of the companies.

Ç. Demir Pali (✉) Yeditepe University, Ataşehir/İstanbul, Turkey e-mail: [email protected] © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2023 P. Arte et al. (eds.), Sustainable International Business, Contributions to Management Science, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-43785-4_5

83

84

Ç. Demir Pali

Issues such as the effective use of resources and the prevention of waste, which are among the fields of sustainability, are also among the working fields of the internal audit departments. As a result of the internal audit and sustainability departments working together, benefits such as bringing together different areas of expertise, preventing overlapping and duplication of tasks from being done by more than one department, and improving interdepartmental communication can be achieved. This study aims to integrate the internal audit department’s engagement with the sustainability department’s work plan on inventory purchases. The study is focused on dyed fabric inventories to determine the share of idle dyed fabric in total purchasing in terms of quantity, investigate the reasons, and analyze the effects of those extra purchases on Sustainable Development Goals (“SDGs”) such as Responsible Consumption and Production, Climate Action and Industry, Innovation and Infrastructure perceptions and propose a business model. This model, which offers a way to reduce the efforts of companies to fulfill the requirements of country-based and international regulations, is aimed to support international business practices and patterns to develop smart strategies.

2 Literature Review 2.1

Sustainability and Sustainable Development Goals

In the United Nations (“UN”) Brundtland Commission report (United Nations, 1987) (also known as “Our Common Future: Report of the World Commission on Environment and Development”) the major objective of development is stated as the satisfaction of human needs and aspirations. In the same report, sustainability is defined as “meeting the needs of the present without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs.” Since then, countries have been collaborating their efforts on the subject and focusing on it in three main areas: environment, society, and governance (“ESG”). International Finance Corporation (“IFC”) (2021) defines ESG as factors considered by investors in decisions related to investments and by companies in managing day-to-day operations. The environment includes how a company positions itself in protecting the environment, its activities on carbon emissions, water, and waste management, raw material procurement processes, and climate change (Institute of Internal Auditors, 2021, p. 5). Those all have actual or potential effects on the physical and natural environment (IFC, 2021, p. 13). Social, on the other hand, covers how businesses manage their relationships with their staff, customers, and other parties in the business environment. Risks related to corporate social responsibility, data security, security, and health and business relations fall under this topic. Governance encompasses areas such as leadership, internal controls, ethics, intellectual capital, and stakeholder protection (Institute of Internal Auditors, 2021, p. 5).

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A. . .

85

Since 1992, countries and the UN, including the UN Department of Economic and Social Affairs, work on building a global partnership for sustainable development. In September 2015 at the UN Sustainable Development Summit in New York “Transforming Our World: The 2030 Agenda for Sustainable Development” was adopted which contains 17 Sustainable Development Goals. Those goals are to invite all developed and developing countries to action to work on prosperity and peace for people and the planet. Countries are called to establish strategies to end poverty and other deprivations, improvements in health, education, and economic growth, and reductions in inequality. Preservation of oceans and forests, and climate change are the other main focuses of the goals (UN, n.d.-a). Policy changes, incentives, and regulations are needed at the country level for global improvement. But it is possible to make these improvements at the company level with company-specific developments. Companies can and should work to achieve these goals by applying proper internal regulations and controls without waiting for governments to make them. For this purpose, studies and analyses should be made in the field of environment, society, and governance, and developments should be supported by new business models that will emerge. This chapter proposes a new business model to reach the Responsible Consumption and Production goal and considering that all sustainable development goals interact with each other, it is also aimed to make progress on Climate Action and Industry, Innovation, and Infrastructure goals. In this context, Responsible Consumption and Production, Climate Action and Industry, Innovation and Infrastructure goals are briefly explained below.

2.1.1

Responsible Consumption and Production

“Sustainable consumption and production is about doing more and better with less.” Although the main goal is preventing the degradation of the environment for economic growth, contributions can be done to reduce the poverty and encourage a transition toward low-carbon and green economies. Increasing resource efficiency and encouraging sustainable lifestyles are some of the ways stated to reach the goal (UN, n.d.-b). Implementation of a 10-year framework program to reach the goal is one of the targets determined by the UN. Also, other targets determined to be reached by 2030 are the achievement of sustainable management and efficient use of natural sources; reducing the food losses on production, supply chain, and post-harvest; reducing the waste generation through prevention, reduction, recycling, and reuse; and educating people on sustainable development and encourage them to change their lifestyles to be in harmony with nature. Revising the national priorities and policies to promote sustainable public procurement practices; encouraging companies to adapt sustainable practices and integrate them into their reporting cycle; supporting the developing countries to improve their technical and technological capacity to have more sustainable patterns of consumption and production; promoting sustainable tourism to create jobs and raise local culture and products; reducing the release of chemicals

86

Ç. Demir Pali

to atmosphere, water, and soil to minimize their negative effects; and reducing the use of fossil-fuel subsidies are targeted. To reach those targets, developed countries are encouraged to take the lead (UN, n.d.-b).

2.1.2

Climate Action

This goal is about reducing the effects of climate-related natural disasters and hazards, improving education, and enhancing awareness on climate change. It has been targeted to make improvements in education, awareness-raising, and personal and organizational capacity on early warning, impact reduction, climate change adaption, and mitigation. It has been aimed to integrate measures for climate change by national policies, strategies, and plans; increase the mitigation, adaptation, impact reduction, and early warning capacity of the institutions and humans; and for the least developed countries and small island developing states promoting mechanisms for raising capacity to set climate change-related plans and management tools effectively. The financial target of the goal is the implementation of the Green Climate Fund to address the needs of developing countries (UN, n.d.-c). In a study published by Deloitte (2013) it is stated that to maximize a company’s value, it is important to pursue stakeholder value and work to keep the environment healthy. From this perspective, climate action is one of the goals that is closely related to all other goals and has a significant impact on all of them.

2.1.3

Industries, Innovation, and Infrastructure

This goal is basically about improvements in economic welfare, industrial development, technology, and science. By considering national circumstances, promoting sustainable and inclusive industrialization, upgrading infrastructure, and strengthening industries to make them more sustainable are some of the targets of the goal. Increasing efficiency on resource use and adopting clean and environment-friendly technologies and industrial processes are the ways determined to reach these targets (UN, n.d.-d). Providing affordable loans to small-scale entities, especially in developing countries, and integrating them into value chains and markets are another target of the goal. To support economic development, it is aimed to develop reliable, resilient, and sustainable infrastructure. It is also targeted to support scientific research to upgrade the technological capabilities of industries by encouraging innovation and increasing the number of research and development workers; and domestic technology development, innovation, and research by policies in developing countries. To support the least developed countries, sustainable and resilient infrastructure development and increase their access to communication technologies, information, and the Internet are aimed (UN, n.d.-d).

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A. . .

2.2

87

Internal Audit

Since the introduction of formal record-keeping systems, there have been concerns about the recording of receipts and disbursements and collecting taxes. Traces of auditing can go back to controls for checks and counterchecks in public finance systems in Babylonia, Greece, the Roman Empire, and the City States of Italy. Needs for controls arose from the governments’ worries about the possibility of booking errors by incompetent officials and attempts of fraud when the opportunity arose (Ramamoorti, 2003, p. 3). Auditing professionals existed in ancient China and Egypt as supervisors of the accounts of the Chinese Emperor and the Egyptian Pharaoh (Hayes, 2005, p. 2). Verification of receipts of merchants for grain brought to the market is viewed as the root of internal auditing by historians (The Institute of Internal Auditors, n.d.-a). The need for independent verification to reduce asset misappropriation, fraud, and record-keeping errors is some of the main reasons for the demand for auditing. Since the complexity, size, and scope of business functions have grown, there emerged the need to verify accounting information to make it a better decision-making tool. Also, the distance between the business owners and reporting parties has made it a necessity to create an objective and independent party inside the organizations to be the “eyes and ears” of the management (Ramamoorti, 2003, p. 2–4). With the expansion of corporate business in the nineteenth and twentieth centuries, the importance of the internal audit has attracted attention and grew to meet the expectations of the related parties. The founding of The Institute of Internal Auditors (IIA) (n.d.-a) is seen by many as the genesis of internal audit. In 1941, IIA (n.d.-a) is established as the “profession’s global voice, recognized authority, acknowledged leader, chief advocate, and principal educator.” Being under an inclusive roof in this way has increased the awareness on internal audit and the prestige of the profession. Also, the enhancement of awareness and prestige has supported its spread. The IIA’s International Professional Practices Framework (IPPF) (n.d.-b) defined the internal audit as “an independent, objective assurance and consulting activity designed to add value and improve an organization’s operations. It helps an organization accomplish its objectives by bringing a systematic, disciplined approach to evaluate and improve the effectiveness of risk management, control, and governance processes.” Responsibilities of the auditors are defined by the IIA (n.d.-a) and can be summarized in three categories: • As an observer: Analyzing opportunities, evaluating emerging technologies, and examining global issues. • As an advisor: Assessing risks and controls to assure that necessary controls are in place to mitigate the significant risks and assess ethics, quality, and efficiency. Since auditors can evaluate the companies from a broad perspective, they can provide data on strengthening internal controls and organizational governance.

88

Ç. Demir Pali

• As an information center: Communicating information and results with clarity and accuracy to the intended users and being a valuable source for the management and boards of directors on accomplishing goals and objectives of the company. Since the internal auditors possess knowledge about the activities of companies (especially financial issues) and are authorized and experienced in accessing and analyzing data, they can carry out effective studies in areas such as sustainability.

3 Role of Internal Auditors in Sustainability Practices As explained earlier, one of the purposes of an internal audit is to add value to the company and to make its activities more effective. Company value can be measured and analyzed in multiple ways, but the stakeholder perspective is perhaps the most important. Because the loss of value of companies in the eyes of their stakeholders can have an impact on environment, society, and governance areas and may end the life of the business, it is vital for companies to find funds for the continuation of their activities, to maintain relations with customers and employees, and to make the right decisions to use existing resources most effectively. The importance of the disclosures to inform the shareholders in the best way is increasing day by day and regulations are being made by various institutions in this regard. In line with the demands and needs of information users in ESG areas, standard setters in the field of accounting also have taken action and started to work to guide the reporting and disclosure of financial and non-financial metrics. First of all, the International Sustainability Standards Board (ISSB) was established at the end of 2021 to meet the needs of information users for reliable, quality, comparable, and transparent information. In 2021, the Value Reporting Foundation (VRF) is founded as a non-profit global organization for “ a comprehensive suite of resources designed to help businesses and investors develop a shared understanding of enterprise value—how it is created, preserved or eroded over time” (The International Financial Reporting Standards Foundation, n.d.). On July 1, 2022, the consolidation of VRF to IFRS Foundation started. According to KPMG’s report (2022), 96% of G2501 companies report on sustainability topics and 71% of N1002 companies identify material ESG topics. Due to the increase in interest in this field and the regulations, companies have ample work to do, and teams will need to show the best performance against possible errors and deficiencies. As the assurance providing and advising body, internal audit can play an important role in companies’ ESG reporting and sustainability matters. Internal audit departments also play an active role in matters such as the ESG strategies, risk appetites, and focal points of the companies in the field of ESG. Risk

1 2

The G250 refers to the largest 250 companies by revenue based on the 2021 Fortune 500 ranking. The N100 refers to a sample of the top 100 companies in 58 countries by revenue.

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A. . .

89

management, which is one of the working areas of internal auditors, also covers the field of ESG and requires auditors to take risks associated with ESG into account (McClure & Stone, 2022). As in all other risk management activities, issues such as where the data comes from, whom it belongs to, who approves it, to whom it is reported, what controls are in place, and the approval process before its publication are among the questions that fall within the scope of the work of auditors. As the internal audit department seeks answers to these questions, it examines whether the necessary controls are in place (McClure & Stone, 2022). In Gartner’s study (2022) “2023 Audit Plan Hot Spots” ESG is determined as one of the risk areas. ESG was on the list in the previous year due to an increase in regulatory action and an increase in investment commitment to ESG matters. The reason for 2023 is the necessity for the companies to establish meaningful policies to follow all the regulations and avoid greenwashing accusations because of the increased stakeholder scrutiny.

4 Case Study 4.1

Company Profile

TYH Textile (“TYH” or “Company”) is an international garment producer and exporter since 2000 and has more than 5000 employees. The company’s production capacity is over 20 million pieces per year and has 12 facilities in Turkey (including factories and warehouses) and two sales offices abroad (in the USA and Netherlands). The company has a leading role in the industry and guides other companies in improving their business practices. The company always maintains a large amount of inventory in its warehouses to avoid any disruptions in its production activities. Customized purchases are made for each order as they differ in detail, but the inventory items in the warehouses of the company are generally raw yarn, dyed yarn, raw fabric, dyed fabric, and accessories (button, label, zipper, rubber, bead, etc.). Inventory movement in the company’s facilities changes with the inventory type. Raw yarn, dyed yarn, raw fabric, or dyed fabric are purchased based on the qualifications required. If it is the raw yarn that is purchased, it is sent to the dyehouse for dyeing and then to the knitter for knitting. If the dyed yarn is purchased, it is sent directly to the knitter. In some cases, instead of raw or dyed yarn, the raw fabric is sent to the dyehouse for the dyeing process. The last and easy option is buying dyed fabric as ready-to-use raw material. As can be seen, a high number of processes, transfers, and chemicals are required to obtain dyed fabric, and therefore, a very important environmental impact arises with every purchase. Production starts with sending the dyed fabric to the facility for cutting and ends with sewing and packaging. The company has enough machinery and equipment for cutting, sewing, and packaging in some locations but in some cases because of

90

Ç. Demir Pali

backlogs or other reasons, all these steps are completed in different locations owned by the company or outsourcing companies’ facilities. The company has a wide customer portfolio and exports to many countries in Europe, mainly to Germany. Customers differ in many aspects such as ordering periods and production method preferences. But in general, it has close and trusting relationships with its customers that have been going on for many years. Customers differ based on ordering periods. The first group of customers placed their orders 1 year in advance so the company can plan the purchases and production earlier. It has advantages for the company since raw materials can be bought at lower prices (since there is enough time to bargain and consider alternative suppliers with better prices) and there is enough time to test them properly to obtain the best quality raw materials (testing the quality and color of the fabric is a time-consuming process). Although purchasing raw materials in high volumes when quality fabrics are bought at reasonable prices is advantageous financially, it can also be a disadvantage because of the high storage costs and difficulties keeping the inventories in good condition. Another similar customer group prefers repeated orders that have the same qualifications. For that type of orders, inventories are bought in advance too for better prices since there is time for bargaining. Last-minute purchases can be costly because of the additional costs charged for changes in suppliers’ production plans. The third group of customers makes their orders without a clear time pattern. Lack of time to bargain on price and quality in the purchase of raw materials is a disadvantage for this group, but it is also an advantage that stocks do not need to be kept in warehouses for a long time. As it can be seen, since the company serves different customer groups, there are limitations on both managing the cost of storage and keeping the inventory in good shape, as well as the ability to purchase affordable and qualified raw materials when they are needed for production. Customers can also be grouped for their preferences of production facilities since the company does not only make in-house production but also work with outsourcing companies in different stages of the production process. For some customers, all production processes (cutting, sewing, packaging, etc.) are completed in-house, while for others production processes are outsourced to subcontractors that are inspected and approved by the customers. Therefore, the way of doing business changes based on the customer group. In-house production has some cost and planning advantages. In that method, all production processes are under the control of the company. But working with an outsourcing company has its advantages, such as in busy season company runs out of capacity and it can be covered with an outsourcer; working on featured pieces like special fabrics and using special sewing technics can cause extra costs and risks (ruining the raw materials for not using an appropriate method or making errors that can cause errors in the production process) if the job is done in-house (specialized outsource companies can do better jobs); transportation of the raw materials is costly and causes high carbon emissions (since the company’s some production facilities are far from each other, it is more beneficial to work with an outsourcing company closer to the facilities).

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A. . .

91

There are also disadvantages of this model since it is not possible to control the amount of waste in cutting, sewing, and packaging if this work is done by a subcontractor. One of the main problems with the issue is the difference between the measurement units of the sent and received inventory. Fabrics sent to subcontractors for cutting are measured by kilograms, but they come back in pieces. Thus, it is hard to compare the inventory sent and received back to control the waste amount and control the efficiency to reduce waste. Another disadvantage is the coordination difficulties in transfer operations between the company’s facilities and subcontractors in different locations. Extra costs can occur, and the company takes other risks in transportation. Also, since a problem in a step directly affects the next one, when a problem occurs in the transportation process or a subcontractor’s production facilities, it causes delays in production and the delivery of the order is postponed to a later time than the planned term. If the company works with subcontractors, it is necessary to keep the inventory in their warehouses to be ready for production. For this reason, inventory storagerelated risks arise from outside parties and accordingly a strict follow-up is required to keep the inventory under control and in good condition.

4.2

Company’s Sustainability Perspective

A sustainability planning team consisting of 10 members from various departments was established in 2021. The company’s procedures were analyzed and documented under the leadership of an experienced advisor. Metrics to measure the sustainability performance of the company are identified and announced to the related departments to improve their procedures. Presentations are made to the management to show the current position, plans, potential effects of the plans, and expected costs for improvements related to those plans. The impact analysis was performed to examine the relationship between the organization and the environment, the society within which it operates, suppliers, customers, and other members of the industry. That way what is taken from the environment and society is compared with what is given and how the resources are used. After careful consideration, it is determined that the company’s biggest effect is related to the industry’s way of operating, how the product is made and reaches the end-users, use and disposal of materials. On the other hand, it is determined that the company has strong relationships with society as it contributes to social well-being by employing a high number of people from local communities and provides social benefits to the cities where the facilities are located. The first stage of the sustainability planning efforts concluded in September 2021. Team members were appointed to lead the work on the topics under their responsibilities and expertise. Completed works and plans were presented to the top management and key employees in a meeting and then the field studies have started.

92

Ç. Demir Pali

As of September 2022, the team was working on 10 targets (energy efficiency, net zero (for all production and operations), use of sustainable production materials, circular products/services, sustainable facilities, efficient and digitalized processes, empowerment of employees, community welfare development, industrial leadership, zero waste) under 8 aspects (energy, materials and water, facilities, processes, employees, society, industry, waste, and products and services). To measure the sustainability performance of the company, 66 metrics are identified as performance criteria. These metrics were developed in-house as a result of the review and research conducted by the sustainability team under the leadership of the advisor. A sustainability report will be prepared for the year 2022.

4.3

Company’s Internal Audit Department

The company has an internal audit department since 2012. In the department, an internal audit manager and an auditor are employed who are also members of the sustainability team, and both have a financial background. Organizing and doing inventory counts, analyzing the efficiency of operations, evaluating internal controls, auditing accounting records, auditing export and import transactions, analyzing production efficiency and error reports in production, supervising official declarations, and analysis of procedures are some main duties of the department. Also, ad-hoc reports and extra audit work depend on the requests from the board. Inventory and inventory-related activities are one of the main areas of focus for the team, as inventories are very important for the continuation of production, as they are high in volume and value, and have tracking and controlling challenges. For sustainability purposes, the team especially has focused on control of inventory purchases (purchase price and extra purchases, etc.), inventory counts (ensuring the inventory lists are prepared completely and correctly and inventory is kept in good condition), and analysis of the inventory purchases and production efficiency to make improvements to achieve waste elimination. With the implementation of this audit work, it is aimed to make the production activities of the company (starting from the raw material supply) efficient, and it is aimed to contribute to the goal of Responsible Consumption and Production. Also, keeping the raw material purchasing processes under control and preventing unnecessary purchases and consumptions will lead to a decrease in the consumption of chemicals that are very harmful to the environment and unnecessary production that does not reach the end-users. In this way, support will be provided for the sustainability studies carried out in the company to achieve its “Climate Action” goal. In addition, the company is a role model in the industry, implementing a good practice example will also affect the way of doing business with other players in the industry, it will also serve as a tool in achieving the “Industries, Innovation and Infrastructure” goal.

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A. . .

4.4

93

Analysis of Inventory Purchases and Waste Inventory

Since the internal audit staff in the company is also members of the sustainability team, they were focused to increase the efficiency of their work by avoiding the reperformance of the same or similar jobs. Since it is one of the most important assets of the company due to its economic value and effect on future production (production processes cannot continue smoothly without ready-to-use raw materials on time) they were focused on the inventory first. Dyed fabric stocks have been chosen and examined in this study because of their high cost and quantity, and their significant impact on the environment until they reach the dyed fabric stage (high economic and environmental effect). As it is explained earlier, the company must keep high levels of inventory for the potential orders of specific customers but also it is important to have inventories on hand for the production in progress. Production lines must be kept working to maintain efficiency and avoid the cost of wasting time and other resources (some subcontractors rent the production line, so even if the line is empty, payment is required). But it is also risky to keep extra fabrics in the warehouses because fabrics are delicate and can be damaged easily. Another risk is that they get obsolete easily (generally fabrics are produced order specific, if an order is cancelled the fabrics purchased for that cannot be used for another. Or changes in fashion cause a change in customer preferences in color and material choices. Therefore, some fabrics cannot be used in the next year because of their color, knitting, or yarn type). Due to its high proportion in all assets, the inventory account is an important element in terms of auditing. Keeping inventories at the optimal level and avoiding unnecessary purchases is a goal of internal audit for cost management, inventory management, and efficiency purposes. Also, the efficiency and effectiveness of purchase processes are being reviewed and internal controls are being evaluated regularly. With the additional requirements of a sustainability planning project, inventory purchases and inventory levels must be evaluated carefully to avoid waste and reach the responsible consumption and production target. In addition to this target, due to the high level of effect of climate change with the use of chemicals, cotton, and water, the company needs to find ways to manage the purchases and inventory levels efficiently. Since the company has a leading role in the industry, the company’s way of doing innovative business will set an example for its competitors and may create an exponentially growing effect. The company has different kinds of inventories such as raw materials (raw yarn, dyed yarn, raw fabric, dyed fabric, accessories, and production supplies), work-inprogress inventory (cut fabric), and finished goods (ready-to-sale apparel). Based on previous experience, it is known that the main areas where most waste occurs are unnecessary inventory purchases and erroneous production. Since the analysis of inventory purchases is already in the yearly audit plan it is decided to focus on that area in particular. As the most expensive raw material, dyed fabric inventory was chosen to work on.

94

Ç. Demir Pali

The average purchase price for dyed fabric is 7.46 € per kg and 6.77 € per kg for 2021 and 2020, respectively. Because of these high prices, unnecessary fabrics that are purchased have a significant negative effect on the company’s financial statements. The usage of the high amount of water in the production of cotton and other processes, the use of chemicals in the production of dyed fabrics, and carbon emission related to transportation affect the environment in a negative way which also does not comply with the plans of the company on achieving the targets on Responsible Consumption and Production, Climate Action and Industry, Innovation and Infrastructure. As the first step of the study, all dyed fabric purchases that were accepted to the warehouses were calculated. Most purchased dyed fabric inventory is measured in kilograms and that inventory purchases amount to 5,897,543 kg for the year 2021 and 3,145,652 kg for the year 2020 (arrival date is used for categorization since it can take more than 1 month for dyed fabrics to reach the warehouses after the order is given). There were also dyed fabric purchases measured in meters, 44,552 m for the year 2021 and 30,017 m for the year 2020. 1 m of dyed fabric weighs approximately 250 g. The inventory list of the dyed fabric and purchase list are gathered on 29 September 2022 (for 2021 and 2020) and are compared based on the batch number (which is a unique number provided by suppliers). After the comparison, it is found that 4.59% of the 5,897,543 kg (270,470 kg) for 2021 and 2.64% of 3,145,652 kg (82,893 kg) for 2020 were still in the inventory. Also, 4.44% of the 44,552 meters (1978 meters) for 2021 and 4.03% of 30,017 meters (1210 m) for 2020 were still in the inventory. Under the company policy, dyed fabrics that are not foreseen to be used in the future are sold to various companies. That is why these sales are also added to the analysis as 136,523 kg for 2021 and 84,370 kg for 2020. In total (total of remaining and sold dyed fabrics), 6.90% of all purchases for 2021 and 5.32% of all purchases for 2020 are waste dyed fabrics. Also, 690 meters of the 44,552 m (1.55%) for 2021 and 240 m of 30,017 m (0.80%) for 2020 are sold because they cannot be used in production. Please see Table 1 for the results. Reasons for the waste of dyed fabrics are determined after the inquiries and reviews as follows: 1. Minimum order requirements of suppliers—Most of the suppliers do not accept orders of less than 30 kg. Because of that, extra fabrics are ordered for sample production, and they remain in inventory. 2. Ignorance and incompetency of purchasing staff—Ordering the same dyed fabric that is already in the warehouse without checking the stocks. Since it will take time to check the suitability of the raw fabrics in the warehouses, it has been determined that purchasing personnel take the easy way out and place new orders. In addition, employees, especially new hires, do not pay enough attention because they are not informed about the amount of unnecessary stock left in the warehouses and the results (economical and environmental) of these practices.

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A. . .

95

Table 1 Waste inventory analysis in kilograms and meters Purchases (kilogram) Remaining dyed fabrics (kilogram) Share of remaining dyed fabrics in total purchases Sold dyed fabrics (kilogram) Share of sold dyed fabrics in total purchases Total of remaining and sold dyed fabrics (kilogram) Share of remaining dyed fabrics in total purchases Purchases (meter) Remaining dyed fabrics (meter) Share of remaining dyed fabrics in total purchases Sold dyed fabrics (meter) Share of sold dyed fabrics in total purchases Total of remaining and sold dyed fabrics (meter) Share of remaining dyed fabrics in total purchases

2021 5,897,543 270,470 4.59% 136,523 2.31% 406,993 6.90% 44,552 1978 4.44% 690 1.55% 2668 5.99%

2020 3,145,652 82,893 2.64% 84,370 2.68% 167,263 5.32% 30,017 1210 4.03% 240 0.80% 1450 4.83%

Inventory details are recorded in the software which is used by all departments. Because of the inaccurate inventory details (typos, missing information, use of different wording, etc.), new fabrics are ordered by purchasing department even if that particular inventory exists in warehouses (they use keywords or fabric qualifications for search). The production department is misled by the same inaccurate inventory details either. In the production phase when there is not enough raw material in the production site, it is checked whether there is any raw material that can be used. If the records show that there is no appropriate inventory in warehouses extra fabrics are ordered. It causes two problems; the first one is the unnecessary purchase of inventory. The second one is the minimum order requirements of suppliers. Even when just 10 kg is needed, more inventories should be ordered for the supplier to meet the order. Because of these unnecessary purchases extra dyed fabric inventory is doubled. 3. Retention and accumulation of safety inventory—When an order is received from a customer, the amount of fabric required for production is calculated and purchases are made more than the need determined. The primary reason for these extra purchases is to compensate for possible production flaws that may arise in production. The second reason is that in production planning, production plans are made more than the number of orders. The customers accept up to 5% over their order quantity when the finished goods are delivered before the due date. Manufacturing companies want to use that option and manufacture 5% more than the order quantity anticipating that they deliver the order before the due date. That’s why they order raw materials for that extra 5% production. It is determined that some of these extra purchases (purchased for possible over-loading quantities) are returned from production or not even sent to production facilities and remained in the warehouses.

96

Ç. Demir Pali

4. Order cancellations—Some orders are cancelled by the customers. In that case, if the raw materials are purchased beforehand, they remain in the inventory. The cost of that inventory is generally invoiced to the customers and that way financial loss is covered. But the fabric is already produced, and resources are already consumed, and because of that it is not possible to cover the environmental effects. After identifying the reasons for inefficiencies in the purchasing phase, inquiries are made, and the financial and environmental effects of these actions are discussed. The results of those inefficiencies are summarized below: 1. A high amount of inactive inventory remains in the warehouses—In addition to the raw materials required for production (new and necessary), the company has a very high amount of inventory in warehouses because of the accumulation of remaining inventory as a result of the unnecessary purchases. It causes two main problems. The first one is related to warehouse conditions. It is very important to keep fabrics in good condition. Humidity levels and temperature need to be under control and fabrics should not be stored on top of each other for long periods. In that case, fabrics lose their form and visible defects occur. Because of that, accumulated unused inventories in the warehouses damage other usable fabrics. The second problem is related to the limited storage area. Because of that problem, some inventories are stored in external service providers, and it causes new problems such as additional risks, control challenges, and difficulty of access. 2. Storage expenses—As it is mentioned before since the company’s storage place is limited, additional space needs to be rented to keep the fabrics safe. If unused inventories do not have to be kept in warehouses, the need to rent additional space for storage may be reduced or even eliminated. 3. Financial losses—Dyed fabric is a significant cost element of production. As it is mentioned before average purchase price for dyed fabric is 7.46 € per kg for the year 2021 and 6.77 € per kg for the year 2020. The average cost of remaining inventory and inventory sold with loss (as it is seen in the table, unused dyed fabrics are sold at low prices, 0.76 € per kg for 2021, 0.75 € per kg for 2020) is calculated and presented in Table 2 as follows. Since the company operates in Turkey, the remaining fabrics are sold in Turkish Lira (TL). The average selling price is 7 TL in 2021 and 6 TL in 2020 but it seems to have decreased due to the increase in the euro/TL currency exchange rate. 4. Environmental losses—Unused dyed fabrics can be sold at a lower price than the purchase cost, and in this way, some of the financial loss can be covered. However, it is not possible to monitor how the sold fabrics are processed afterward, and their environmental impact cannot be measured. Even if the effect cannot be measured, it is known that since it will not be possible to recycle dyed fabrics with zero loss, irreversible damage is caused to nature due to wasted raw materials. In addition, since it is necessary to process it for recycling,

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A. . .

97

Table 2 Cost of waste inventory for 2021 and 2020 Average purchase price per kg Remaining inventory (kilogram) Average total cost of remaining inventory Sold inventory (kilogram) Average total cost of sold inventory Average selling price of unused inventory Average sales revenue of unused inventory Loss of unused dyed fabric sales Total financial loss

2021 €7.46 270,470 €2,017,706 136,523 €1,018,462 €0.67 €91,276 €927,185 €2,944,892

2020 €6.77 82,893 €561,186 84,370 €571,185 €0.75 €63,199 €507,986 €1,069,172

environmental effects will also arise from recycling processes. Therefore, all unnecessary purchases have exponentially increased environmental impacts. 5. Unnecessary transportation costs and carbon emissions—Dyed fabric production is a long, chemical-consuming, and complex process. The yarns to be used are mostly imported from abroad and then dyeing and knitting require transportation because they go through various stages (dyehouse, knitter) in external parties. The transportation costs and the resulting carbon emissions for dyed fabrics that are produced but not turned into a finished good are completely unnecessary and cause significant financial and environmental damage. 6. Control and follow-up problems—Due to the complex processes described earlier, it is very difficult to keep track of the dyed fabric inventory (the whole process from raw yarn purchase to dyed fabric) under control. For this reason, as the inventory amount increases, more control and follow-up difficulties will arise, and potential errors will occur. Unnecessary dyed fabric purchases cause problems in this area as well, and some of the stock follow-up efforts are spent on the follow-up of fabrics that will not benefit the company. For example, the internal audit department performs systematic and sometimes random inventory counts at the end of each quarter. During these counts, the inventory lists of the warehouses are gathered, and the counts are completed by choosing random samples. No distinction is made whether the selected inventories are necessary or unnecessary for production, and all the inventory in the warehouses is audited. When problems are encountered, time and effort are spent to solve them. Due to the unnecessary stocks in the warehouses, there are unnecessary increases in audit work. By keeping stocks under control and preventing unnecessary stock accumulation, it is possible to prevent labor inefficiency due to auditing and counting unused stocks. As can be seen in the explanations above, the disruptions and problems experienced in the purchasing process have a chain effect. A significant amount of financial and environmental damage occurs because of both unnecessary purchases and storing of unusable raw materials. As a result of examining the causes and effects, it was decided to change the business model of the company. Efforts have been made to ensure that the new

98

Ç. Demir Pali

business model is innovative and exemplary in the industry, compatible with responsible consumption and production goals, and planned in a way that will limit the negative impact of climate change (since it is not possible to eliminate). Analyses are made and changes in the company procedures are advised.

4.5

Proposed Business Model

The internal audit department advised some changes in the company procedures to reach the goals that are set by the sustainability team. First, a “to-do list” that sets the basic actions to eliminate waste is prepared and then a new approach is presented to use the remaining inventory efficiently and improve the operations to reach a more sustainable way of doing business. Those actions are listed below: (a) All purchase department personnel are informed about the results of their not careful enough actions. Additional controls are asked to be done in purchase order requests, such as a double check of the records (qualifications of the dyed fabrics for color, knitting pattern, yarn type, and certification) and checking the inventory on hand details not to order fabrics that are already in the warehouses. (b) Recording errors, if detected, will be reported to the department head and recurring errors will be used for employee performance measurements. (c) Errors will be avoided by using machine learning. For example, a warning appears on the screen in case of typos while entering color information or if there are entries outside the standard product specifications. (d) Sales personnel are asked to be more proactive, especially in the production of samples. For example, if a customer asks for a t-shirt sample using 30/1 combed 30% cotton, 70% polyester, and fuchsia color fabric, the sales personnel should check the stock details to see if there is any fabric close to these requirements. If there is, then he/she should offer new options such as 30/1 combed 30% cotton, 70% polyester, and pink color fabric; or 40/1 combed 30% cotton, 70% polyester, and fuchsia color fabric. By offering different types of fabrics with different colors and yarn counts that are already in the inventory, unnecessary purchases can be eliminated and help reduce the waste of that inventory. Also, as mentioned before, minimum order requirements of suppliers cause unnecessary purchases for sample production (ordering 30 kg of fabric to use only 4 kg of the batch), by this practice these purchases can be eliminated. (e) At the end of each month, an automated inventory list that includes non-moving inventories for the last 6 months will be sent to the sales and purchase departments. By that, they will be aware of those inventories and keep them in mind for future uses. (f) Inventory lists will be sent to the design department so they can be aware of the inventory on hand and use that inventory for the new designs and sample production. Also, they can lead the design preferences of the customers to use the fabrics that are on hand in high volume (In some cases, orders are cancelled

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A. . .

(g)

(h)

(i)

(j)

(k)

(l)

99

by the clients for internal reasons or fabric qualifications. If it is a fault of the customer, it is compensated. But a high volume of fabrics remained in the inventory). An automated inventory list will be sent to all employees in the purchasing department to inform them about the remaining inventory purchased by them. A performance report will be prepared for each employee that shows the percentage of remaining inventory in comparison with the total purchases and if it is higher than 5%, the results will also be sent to the department head. A manual will be prepared that shows the steps of inventory purchase transactions and additional precautions will be explained. By that, it is planned to enhance the awareness of sustainability and waste management. In addition, it is aimed to prevent possible mistakes that new employees can make. A system will be established to warn the purchasing personnel who have a large amount of ready-to-use inventory in the warehouses if they make new purchase orders. Additional approval of the purchasing manager will be required for overlimit (These limits will be changed with the customer group they work with. Because customers have different patterns for orders, some customers give orders in advance, so high-volume purchases are made. Higher limits will be set for these kinds of employees.) purchase requests. In this way, it is aimed that purchasing personnel will be aware of the problem of high stock accumulation in warehouses and be more careful. The company’s design department prepares seasonal or on-demand collections for customers. As part of the new business model, designs will be made with a focus on sustainability and using existing inventories (especially high-volume dyed fabrics left over from cancelled orders). Thus, it will be possible to use the inventories left in the warehouses effectively and to create awareness in the field of sustainability, and practices that set an example for the competitors in the sector and increase the awareness of the employees. Investigations will be conducted to provide information as to what happens to the dyed fabrics sold later, and how and for what purposes buyers purchase them. For example, information such as whether the sold fabrics are recycled, if recycled, how much additional carbon and water footprint resulting from this process occurred, and how it is used if it is not recycled. According to the results of these observations, decisions will be taken to minimize the environmental impact. Customers who recycle their purchased materials in the most efficient (environmentally friendly) way or use them in a less damaging way will be selected. A project has been started by the research and development department of the company to analyze the reasons and effects of the inefficiencies mentioned above. After the analysis, a software will be purchased to monitor the newly applied practices and report the results.

100

Ç. Demir Pali

5 Summary and Conclusion Deloitte (2020) identified three strategies for sustainable transformation: 1. Look ahead. Understand what threats and, more importantly, opportunities the pressures toward sustainability present for the future of the business. 2. Look inside. Consider how business operations could be reconfigured to accelerate the transformation toward greater sustainability. 3. Look around. Leverage the surrounding business ecosystem to create a competitive advantage. In this context, the first thing companies should do is to be aware of their position in terms of sustainability. In light of this information, events that will create risks or opportunities for the company in terms of sustainability should be determined. After these determinations, ways to guide business activities and accelerate the transformation should be sought. Finally, ways of gaining an advantage should be found by examining the competitors and finding ways of doing business that will provide a competitive advantage. TYH Tekstil, which set out with the aim of being the sector leader in the field of sustainability and set its goals in economic, environmental, and social areas, took its first steps by establishing a sustainability team. As a result of the intersection of sustainability efforts and regular workloads of the internal audit employees in the team, it is aimed to reveal a more effective working model by integrating the two departments. A new business model has been developed and shared with the management to be put into practice to minimize the financial and environmental damages of the inventory that is not used and remains in the warehouses. As presented in Fig. 1, the reasons for the problems in this area were identified. Then, the results caused by these problems were determined and the necessary steps for the implementation of the new business model were determined. This model can be implemented by companies operating in many industries, especially in the textile industry. Sustainability-oriented audit works that will be added to the responsibilities of the already existing internal audit departments will enable businesses to use their resources more effectively and efficiently. In addition, companies that are willing to start sustainability studies but do not know where to start can also improve their activities by applying a model like this one. Adapting this approach to the ways of doing business of different companies will contribute to making the business strategies more sustainability-oriented and making the work of the international business world more effective in the field of sustainability. With the implementation of this business model, it will be possible to prevent the accumulation of idle inventory. This will not only prevent the financial losses incurred but also eliminate the environmental damages arising from the production and purchase of raw materials with high carbon and water footprint such as dyed fabric. For businesses operating in a sector with a significant environmental impact and damage, such as the production of textile products, taking control of unnecessary

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A. . .

REASONS • • • •

Minimum order requirements of suppliers Ignorance and incompetency of purchasing staff Retention and accumulation of safety inventory Order cancellations

RESULTS • • • • • • •

High amount of inactive inventory remains in the warehouses High storage expenses Challenges related to keeping inventory in good conditions Financial losses Environmental losses Unnecessary transportation costs and carbon emissions Control and follow-up problems

ACTIONS • • • • • • • • • • •

Educating the buyers to be more careful on ordering process Employee errors will be logged to measure employee performance Machine learning will be used to eliminate errors Sales personnel will be more involved to lead the customers to use the inventory on hand An automated inventory list will be sent to buyers to notify them about non-moving inventories Design department will be involved to use inventory on hand on their new designs A manual will be prepared to guide the employees on how to enter the inventory details A buyer-based remaining inventory report will be prepared Design department will be focused on sustainability Sold waste inventories will be followed to measure the carbon and water footprint A new software will be bought to monitor the performance of new business model

Fig. 1 Background and implementation of the business model

101

102

Ç. Demir Pali

raw material purchases in this way is an important step in terms of “Climate Action” and “Responsible Consumption and Production” goals. There will also be benefits such as the synergy created by the collaboration of different departments and the development of interdepartmental communication, a team spirit that spreads throughout the company, more effective work of more than one department, and more efficient work by preventing the same work from being done by different departments. It will be possible to make a greater impact if the environmental benefit (or reduction of environmental damage) and economic advantages that the business model will provide lead the competitors in the sector and become a role model. In this way, it may be possible for other players in the industry to implement similar practices and review the way they do business in the sector. The effective use of resources will provide significant benefits first within the company, and then throughout the country and the world. Such innovations are an important step toward achieving the goal of “Industries, Innovation and Infrastructure.” Such models, which are implemented in an industry with intense international activity such as textiles, will also have a significant impact on international business and can guide the development of smart strategies. Presenting a company-implemented model, it is aimed to provide a new perspective to academic researchers and to represent an example of applicability in the field of integration of sustainability and internal audit functions. Highlights In this study, the dyed fabric purchasing processes of a company producing garments are analyzed. It is determined that there were significant disruptions and inefficiencies in the purchasing processes. Since those problems are the subject of both sustainability studies and the work of the internal audit department, a business model is proposed integrating the two functions. With this model, it is aimed to bring together different areas of expertise, prevent overlapping and duplication of tasks, and improve interdepartmental communication.

References Deloitte. (2013). Drivers of long-term business value: Stakeholders, stats, and strategy. Deloitte University Press [Online]. Retrieved from https://www2.deloitte.com/us/en/insights/topics/ social-impact/drivers-of-long-term-business-value.html Deloitte. (2020). The sustainability transformation: Look ahead, look inside, and look around [Online]. Retrieved from https://www2.deloitte.com/us/en/insights/topics/social-impact/ drivers-of-long-term-business-value.html Gartner. (2022). 2023 Audit plan hot spots. Retrieved from https://www.gartner.com/en/audit-risk/ trends/audit-plan-hot-spots Hayes, R. (2005). Principles of auditing: An introduction to international standards on auditing (2nd ed.). Pearson Education Limited. International Finance Corporation. (2021). IFC ESG guidebook. Retrieved from https://www.ifc. org/wps/wcm/connect/bee837d0-34b5-4703-95bb-ebb8c474f729/IFC-ESG-Guidebook.pdf? MOD=AJPERES&CVID=nXrNOGJ

Integration of Internal Audit and Sustainability Functions: A. . .

103

KPMG. (2022). Big shifts, small steps. Retrieved from https://assets.kpmg/content/dam/kpmg/xx/ pdf/2022/10/ssr-executive-summary-small-steps-big-shifts.pdf McClure, C., & Stone, A. (2022). Internal audit’s new role: ESG sustainability reporting. Retrieved from https://www.forbes.com/sites/crowe/2022/11/01/internal-audits-new-role-esg-sustainabil ity-reporting/?sh=1ba90b9b578c Ramamoorti, S. (2003). Internal auditing: History, evolution, and prospects. In A. Bailey, A. Gramling, & S. Ramamoorti (Eds.), Research opportunities in internal auditing, the institute of internal auditors. Altamonte Springs. The Institute of Internal Auditors. (2021). Internal audit’s role in ESG reporting [Online]. Retrieved from https://www.theiia.org/globalassets/documents/about-us/about-internalaudit/ white-paper-internal-audits-role-in-esg-reporting.pdf The Institute of Internal Auditors. (n.d.-a). About the Institute of Internal Auditors. Retrieved from https://www.theiia.org/en/about-us/about-internal-audit/history-of-the-iia/. The Institute of Internal Auditors. (n.d.-b). About Internal Audit. Retrieved from https://www.theiia. org/en/about-us/about-internal-audit/ The International Financial Reporting Standards Foundation. (n.d.). Value Reporting Foundation. Retrieved from https://www.ifrs.org/sustainability/value-reporting-foundation/. United Nations. (1987). Our Common Future: Report of the World Commission on Environment and Development. Retrieved from http://www.un-documents.net/ocf-02.htm. United Nations. (n.d.-a). The 17 goals. Retrieved from https://sdgs.un.org/goals United Nations. (n.d.-b). Sustainable consumption and production. Retrieved from https://www.un. org/sustainabledevelopment/sustainable-consumption-production/. United Nations. (n.d.-c). Climate action. Retrieved from https://www.un.org/ sustainabledevelopment/climate-change/. United Nations. (n.d.-d). Industries, innovation and infrastructure. Retrieved from https://www.un. org/sustainabledevelopment/infrastructure-industrialization/

Çağla Demir Pali is an assistant professor of accounting at Yeditepe University. She received her PhD degree in Accounting from Istanbul University in 2018 and worked in the fields of independent audit, internal audit, and cost accounting for 8 years. Her research focuses on risk management, sustainability, and auditing.

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News on Internationalizing Firms: The Role of Social Media Capability Emmanuel Kusi Appiah

Abstract Much of the literature on the implications of fake social media news focuses on political communication, marketing, and consumer research. Therefore, we still know little about the consequences of fake social media news in international business research. This article presents a normative conceptual model that articulates the underlying mechanisms on how the ramifications of fake social media news on the international legitimacy of internationalizing firms can be mitigated. Drawing on the resource-based view theoretical framework and international business literature, the model theorizes social media capability as a firm-specific advantage that can help explain the extent to which the negative implications of fake social media news could be mitigated.

1 Introduction As human beings, we have inalienable rights that no state or government can take from us. One such right is freedom of expression, as enshrined in Article 19 of the Universal Declaration of Human Rights (United Nations, 2015). This freedom of expression exacerbated by digital technology advancement has triggered the upsurge of fake news. Studies show that fake news stories are 70% more likely to be retweeted than factual news stories (Vosoughi et al., 2017). Fake news is a form of disinformation or content pretending as legitimate to deceive the public for ideological or financial gain (Chen & Cheng, 2019; Di Domenico et al., 2021; Lazer et al., 2018). Alternatively, content may be genuine but classified as fake when shared with false contextual information to spread wrong impressions about people, brands, and corporations (Obada, 2019). Fake news consists of satirical content, news parody, photo manipulation, fabrication, advertising, and propaganda (Petratos, 2021; Tandoc et al., 2017). People have used the dissemination of fake news as a financial earning tool to generate wealth. For example, during the 2016 E. K. Appiah (✉) University of Vaasa, Vaasa, Finland e-mail: emmanuel.kusi.appiah@uwasa.fi © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2023 P. Arte et al. (eds.), Sustainable International Business, Contributions to Management Science, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-43785-4_6

105

106

E. K. Appiah

90% 80% 70% 60% 50% 40% 30% 20% 10% 0%

Fig. 1 Where concern about fake news on the Internet is highest

United States presidential elections, several websites in Macedonia spread fake news stories about the elections to generate money through Google AdSense advertising (Baptista & Gradim, 2020). The 2019 edition of the Reuters Institute Digital News Report notes that the publication of fake news has caused concern to nations because of its capability to influence political, economic, and social well-being. The people of Brazil were the most concerned, followed by those of the United Kingdom (UK), Spain, the United States (USA) populations, and the least concerned being those of the Netherlands (see Fig. 1). Countries are therefore putting up structures to circumvent the spread of fake news. For instance, in Finland, the government has reformed the educational system to educate students on critical thinking and information literacy (Mackintosh, 2019). In recent years, we have recorded the dramatic spread of fake news stories through social media. In the context of both small and multinational enterprises (MNEs), there exist cases whereby individuals have used social media channels to spread false information about firms to tarnish the corporate image or change the mindset of consumers (Berthon & Pitt, 2018; Di Domenico et al., 2021). For example, an online user used the Channel23News website to publish an article on social media falsely accusing Karri Twist, a London Indian restaurant, of serving human meat (Ferraro & Chipman, 2019). Similarly, fake information was spread, accusing Coca-Cola of recalling Dasani water due to the presence of a parasite (Chen & Cheng, 2019; Ferraro & Chipman, 2019). In 2017, Starbucks was also a target of fake news on Twitter. An unknown online user made a tweet advertising “Dreamer Day,” in which the company would supposedly give out free coffee to undocumented migrants in the USA (Chen & Cheng, 2019; Obada, 2019; Vafeiadis et al., 2019). Finally, in 2019, Tesla had a similar experience when a fake video was posted online and later went viral, showing a Tesla self-driving car knocking over a robot prototype at a consumer electronics show (Hodge, 2020). At the time Tesla did not have a self-driving model.

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News. . .

107

The rise in fake news on social media has instigated research interest in academic forums. Extant studies have focused on the influence of fake news on the firm’s brand (Berthon & Pitt, 2018; Chen & Cheng, 2019; Mills & Robson, 2019). Others also focused on the motivation to spread or share fake news and the outcomes of doing so (Beyens et al., 2016; Brigida & Pratt, 2017; Di Domenico et al., 2021; Colliander, 2019). With respect to the outcomes of the influence of fake news on firms, prior research shows that fake news on social media adversely or positively influence the legitimacy of brands and firms. On the one hand, fake news on social media can create confusion and doubt about knowledge about firms and brands in the minds of consumers and the public (Di Domenico et al., 2021; Van Duyn & Collier, 2018). On another hand, if firms manipulate reviews or create fake comments, it can create positive company image, increased sales, and even generate uncertainty and confusion on the part of competitors (Dishman & Nitse, 1999); however, it is an unethical way of doing business and can attract legal actions. Among internationalizing firms, fake news, trolling, and fake reviews can harm a firms’ international competitiveness and relationships with international customers and other stakeholders (Saari et al., 2022). The publication of fake news has caused concern to nations because of its capability to impair the success of firms. According to the European Communication Monitor, 22.5% of European organizations and their reputation were affected by fake news in the first half of 2018, and the main source of misleading content was social media (81.3%) (Zerfass et al., 2018). Therefore, more research is needed to address the challenges arising from fake social media news. There is a lack of studies on the implications of fake social media news in the context of internationalization, particularly how the negative effects of fake social media news on internationalizing firms can be mitigated. The usage of digital platforms such as social media has become more appealing to internationalizing firms due to the low cost and accessibility (Jean and Kim 2020). Notwithstanding the importance of digital technology to internationalizing firms, still past work is undermined by the lack of studies on the implications of fake social media news. This paper bridges the gap by addressing the following research question: How can internationalizing firms mitigate the international legitimacy challenges caused by fake social media news? Internationalizing firms face challenges in securing legitimacy in foreign markets (Bangara et al., 2012; Wu & Zhou, 2018; Zaheer, 1995; Zimmerman & Zeitz, 2002). This therefore provides an interesting context to incorporate into the discussions on international legitimacy, fake social media news. The implications of fake news are perceived from the consumer, firm, and societal levels (Di Domenico et al., 2021). We take a narrow perspective to approach the implications of fake news from the firm level. Extant studies have focused on the societal and firm levels (Chen & Cheng, 2019; Di Domenico et al., 2021; Visentin et al., 2019). Studies in IB show social media capability of firms expressed as—the ability to connect, engage, coordinate, and collaborate in interaction with partners in networks—enable firms to extract information from foreign markets, and mitigate challenges created by foreign market uncertainties and liabilities (Alarcón-del-Amo

108

E. K. Appiah

et al., 2018). The current research draws on the resource-based view (Barney, 1991) to theorize on social media capability (Marchand et al., 2021) as a firm-specific advantage (FSA) explaining how the implications on international legitimacy can be mitigated. An FSA is a unique capability proprietary to a firm, and the category can include technological expertise, brand power, innovative capabilities, and corporate culture (Lee & Rugman, 2012; Rugman, 2005). In accordance with this definition, we consider social media capability as an example of a firm’s technological expertise enabling internationalizing firms to create brand awareness to overcome legitimacy challenges in the foreign market (Alarcón-del-Amo et al., 2018; Eid et al., 2020). Our work provides several important contributions to IB research. Firstly, we contribute to the literature on internationalization in the digital context by showing how the spread of fake news stories on social media influences the activities of international firms. Our discussions on social media respond to two interrelated research calls. The first call for research is on the impact of digitalization on internationalization (Coviello et al., 2017; Vahlne & Johanson, 2017). The second relates to the emerging interest among firms in using social media (Shaikh et al., 2015). Secondly, management scholars have researched how organizations can maintain legitimacy in situations of crisis or lose legitimacy following a crisis (Bitektine, 2011; Elsbach, 1994; Sine & David, 2003; Suchman, 1995). Nevertheless, the current research contributes to the literature on international legitimacy by providing information informed by theory on the underlying mechanisms of the negative implications of social media fake news on the international legitimacy of firms in foreign markets, which is an emerging phenomenon in business (Di Domenico et al., 2021). By this, we respond to the call for more phenomenon-based research in IB (Doh, 2015). Thirdly, we cross-fertilize ideas from IB, information systems (IS), and international entrepreneurship (IE) to create new perspectives that improve our understanding of the ramifications of fake social media news stories for international firms. Given this, we respond to the call for interdisciplinary studies in IB research (Knight & Liesch, 2016).

2 Theoretical Background 2.1

Internationalization and Legitimacy

Scholars have applied different internationalization theories to explain internationalizing firms—thus, firms that have adapted operations (strategy, structure, resources, etc.) to international environments (Calof & Beamish, 1995). The behavioral approach, also known as the stage model of internationalization, is an example (Andersen, 1993; Kocak & Abimbola, 2009). The Uppsala model (Johanson & Vahlne, 1977; Johanson & Wiedersheim-Paul, 1975) is also related to the stage model. The model demonstrates why firms internationalize later in their development and why such processes proceed gradually from inception (Autio et al., 2000). According to the model, firms internationalize by first targeting close markets

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News. . .

109

with low psychic distance and gradually expanding to other more distant markets. Firms following the stage model are known as gradual internationalizing firms (Johanson & Vahlne, 1977; Johanson & Wiedersheim-Paul, 1975). Scholars consider the stage model of internationalization to consist of large, well-resourced MNEs (Knight & Cavusgil, 1996; Knight & Liesch, 2016). Criticisms of the stage model have given rise to another theoretical perspective known as early internationalization. Early internationalization refers to the early leap of firms into foreign markets to derive a significant competitive advantage from the use of resources and the sale of output in multiple countries (Oviatt & McDougall, 1994; Knight & Cavusgil, 2004; Wu & Zhou, 2018). According to the critics, the stage model fails to explain entrepreneurial firms that initiate early entry into foreign markets (McDougall et al., 1994; Oviatt & McDougall, 1994; Autio et al., 2000; Fletcher, 2008). Firms following the early internationalization model have attracted different names but the most used ones are early internationalizing firms (EIFs) (Knight et al., 2004), international new ventures (INVs) (Oviatt & McDougall 1994), and born globals (BGs) (Rennie, 1993; Knight & Cavusgil, 1996). For the sake of theoretical parsimony, in this paper we use EIFs. Unlike gradual internationalizing firms, EIFs have an international entrepreneurial orientation that has the potential to promote global technological competence (Knight & Cavusgil, 2004). Our main concern in this study is not to delineate the differences between gradual internationalizing firms and EIFs but to consider them as one by labeling them as internationalizing firms. The literature shows that the survival of internationalizing firms depends on legitimacy—which is considered an intangible asset of the firm (Ahlstrom et al., 2008; Bangara et al., 2012; Bitektine, 2011; King & Whetten, 2008; Stinchcombe, 1965). Due to the liabilities of newness, which are exacerbated by liabilities of foreignness, internationalizing firms should build legitimacy in the host markets to obtain location-bound advantages such as new customers, access to resources from other firms, insidership permitting access to existing foreign networks, etc. Legitimacy is important to internationalizing firms (Bangara et al., 2012; King & Whetten, 2008). Fischer and Reuber (2007) described legitimacy as a socially constructed organizational resource. That characterization implies that the actions of an internationalizing firm in a host market will determine how it will be evaluated or judged by lead stakeholders such as potential customers and sellers. Legitimacy is a construct closely related to organizational reputation (Deephouse & Carter, 2005; Fischer and Reuber, 2007). Like organizational reputation, researchers have linked legitimacy to similar antecedents, such as organizational size, strategic alliances, isomorphism, and regulatory compliance (Deephouse & Carter, 2005). Research on internationalization shows that internationalizing firms can build legitimacy by imitating the behaviors of other firms in the host country, forming strategic alliances, and conforming to societal values, norms, and expectations (Wu & Zhou, 2018). Scholars of organizational theory have developed specific taxonomies of legitimacies (Bitektine, 2011); however, in our study our objective is neither to find the differences among the various types of legitimacies nor to juxtapose two or more legitimacy types. Instead, we seek to maintain a focus on international legitimacy (i.e., legitimacy in the foreign market). Through coercive, mimetic, and normative

110

E. K. Appiah

processes, firms adopt systems, procedures, and structures that are considered appropriate in the environment to achieve legitimacy (DiMaggio & Powell, 1983; Kostova & Roth, 2002). In the following section, we delineate the role of social media in the context of internationalizing.

2.2

Social Media in the Context of Internationalizing

The inception of the Internet has changed the way international business is conducted. There has been a change in the locus of activity from the desktop to the world wide web (the Internet), a change in the locus of value production from the firm to the consumer, and a change in the locus of power from the firm to the consumer (Berthon et al., 2012). Information no longer remains local, and consumers have become creative. Social media platforms such as Facebook, Twitter, YouTube, WhatsApp, and the like mean consumers can access a firm’s products and services, and also share reviews and content with the firms. The functionality of social media in performing the aforementioned activities is due to the physicality and accessibility stimuli associated with the social media context (McFarland & Ployhart, 2015). According to McFarland and Ployhart (2015), physicality stimuli of social media stand for the irrelevance of physical constraints in impeding interactions, whereas accessibility stimuli represent an open-access structure that facilitates the easy connection to networks. Social media is a group of mobile and web applications that build on the ideological and technological foundations of Web 2.0 and allow users such as individuals and communities to create, share, collaborate, discuss, and modify user-generated content (Kaplan & Haenlein, 2010). Extant reviews show that social media can be categorized into public social media and enterprise social media (Wang et al., 2017b). Public social media encompasses social networking sites (e.g., Facebook, Twitter, Flickr, LinkedIn, Skype, Pinterest, Instagram), web-based communities (e.g., discussion boards, brand communities, and chat rooms), and the virtual world (e.g., Second Life and World of Warcraft). Enterprise social media encompasses firm blogs, websites, wikis, and other intranet communication media owned by the firm. In the context of the present study, our focus is on public social media. Existing IB literature on social media and internationalization show that social media eliminates physical distance (Alarcón-del-Amo et al., 2018; Altshuler & Tarnovskaya, 2010; Ahmad et al., 2019; Arnone & Deprince, 2016; Vuori, 2012). It allows international firms to reach out to consumers in different geographical areas without having to be physically present there. Social media also provides opportunities to communicate and respond to competition, create awareness, create strategic partnerships with customers, and develop new capabilities to enhance customer relationships (Arnone & Deprince, 2016). Existing studies on brand building show that social media provides international firms with the opportunity to build brands (Cawsey & Rowley, 2016). Jones et al. (2015) established that firms utilizing social

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News. . .

111

media create better awareness, develop better relations with customers, increase sales, repeat sales, and more frequently have the opportunity to engage with customers. While extant contributions have shown the importance of social media in the context of international firms, we take a step further to focus on how the publication of fake news on social media has negatively affected the legitimacy of internationalizing firms.

2.3

Fake Social Media News Stories

Studies show that fake news has existed from the beginning of civilization; however, it has become more dominant in our contemporary digital era following the 2016 US elections (Baptista & Gradim, 2020; Di Domenico et al., 2021). Despite the popularity, scholars accord that there is still no agreed definition (Baptista & Gradim, 2020; Di Domenico et al., 2021; Petratos, 2021). Extant studies have used two distinct concepts—misinformation and disinformation—interchangeably to define fake news (Di Domenico et al., 2021; Wardle & Derakhshan, 2018). Following Baptista and Gradim (2020), we define it as “a type of online disinformation, with totally or partially false content, created intentionally to deceive and/or manipulate a specific audience, through a format that imitates a news or report (acquiring credibility), through false information that may or may not be associated with real events, with an opportunistic structure (title, image, content) to attract the readers’ attention and to persuade them to believe in falsehood, in order to obtain more clicks and shares, therefore, higher advertising revenue and/or ideological gain” (Baptista & Gradim, p. 22). Unlike fact news, careful analysis shows that fake news stories are significantly shorter news items with sparse use of technical words, less punctuation, fewer quotes, and more lexical redundancy, and which require lower levels of education to be interpreted (Baptista & Gradim, 2020; Horne & Adali, 2017). Sharing fake news content on social media has become routine. For example, people have used WhatsApp to spread fake news stories about the conflict between Hindus and Muslims (Baptista & Gradim, 2020). Similarly, during the 2018 presidential elections in Brazil, WhatsApp was used as a political tool to spread fake news (Baptista & Gradim, 2020). The dissemination of fake news stories on social media also became popularized during the 2016 US presidential election (Allcott & Gentzkow, 2017). While using social media to disseminate false information is common in politics, it is also present in the corporate world, from small start-ups to large firms. For example, people can disseminate fake news content on Facebook and Twitter to undermine the legitimacy of firms (Baptista & Gradim, 2020; Chen & Cheng, 2019; Di Domenico et al., 2021; Valenzuela et al., 2017). Moreover, firms looking to generate traffic to their websites can create false reviews or even create fake comments to prompt customer trust and confidence (Chen & Cheng, 2019). While most studies on fake news have focused on political psychology, we shift the focus to international firms. In the following section, we focus on the development of a conceptual framework and propositions.

112

E. K. Appiah

3 Conceptual Development and Propositions 3.1

Influence of Fake News Stories on Internationalizing Firms

Scholars have isolated two main actors that create and disseminate fake news on social media. According to Zhang and Ghorbani (2019), the two main actors are human beings and non-humans. Humans1 can be people with fake accounts who firms hire to run smear campaigns on competing brands. Non-human creators of fake news are social bots2 and cyborgs3 (Chu et al., 2012; Ferrara et al., 2016; Zhang & Ghorbani, 2020). According to Berthon and Pitt (2018), firms may be victims of or implicated in fake news in several ways. First, when the name of the firm or its brand is mentioned in fake news. Second, when the firm’s ads appear alongside fake news items. Third, when the firm associates its brand with opinion and commentary websites that publish misleading content. Fourth, when firms finance fake news. Anecdotal evidence indicates that international companies such as Walmart (and its subsidiary Sam’s Club), McDonalds, Mondelez International, Pepsi Company, and Coca-Cola have all at some point been negatively affected by fake news. For example, prior to the 2016 US presidential election, the stock of Pepsi Company fell around 4% when fake news content on social media reported the CEO, Indra Nooyi, telling Trump supporters to “take their business elsewhere” (Berthon & Pitt, 2018; Obada, 2019; Vafeiadis et al., 2019). Furthermore, in 2016, the market share for Apple Music slowed due to fake news posted on a blog claiming that Apple was deleting its music collections (Berthon & Pitt, 2018). Fifth, when firms deliberately use endorsements and fake reviews to deceive the external public to undercut ethical business. For example, in 2022 Amazon sued AppSally and Rebatest for acting as fake-review brokers to boost third-party sellers’ products’ ranking in Amazon search results (Palmer, 2022). From the lens of the consumer, studies illustrate that fake news on social media about firms impaired consumers’ brand trust (Chen & Cheng, 2019; Di Domenico et al., 2021; Visentin et al., 2019). Di Domenico et al. (2021) explain that fake news on social media causes consumers to develop low media trust, creates doubts and confusion in the minds of consumers, and even causes them to rely unconsciously on such information for subsequent behavioral actions. Fake social media news and reviews present a social problem as an increasing number of stakeholder decisions to consider an internationalizing firm legitimate in the host market are based on them. For example, when consumers and the local community discover that an internationalizing firm is using fake reviews and other forms of deceptive endorsements, their judgment, evaluation, and attitude to that firm and its brand turn 1

Such people are known as trolls (Kim et al., 2021). Social bots are computer algorithms that exhibit human-like behaviors. Thus, they automatically produce content and interact with humans on social media (Ferrara et al., 2016). 3 Cyborgs are human-assisted bots (Ferrara et al., 2016). 2

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News. . .

113

negative. Legitimacy is about conforming to societal values, norms, and expectations (Wu & Zhou, 2018). In view of this, manipulating online reviews is in contrary to the accepted way of doing business in a foreign market, which can urge local governments to take actions against the firm because it is prejudicial to fair competition in the host market. We offer the following proposition: Proposition 1 Fake news on social media negatively impacts international legitimacy.

3.2

Social Media Capability

The work of Penrose (1959) conceiving the firm as an administrative organization and a collection of productive resources, set the foundations for the Resource-based view (RBV) of the firm (Carrick, 2013). The RBV theoretical framework assumes that a firm’s competitive advantage depends on its resources and capabilities. Barney (1991) isolated four theoretical conditions needed to make a firm’s resources a competitive advantage within a market, the so-called VRIN Framework where “V” stands for the value of resources, “R” represents the rareness of resources, the “I” is the inimitability of resources, and the “N” is the non-substitutability of resources. Social media may not be rare and does not vary across firms due to the relatively recent diffusion and the open access to create an account (Di Domenico et al., 2021; McFarland & Ployhart, 2015). Furthermore, social media appear imitable because it is open access available for competing firms, and people are proficient at using it privately. Therefore, what is created and shared can be imitated by others. Given the VRIN/VRIO framework, scholars (e.g., Vitale, 1986; Clemons & Row, 1991; Powell & Dent-Micallef, 1997; Bharadwaj, 2000; Sinkovics et al. 2013; Fernandez & Nieto, 2006; Herhausen et al. 2020) question the direct influence of digital technology on the attainment of sustained competitive advantage and firm performance. According to the scholars, the digital technology available to firms (e.g., Social media—Facebook, Twitter, LinkedIn, etc.; software and hardware), the ease of duplicating or imitating the use of digital technologies once in existence even for a comparatively short period complicate firms sustaining competitive advantage and performance. However, scholars argue that it can only lead to sustainable competitive advantage and performance when they are used to leverage differences in strategic resources and capabilities. Similarly, Penrose (1959) argued that when the same resource is common to competitors, competitive advantage can arise through superior use. Given the conditions mentioned above, we argue that though social media is common to all, not all people or firms may have the capabilities to use it to manage complex legitimacy crises arising from fake news stories. The social media capabilities of firms are reflected in their abilities to use social media platforms for consumer reviews, and to keep consumers and other stakeholders in the host market well-informed. For example, an Indian restaurant in London (Karri Twist) was falsely accused of serving human meat and was consequently shut

114

E. K. Appiah

Social Media Capability

H2 (-)

Social Media Fake News

H1(-)

International Legitimacy

Fig. 2 Proposed Conceptual Framework

down. The restaurant received bomb threats and lost over half of its revenue. The owner’s response was swift and effective: He posted a denial of the allegations on Facebook, tweeted to calm disgruntled consumers, and even had broadcast a Facebook Live session from inside the operating restaurant to prove it had not shut (BBC, 2017; CBC, 2017). In the same vein, when Starbucks became a victim of a fake news story on Twitter that it was giving out free coffee to undocumented migrants in the USA, it immediately responded to users who were sharing this false information via social media (Chen & Cheng, 2019; Obada, 2019; Vafeiadis et al., 2019). Vafeiadis et al. (2019) encourage firms affected by fake news stories to carefully plan a response strategy to minimize the negative impact, which is what the owner of Karri Twist and Starbucks did. In sum, the usage of social media to respond to fake news and allegations or for legitimate reviews on sites like Google, Yelp, Tripadvisor, and Facebook provide a social proof that can diffuse the negative perceptions that consumers and the local community of the host market may have about the internationalizing firm. Accordingly, we offer the following proposition: Proposition 2 Social media capability weakens the negative consequences of social media fake news on international legitimacy. Our discussions and derived propositions lead us to propose a normative conceptual model (see Fig. 2). The model focuses on the moderating role of social media capability as a basis for explaining the underlying mechanisms of the consequences of fake news stories on international legitimacy.

4 Discussion and Conclusions The ubiquity of social media usage among individuals and firms and the increasing spread of fake news stories make it worthwhile to explore the ramifications of fake news stories on international firms. Our observations unearth some studies on the ramifications of fake news on businesses; however, the underlying nuances that explain the effects are scarcely addressed. Fueled by existing cases of fake news stories concerning international firms such as McDonalds, Pepsi Company, Tesla, and Coca-Cola, this study explores the underlying mechanisms present between the

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News. . .

115

negative effects of social media fake news on international legitimacy focusing on moderators. Given this aim, this study provides theoretical evidence on the moderating role of social media capability. As part of the explanation, we develop a conceptual model and propositions that detail the underlying mechanism between fake news content and brand trust. The model expresses the need for researchers to consider the non-linearity and interdependencies between fake social media news and international legitimacy. Our model proposes that fake social media news stories have a negative influence on international legitimacy. The ubiquity of social media has paved the way for everyone to criticize their experiences with a firm’s actions in real-time. This includes social bots, cyborgs, and people with fake social media accounts hired to run smear campaigns on competing brands (Chu et al., 2012; Ferrara et al., 2016; Zhang & Ghorbani, 2020). We found a plethora of cases that pinpoint the ramifications of fake news stories via social media on international legitimacy. Some of the things that stand out are that social media fake news stories question the international legitimacy of internationalizing firms. It can put doubts and confusion in the minds of consumers and the local community of the host market and can also even cause consumers to unconsciously rely on such information for subsequent behavioral actions (Di Domenico et al., 2021). Studies show that most people who have encountered social media fake news tend to believe them, which highlights the potential ramifications for firms if fake news is refuted (Vafeiadis et al., 2019). For example, according to a survey report, 75% of American adults who have encountered fake news tend to believe it (Silverman & Singer-Vine, 2016). In our model, we propose social media capability as a moderating variable to examine how the ramifications of fake social media news stories on international legitimacy can be mitigated. First, we conceptualized social media capability as the firm’s ability to use social media platforms for consumer reviews, and to keep consumers and other stakeholders in the host market wellinformed. We found that victimized firms such as Starbucks and Karri Twist used social media to minimize the negative impact of fake news stories. Karri Twist denied the accusation on Twitter and created a Facebook Live video. Starbucks also attacked the accusers on social media and responded to Twitter users inquiring about the promotion by declaring there was no truth to it (Vafeiadis et al., 2019). The responses of both firms on social media reduced the credibility of the stories (Vafeiadis et al., 2019). Therefore, we posit that using social media to keep consumers well-informed has the potential to weaken the ramifications of fake news on international legitimacy.

4.1

Theoretical Implications

The importance of this study is reflected in the studies on the liability of foreignness (i.e., difficulty in achieving legitimacy) associated with international firms (Bangara et al., 2012; Zaheer, 1995). Our focus is on the conceptual theorization of the

116

E. K. Appiah

negative implication of fake social media news stories on the international legitimacy of firms. Theoretically, we make the following contributions: Firstly, responding to the call for research on the impact of digitalization on internationalization (Coviello et al., 2017; Vahlne & Johanson, 2017), we contribute to the literature on internationalization in the digital context and social media research by showing how the spread of fake news stories on social media influences internationalizing firms. In the light of digitalization, fake news is taking over social media and putting the survival of firms at risk (Di Domenico et al., 2021). Originally, internationalizing firms are known to be stifled by the challenge of achieving legitimacy in host markets (Bangara et al., 2012; Zaheer, 1995), but arguably this has been intensified by the upsurge of social media fake news. We showed that social media fake news stories have impaired establishing consumer brand trust and the way they evaluate firms’ brands and operations (Chen & Cheng, 2019; Di Domenico et al., 2021; Visentin et al., 2019). Secondly, responding to the call for more phenomenon-based research in IB (Doh, 2015) and the call for research on the emerging interest of firms in using social media (Shaikh et al., 2015), this study contributes to studies on social media fake news phenomenon in the context of international business. We introduce a conceptual theorization on the underlying mechanisms surrounding the mitigation of the ramifications of fake social media news on international legitimacy, which is an emerging phenomenon in business (Di Domenico et al., 2021). We proposed social media capability as contingent condition necessary for weakening the ramifications of fake social media news on international legitimacy. We argue that internationalizing firms with the ability to use social media to inform leading stakeholders, such as consumers, can respond to fake news promptly to counter its escalation. As Vafeiadis et al. (2019) reported, such firms engage in careful planning and develop response strategies to minimize the effects of disinformation. Thirdly, our study contributes to the studies on the ramifications of fake social media news in IB research. However, the underlying mechanisms available to mitigate the ramifications are less clear. Our conceptual model and propositions unpack the underlying mechanisms: We describe how fake social media news and reviews influence international legitimation moderated by social media capability. According to the model, fake social media news and reviews negatively influence international legitimation in that it can cause consumers and the local community of the host market develop a negative attitude to that firm and its brand, whereas social media capability mitigate the negative influence. Finally, this study responds to the call for more interdisciplinary studies (Cavusgil & Knight, 2015; Etemad, 2017; Knight & Liesch, 2016) and cross-pollinates perspectives from IB, IE, and IS to enhance the understanding of the ramifications of fake social media news on the international legitimacy of internationalizing firms. We argue that just as digitalization has created a medium for firms to internationalize across geographical borders, so have the realities of research changed (Knight and Cavusgil, 1996). Therefore, IB scholars cannot ignore the power of digital technologies originating from the digital context, nor do scholars in IS ignore internationalization. Given this, the

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News. . .

117

interdisciplinary nature of our study creates new perspectives or frameworks that improve our understanding of the social media fake news phenomena.

4.2

Practical Implications

The ubiquity of disinformation in social media and the propensity to cause damage to a firm’s legitimacy in a host market demand that managers and entrepreneurs see it as their responsibility to identify ways and strategies to overcome it when it occurs. Our study encourages the reader to view social media capability as a crucial FSA that can support an internationalizing firm to mitigate the harm that social media fake news can cause. We showed that during legitimacy crises, highly international entrepreneurial-oriented firms adopt innovative ways to register their presence online, such as the use of Facebook Live, sharing a post, and commenting on posts by consumers to create brand trust among consumers. Therefore, managers and entrepreneurs must develop a strong social media capability throughout the firm and become more entrepreneurial. Entrepreneurs and managers should understand the importance of social media to the firm’s activities. Existing literature demonstrates that knowing how to integrate social media is more important than knowing what it is used for (Wang et al., 2017a). Therefore, our study highlights the importance of social media capability as reflected in the firm’s ability to use social media to inform lead stakeholders in times of legitimacy crises. This finding calls for entrepreneurs and managers who know what social media is used for but do not know how to integrate it into their activities to invest in developing their social media capability. Doing so will help them to understand the key features of social media, identify suitable social media initiatives, and decide on appropriate social media applications and potential solutions if their firms fall victim to fake social media news items. Finally, our study has elaborated on practical cases on the ramifications of fake social media news on the legitimacy of international firms such as Apple, Starbucks, Coca-Cola, and others. By this, we postulate that entrepreneurs and managers can take lessons and incorporate them into their individual firm’s operations. Furthermore, looking at the grave ramifications of fake news for firms, policymakers, managers, and entrepreneurs should help lead stakeholders and the general public in identifying fake news stories. Firms should train people on how to use AI (artificial intelligence) to trawl social media fake news or use it to detect bots, for instance, on Twitter. The literature reports on various AI tools such as credibility scoring, disinformation, bot/spam detection, codes and standards, verification, and whitelisting (Petratos, 2021). However, the firm must select which of those best suits its methods of managing digital disinformation and how such a solution could be implemented in its business operations. At the country level, policymakers such as the government of Finland has put structures in place to train the populace on how to identify fake news (Mackintosh, 2019). This is a positive step and should encourage

118

E. K. Appiah

similar initiatives in other countries, especially emerging economies, as social media usage becomes dominant (von Abrams 2019).

4.3

Limitations and Suggestions for Future Research

Our study unveils several avenues for future theoretical advancement on social media and internationalization research in the IB field. First, our proposed conceptual model and propositions could be tested in future studies from both quantitative and qualitative perspectives to broaden our understanding of the underlying mechanisms of how internationalizing firms mitigates the ramifications of fake social media news on international legitimacy. Presently, the digital transformation trend prevails in different industry sectors (Petratos, 2021); therefore, we encourage future studies to test our conceptual model in different sectors. We believe this will help us to understand how industry sector-specific variation influences how the ramifications of fake social media news on international legitimacy are mitigated. Furthermore, the current study is conceptual. We encourage future studies to test our conceptual model. Doing so could confirm the applicability of our conceptual model in the research stream of firm internationalization. We have incorporated social media capability as a contingent factor explaining how the ramifications of fake social media news can be mitigated; however, future studies can consider incorporating other contingent factors such as strategic flexibility (Wu & Zhou, 2018) and partnerships (Petratos, 2021). On strategic flexibility, the reason is that it enables internationalizing firms to actively respond to environmental uncertainties (Wu & Zhou, 2018), a typical example is when the firm’s legitimacy is at the center of skepticism in the host market. Lastly, on partnerships, the reason is that joining forces with other firms enhances capacity building and can create economies of scale and scope to aid the focal firm in mitigating the spread of online fake news.

References Ahlstrom, D., Bruton, G. D., & Yeh, K. S. (2008). Private firms in China: Building legitimacy in an emerging economy. Journal of World Business, 43(4), 385–399. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jwb. 2008.03.001 Ahmad, S. Z., Abu Bakar, A. R., & Ahmad, N. (2019). Social media adoption and its impact on firm performance: The case of the UAE. International Journal of Entrepreneurial Behavior and Research, 25(1), 84–111. https://doi.org/10.1108/ijebr-08-2017-0299 Alarcón-del-Amo, M.-D.-C., Rialp-Criado, A., & Rialp-Criado, J. (2018). Examining the impact of managerial involvement with social media on exporting firm performance. International Business Review, 27(2), 355–366. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ibusrev.2017.09.003 Allcott, H., & Gentzkow, M. (2017). Social media and fake news in the 2016 election. Journal of Economic Perspectives, 31(2), 211–236. https://doi.org/10.1257/jep.31.2.211

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News. . .

119

Altshuler, L., & Tarnovskaya, V. V. (2010). Branding capability of technology born globals. Journal of Brand Management, 18(3), 212–227. https://doi.org/10.1057/bm.2010.47 Andersen, O. (1993). On the internationalization process of firms: A critical analysis. Journal of International Business Studies, 24(2), 209–231. https://doi.org/10.1057/palgrave.jibs.8490230 Arnone, L. & Deprince, E. (2016). Small firms internationalization: Reducing the psychic distance using social networks. Global Journal of Business Research, 10 (1) p. 55–63. Available at SSRN: https://ssrn.com/abstract=2797435. Autio, E., Sapienza, H. J., & Almeida, J. G. (2000). Effects of age at entry, knowledge intensity, and imitability on international growth. Academy of Management Journal, 43(5), 909–924. https:// doi.org/10.5465/1556419 Bangara, A., Freeman, S., & Schroder, W. (2012). Legitimacy and accelerated internationalization: An Indian perspective. Journal of World Business, 47(4), 623–634. https://doi.org/10.1016/j. jwb.2011.09.002 Baptista, J. P., & Gradim, A. (2020). Understanding fake news consumption: A review. Social Sciences, 9(10), 185. https://doi.org/10.3390/socsci9100185 Barney, J. (1991). Firm resources and sustained competitive advantage. Journal of Management, 17(1), 99–120. https://doi.org/10.1177/014920639101700108 BBC. (2017, May 18). Restaurant hit by ‘human meat’ fake news claims. BBC News. Retrieved September 6, 2022, from https://www.bbc.com/news/newsbeat-39966215 Berthon, P. R., & Pitt, L. F. (2018). Brands, truthiness and post-fact. Journal of Macromarketing, 38(2), 218–227. https://doi.org/10.1177/0276146718755869 Berthon, P. R., Pitt, L. F., Plangger, K., & Shapiro, D. (2012). Marketing meets web 2.0, social media, and creative consumers: Implications for international marketing strategy. Business Horizons, 55(3), 261–271. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.bushor.2012.01.007 Beyens, I., Frison, E., & Eggermont, S. (2016). “I don’t want to miss A thing”: Adolescents’ fear of missing out and its relationship to adolescents’ social needs, Facebook use, and Facebook related stress. Computers in Human Behavior, 64, 1–8. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.chb.2016. 05.083 Bharadwaj, A. S. (2000). A resource-based perspective on information technology capability and firm performance: An empirical investigation. MIS Quarterly, 24(1), 169. https://doi.org/10. 2307/3250983 Bitektine, A. (2011). Toward a theory of social judgments of organizations: The case of legitimacy, reputation, and status. Academy of Management Review, 36(1), 151–179. https://doi.org/10. 5465/amr.2011.55662572 Brigida, M., & Pratt, W. R. (2017). Fake news. The North American Journal of Economics and Finance, 42, 564–573. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.najef.2017.08.012 Calof, J. L., & Beamish, P. W. (1995). Adapting to foreign markets: Explaining internationalization. International Business Review, 4(2), 115–131. https://doi.org/10.1016/0969-5931(95) 00001-g Carrick, J. (2013). From Penrose to complementary assets: The evolution of the resource-based literature. Journal of Management Policy and Practice, 14(3), 125–156. Cavusgil, S. T., & Knight, G. (2015). The Born Global Firm: An entrepreneurial and capabilities perspective on early and rapid internationalization. Journal of International Business Studies, 46(1), 3–16. https://doi.org/10.1057/jibs.2014.62 Cawsey, T., & Rowley, J. (2016). Social media brand building strategies in B2B companies. Marketing Intelligence and Planning, 34(6), 754–776. https://doi.org/10.1108/mip-042015-0079 CBC/Radio Canada. (2017, May 30). Indian restaurant told they 'should be bombed' over fake news about serving human meat | CBC radio. CBC News. Retrieved September 6, 2022, from https:// www.cbc.ca/radio/asithappens/as-it-happens-tuesday-edition-1.4137713/indian-restauranttold-they-should-be-bombed-over-fake-news-about-serving-human-meat-1.4137715

120

E. K. Appiah

Chen, Z. F., & Cheng, Y. (2019). Consumer response to fake news about brands on social media: The effects of self-efficacy, Media Trust, and Persuasion Knowledge on Brand Trust. Journal of Product and Brand Management, 29(2), 188–198. https://doi.org/10.1108/jpbm-12-2018-2145 Chu, Z., Gianvecchio, S., Wang, H., & Jajodia, S. (2012). Detecting automation of Twitter accounts: Are you a human, bot, or Cyborg? IEEE Transactions on Dependable and Secure Computing, 9(6), 811–824. https://doi.org/10.1109/tdsc.2012.75 Clemons, E. K., & Row, M. C. (1991). Sustaining it advantage: The role of structural differences. MIS Quarterly, 15(3), 275. https://doi.org/10.2307/249639 Colliander, J. (2019). “This is fake news”: Investigating the role of conformity to other users’ views when commenting on and spreading disinformation in social media. Computers in Human Behavior, 97, 202–215. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.chb.2019.03.032 Coviello, N., Kano, L., & Liesch, P. W. (2017). Adapting the Uppsala model to a modern world: Macro-context and Microfoundations. Journal of International Business Studies, 48(9), 1151–1164. https://doi.org/10.1057/s41267-017-0120-x Deephouse, D. L., & Carter, S. M. (2005). An examination of differences between organizational legitimacy and organizational reputation*. Journal of Management Studies, 42(2), 329–360. https://doi.org/10.1111/j.1467-6486.2005.00499.x Di Domenico, G. D., Sit, J., Ishizaka, A., & Nunan, D. (2021). Fake news, social media and marketing: A systematic review. Journal of Business Research, 124, 329–341. https://doi.org/ 10.1016/j.jbusres.2020.11.037 DiMaggio, P. J., & Powell, W. W. (1983). The Iron Cage Revisited: Institutional isomorphism and collective rationality in organizational fields. American Sociological Review, 48(2), 147. https:// doi.org/10.2307/2095101 Dishman, P., & Nitse, P. (1999). Disinformation usage in corporate communications: CI’ers beware. Competitive Intelligence Review, 10(4), 20–29. Doh, J. P. (2015). From the editor: Why we need phenomenon-based research in international business. Journal of World Business, 50(4), 609–611. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jwb.2015. 08.002 Eid, R., Abdelmoety, Z., & Agag, G. (2020). Antecedents and consequences of social media marketing use: An empirical study of the UK exporting B2B SMEs. Journal of Business and Industrial Marketing, 35(2), 284–305. Elsbach, K. D. (1994). Managing organizational legitimacy in the California cattle industry: The construction and effectiveness of verbal accounts. Administrative Science Quarterly, 39(1), 57. https://doi.org/10.2307/2393494 Etemad, H. (2017). The emergence of online global market place and the multilayered view of International Entrepreneurship. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 15(4), 353–365. https://doi.org/10.1007/s10843-017-0220-5 Fernandez, Z., & Nieto, M. J. (2006). The internet: Competitive strategy and boundaries of the firm. International Journal of Technology Management, 35(1/2/3/4), 182. https://doi.org/10.1504/ ijtm.2006.009234 Ferrara, E., Varol, O., Davis, C., Menczer, F., & Flammini, A. (2016). The rise of social bots. Communications of the ACM, 59(7), 96–104. https://doi.org/10.1145/2818717 Ferraro, M. F., & Chipman, J. C. (2019, February 8). Perspective | fake news threatens our businesses, not just our politics. The Washington Post. Retrieved September 6, 2022, from https://www.washingtonpost.com/outlook/fake-news-threatens-our-businesses-not-just-our-pol itics/2019/02/08/f669b62c-2b1f-11e9-984d-9b8fba003e81_story.html Fletcher, R. (2008). The internationalisation from a network perspective: A longitudinal study. Industrial Marketing Management, 37(8), 953–964. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.indmarman.2007. 09.008 Fischer, E., & Reuber, R. (2007). The good, the bad, and the unfamiliar: The challenges of reputation formation facing new firms. Entrepreneurship Theory and Practice, 31(1), 53–75. https://doi.org/10.1111/j.1540-6520.2007.00163.x

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News. . .

121

Herhausen, D., Miočević, D., Morgan, R. E., & Kleijnen, M. H. P. (2020). The digital marketing capabilities gap. Industrial Marketing Management, 90, 276–290. https://doi.org/10.1016/j. indmarman.2020.07.022 Hodge, N. (2020, April 1). Risk Management Magazine - fake facts: What the rise of disinformation campaigns means for businesses. Magazine. Retrieved September 6, 2022, from http://www. rmmagazine.com/articles/article/2020/04/01/-Fake-Facts-What-the-Rise-of-DisinformationCampaigns-Means-for-Businesses- doi:https://doi.org/10.1016/j.emj.2020.04.008. Horne, B. D. & Adali, S. (2017). This just in: Fake news packs a lot in title, uses simpler, repetitive content in text body, more similar to satire than real news. Paper presented at the Eleventh International AAAI Conference on Web and Social Media, Montreal, QC, May 15–18. Jean, R. J. B., & Kim, D. (2020). Internet and SMEs’ internationalization: The role of platform and website. Journal of International Management, 26(1), 100690. Johanson, J., & Vahlne, J.-E. (1977). The internationalization process of the firm—A model of knowledge development and increasing foreign market commitments. Journal of International Business Studies, 8(1), 23–32. https://doi.org/10.1057/palgrave.jibs.8490676 Johanson, J., & Wiedersheim-Paul, F. (1975). The internationalization of the firm? Four Swedish cases. Journal of Management Studies, 12(3), 305–323. https://doi.org/10.1111/j.1467-6486. 1975.tb00514.x Jones, N., Borgman, R., & Ulusoy, E. (2015). Impact of social media on small businesses. Journal of Small Business and Enterprise Development, 22(4), 611–632. https://doi.org/10.1108/jsbed09-2013-0133 Kaplan, A. M., & Haenlein, M. (2010). Users of the world, unite! The challenges and opportunities of social media. Business Horizons, 53(1), 59–68. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.bushor.2009.09.003 Kim, B., Xiong, A., Lee, D., & Han, K. (2021). A systematic review on fake news research through the lens of news creation and consumption: Research efforts, challenges, and Future Directions. PLoS One, 16(12). https://doi.org/10.1371/journal.pone.0260080 King, B. G., & Whetten, D. A. (2008). Rethinking the relationship between reputation and legitimacy: A social actor conceptualization. Corporate Reputation Review, 11(3), 192–207. https://doi.org/10.1057/crr.2008.16 Knight, G. A., & Cavusgil, S. T. (1996). The born global firm: A challenge to traditional internationalization theory. Advances in International Marketing, 8, 11–26. Knight, G. A., & Cavusgil, S. T. (2004). Innovation, organizational capabilities, and the born-global firm. Journal of International Business Studies, 35(2), 124–141. https://doi.org/10.1057/ palgrave.jibs.8400071 Knight, G. A., & Liesch, P. W. (2016). Internationalization: From incremental to born global. Journal of World Business, 51(1), 93–102. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jwb.2015.08.011 Knight, G., Madsen, T., & Servais, P. (2004). An inquiry into born-global firms in Europe and the USA. International Marketing Review, 21(6), 645–665. Kocak, A., & Abimbola, T. (2009). The effects of entrepreneurial marketing on born global performance. International Marketing Review, 26(4/5), 439–452. https://doi.org/10.1108/ 02651330910971977 Kostova, T., & Roth, K. (2002). Adoption of an organizational practice by subsidiaries of Multinational Corporations: Institutional and relational effects. Academy of Management Journal, 45(1), 215–233. https://doi.org/10.5465/3069293 Lazer, D. M., Baum, M. A., Benkler, Y., Berinsky, A. J., Greenhill, K. M., Menczer, F., Metzger, M. J., Nyhan, B., Pennycook, G., Rothschild, D., Schudson, M., Sloman, S. A., Sunstein, C. R., Thorson, E. A., Watts, D. J., & Zittrain, J. L. (2018). The science of fake news. Science, 359(6380), 1094–1096. https://doi.org/10.1126/science.aao2998 Lee, I. H., & Rugman, A. M. (2012). Firm-specific advantages, inward FDI origins, and performance of multinational enterprises. Journal of International Management, 18(2), 132–146. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.intman.2011.11.001

122

E. K. Appiah

Mackintosh, E. (2019). Finland is winning the war on fake news. Other nations want the blueprint. CNN. Retrieved September 6, 2022, from https://edition.cnn.com/interactive/2019/05/europe/ finland-fake-news-intl/ Marchand, A., Hennig-Thurau, T., & Flemming, J. (2021). Social media resources and capabilities as strategic determinants of social media performance. International Journal of Research in Marketing, 38(3), 549–571. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ijresmar.2020.09.011 McDougall, P. P., Shane, S., & Oviatt, B. M. (1994). Explaining the formation of international new ventures: The limits of theories from International Business Research. Journal of Business Venturing, 9(6), 469–487. https://doi.org/10.1016/0883-9026(94)90017-5 McFarland, L. A., & Ployhart, R. E. (2015). Social Media: A contextual framework to guide research and practice. Journal of Applied Psychology, 100(6), 1653–1677. https://doi.org/10. 1037/a0039244 Mills, A. J., & Robson, K. (2019). Brand management in the era of fake news: Narrative response as a strategy to insulate brand value. Journal of Product and Brand Management, 29(2), 159–167. https://doi.org/10.1108/jpbm-12-2018-2150 Obada, R. (2019). Sharing fake news about brands on social media: A new conceptual model based on flow theory. Argumentum. Journal of the Seminar of Discursive Logic Argumentation Theory and Rhetoric, 17(2), 144–166. Oviatt, B. M., & McDougall, P. P. (1994). Toward a theory of international new ventures. Journal of International Business Studies, 25(1), 45–64. https://doi.org/10.1057/palgrave.jibs.8490193 Palmer, A. (2022, February 22). Amazon sues two companies that allegedly help fill the site with fake reviews. Retrieved January 7, 2023, from https://www.cnbc.com/2022/02/22/amazon-suesalleged-fake-reviews-brokers-appsally-rebatest.html Penrose, E. T. (1959). The theory of the growth of the firm. John Wiley. Petratos, P. N. (2021). Misinformation, disinformation, and fake news: Cyber risks to business. Business Horizons, 64(6), 763–774. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.bushor.2021.07.012 Powell, T. C., & Dent-Micallef, A. (1997). Information technology as competitive advantage: The role of human, business, and technology resources. Strategic Management Journal, 18(5), 375–405. https://doi.org/10.1002/(sici)1097-0266(199705)18:53.0.co;2-7 Rennie, M. W. (1993). Born global. The McKinsey Quarterly, 4, 45. Rugman, A. M. (2005). The regional multinationals: MNEs and ‘Global’ strategic management. Cambridge University Press. Saari, M., Haapanen, L., & Hurmelinna-Laukkanen, P. (2022). Social media and international business: Views and conceptual framing. International Marketing Review, 39(7), 25–45. https:// doi.org/10.1108/imr-06-2021-0191 Shaikh, A. A., Karjaluoto, H., & Chinje, N. B. (2015). Consumers’ perceptions of mobile banking continuous usage in Finland and South Africa. International Journal of Electronic Finance, 8(2/3/4), 149. https://doi.org/10.1504/ijef.2015.070528 Silverman, C., & Singer-Vine, J. (2016, December 7). Most Americans who see fake news believe it, new survey says. BuzzFeed News. Retrieved September 6, 2022, from https://www. buzzfeednews.com/article/craigsilverman/fake-news-survey Sine, W. D., & David, R. J. (2003). Environmental jolts, institutional change, and the creation of entrepreneurial opportunity in the US electric power industry. Research Policy, 32(2), 185–207. https://doi.org/10.1016/s0048-7333(02)00096-3 Sinkovics, N., Sinkovics, R. R., & “Bryan” Jean, R. J. (2013). The internet as an alternative path to internationalization? International Marketing Review, 30(2), 130–155. doi:https://doi.org/10. 1108/02651331311314556. Stinchcombe, A. (1965). Social structure and organizations. In J. March (Ed.), Handbook of organizations (pp. 142–193). Rand McNally. Suchman, M. C. (1995). Managing legitimacy: Strategic and institutional approaches. Academy of Management Review, 20(3), 571–610. https://doi.org/10.5465/amr.1995.9508080331 Tandoc, E. C., Lim, Z. W., & Ling, R. (2017). Defining “fake news”. Digital Journalism, 6(2), 137–153. https://doi.org/10.1080/21670811.2017.1360143 United Nations. (2015). Universal declaration of human rights. United Nations.

Mitigating the Negative Implications of Fake Social Media News. . .

123

Vafeiadis, M., Bortree, D. S., Buckley, C., Diddi, P., & Xiao, A. (2019). Refuting fake news on social media: Nonprofits, crisis response strategies and issue involvement. Journal of Product and Brand Management, 29(2), 209–222. https://doi.org/10.1108/jpbm-12-2018-2146 Vahlne, J.-E., & Johanson, J. (2017). From internationalization to evolution: The Uppsala model at 40 years. Journal of International Business Studies, 48(9), 1087–1102. https://doi.org/10.1057/ s41267-017-0107-7 Valenzuela, S., Piña, M., & Ramírez, J. (2017). Behavioral effects of framing on social media users: How conflict, economic, human interest, and Morality Frames Drive News Sharing. Journal of Communication, 67(5), 803–826. https://doi.org/10.1111/jcom.12325 Van Duyn, E., & Collier, J. (2018). Priming and fake news: The effects of elite discourse on evaluations of news media. Mass Communication and Society, 22(1), 29–48. https://doi.org/10. 1080/15205436.2018.1511807 Visentin, M., Pizzi, G., & Pichierri, M. (2019). Fake news, real problems for brands: The impact of content truthfulness and source credibility on consumers’ behavioral intentions toward the advertised brands. Journal of Interactive Marketing, 45, 99–112. https://doi.org/10.1016/j. intmar.2018.09.001 Vitale, M. R. (1986). The growing risks of information systems success. MIS Quarterly, 10(4), 327. https://doi.org/10.2307/249185 Abrams, K. von. (2019, December 12). Global Social Network Users. Insider Intelligence. Retrieved September 6, 2022, from https://www.emarketer.com/content/global-social-net work-users Vosoughi, S., Mohsenvand, M. N., & Roy, D. (2017). Rumor gauge. ACM Transactions on Knowledge Discovery from Data, 11(4), 1–36. https://doi.org/10.1145/3070644 Vuori, M. (2012). Exploring uses of social media in a global corporation. Journal of Systems and Information Technology, 14(2), 155–170. https://doi.org/10.1108/13287261211232171 Wang, T., Thornhill, S., & De Castro, J. O. (2017a). Entrepreneurial orientation, legitimation, and new venture performance. Strategic Entrepreneurship Journal, 11(4), 373–392. https://doi.org/ 10.1002/sej.1246 Wang, Y., Rod, M., Ji, S., & Deng, Q. (2017b). Social media capability in B2B marketing: Toward a definition and a research model. Journal of Business and Industrial Marketing, 32(8), 1125–1135. https://doi.org/10.1108/jbim-10-2016-0250 Wardle, C., & Derakhshan, H. (2018). Thinking about ‘information disorder’: Formats of misinformation, disinformation, and mal-information. In C. Ireton & J. Posetti (Eds.), Journalism, “fake news” and disinformation (pp. 43–54). Paris Wu, A., & Zhou, L. (2018). Understanding earliness of internationalization and its impact on postentry geographic diversity of International Young Ventures. Journal of International Marketing, 26(2), 62–79. https://doi.org/10.1509/jim.16.0123 Zaheer, S. (1995). Overcoming the liability of foreignness. Academy of Management Journal, 38(2), 341–363. https://doi.org/10.5465/256683 Zerfass, A., Tench, R., Verhoeven, P., Verčič, D., & Moreno, A. (2018). European communication monitor 2018 (2nd ed.). Retrieved September 6, 2022, from http://www. communicationmonitor.eu/2018/06/13/ecm-european-communication-monitor-2018/ Zhang, X., & Ghorbani, A. A. (2020). An overview of online fake news: Characterization, detection, and discussion. Information Processing and Management, 57(2), 102025. https:// doi.org/10.1016/j.ipm.2019.03.004 Zimmerman, M. A., & Zeitz, G. J. (2002). Beyond survival: Achieving new venture growth by building legitimacy. Academy of Management Review, 27(3), 414–431. https://doi.org/10.5465/ amr.2002.7389921

124

E. K. Appiah

Emmanuel Kusi Appiah received his Ph.D. in 2022 from the University of Vaasa. His dissertation deals with internationalization of new ventures in the digital context. Emmanuel’s research interest is on early internationalization at the interface of digitalization. He has presented his papers at top scientific conferences, such as the Hawaii International Conference on System Sciences, Academy of International Business, McGill International Entrepreneurship, and European International Business Academy. Also, Emmanuel has previous consulting experience in the area of digital and social media marketing. He has worked as a reviewer for International Marketing Review, a reviewer of several conference proceedings, and a reviewer for several books.

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization in the Social Media Context Emmanuel Kusi Appiah

Abstract This chapter aims to enhance our understanding of how internationalizing SMEs strengthen their network ties and how the strengths of those ties in the context of social media underpin opportunity realization in the foreign market. It adopts Granovetter’s dimensions of tie strength and its results reveal duration, intimacy, and reciprocity to be the dimensions on which the tactics adopted by the case firms to strengthen ties are based. Further, the analysis shows that the firms’ use of those tactics is rooted in their ability to use social media platforms to connect with, engage, coordinate, and collaborate with their online followers. The chapter contributes to research on social capital, opportunity recognition, the social media context to expand extant literature on interdisciplinary studies.

1 Introduction Digital technology occupies a key position in the United Nations (UN) 17 Sustainable Development Goals (SDGs) for it fosters innovation and industrial sustainability (UN, 2022). It is also considered as a force that influence the speed of new venture internationalization (Monaghan et al., 2019; Vadana et al., 2021). A contactless digital technology artefact influencing internationalization that has attracted attention within both academia and non-academic forums is social media (SM) platforms. Social media platforms are digital channels such as Facebook, YouTube, Twitter, and LinkedIn that facilitate information sharing, user-created content, and collaboration across multiple individuals (Freixanet et al., 2020; Kaplan & Haenlein, 2010; McFarland & Ployhart, 2015). In non-academic sectors, SM platforms are becoming increasingly important strategic tools for firms (Parveen et al., 2016) and are changing the interactions between firms and consumers (Kao et al., 2016). Internationalizing small and medium-sized enterprises (SMEs) often lack sufficient knowledge of foreign markets; a situation commonly expressed as the E. K. Appiah (✉) University of Vaasa, Vaasa, Finland e-mail: emmanuel.kusi.appiah@uwasa.fi © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2023 P. Arte et al. (eds.), Sustainable International Business, Contributions to Management Science, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-43785-4_7

125

126

E. K. Appiah

liability of newness (Zaheer, 1995); have difficulty in achieving legitimacy, known as the liability of foreignness (Zaheer, 1995); experience difficulty in accessing existing foreign market networks, something expressed as the liability of outsidership (Johanson & Vahlne, 2009); and lack sufficient resources (Zahra, 2005). Prior studies (e.g. Arnone & Deprince, 2016; Nowiński & Rialp, 2016) viewed the leverage provided by SM platforms as a strategic resource that could be deployed to create social networks, extracting information from foreign markets, and mitigating probable challenges from foreign market uncertainties and liabilities (Alarcón-del-Amo et al., 2018). Despite these few theoretical contributions, with few exceptions (e.g. Fraccastoro et al., 2021; Nowiński & Rialp, 2016), neither the international entrepreneurship (IE), international business (IB) or interactive marketing literature offers a great deal of research on SM platform usage in the networks of internationalizing SMEs, a point confirmed by Zucchella (2021) in the context of IB and IE issues and their association with SM platforms. Moreover, research on how the usage of SM platforms strengthens network ties or the associated opportunities generated for firms remains scarce. This is an important area that warrants research attention because anecdotal evidence (e.g. Johanson & Mattsson, 1988; Williams et al., 2020) shows that network ties facilitate SME internationalization. For instance, network ties enable international SMEs to overcome liabilities of newness and smallness (Coviello & Munro, 1995). Further, scholars (e.g. Coviello & Munro, 1995; Ellis, 2011; Johanson & Mattsson, 1988) have argued that opportunity recognition is influenced by participation in networks. Therefore, the present study aims to enhance our understanding of the networking tactics of internationalizing SMEs in the context of SM. We view SM as not simply a technology but a context for interaction that fundamentally changes the way in which the cognition, affects, and the behaviour of individuals are shaped (McFarland & Ployhart, 2015). While studies on SM strategies and tactics have focused on communication and marketing (e.g. Kiráľová & Pavlíčeka, 2015), we opted to focus on networking in a SM context, which is relatively an unexamined type of context (McFarland & Ployhart, 2015). For the study’s research purposes, networking tactics are what a firm does with its SM marketing capability to establish relationships with others. An SM marketing capability refers to the firm’s ability to use SM platforms to connect, engage, coordinate, and collaborate in interactions with partners (Drummond et al., 2020) while a relationship or network refers to the extent to which users relate to each other, converse, share information of sociality virtually or regard each other as a follower or fan (Kietzmann et al., 2011). Accordingly, the research questions guiding this study are: How do internationalizing SMEs strengthen their network ties in the SM context? and how does the strength of those network ties trigger opportunity realization in a foreign market? We undertake a detailed exploration of these research questions from both theoretical and practical viewpoints. While many studies (e.g. Ellis, 2011; Gilbert & Karahalios, 2009; Granovetter, 1973) have applied tie strength in different contexts and at different levels of analysis, in this study, we applied organizational-level network-tie analysis in the context of SM and SME internationalization. On network type, the study’s focus is not on a specific network (e.g. suppliers). In order to have

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization. . .

127

an in-depth and holistic understanding of network tactics and strategies, the focus is on any network in general which encompasses customers, suppliers, individuals, and other online followers. Arguably, understanding how network ties are strengthened via the SM context and the related opportunities realized will lead to the effective use of SM platforms. The theoretical arguments of the study is based on the social network approach focusing on ties (Granovetter, 1973), SM marketing capability literature, and SME internationalization. Following Quinton and Wilson (2016), the author extends the investigation of ties into the under-researched SM context. The empirical basis of this study is data from internationalizing Finnish SMEs. The study adopts a multiple-case study using the netnography approach and semi-structured interviews to collect data. Considerably, netnography is a novel approach because it offers the opportunity to observe and fully understand online interactions between network parties in the digitalized environment (Quinton & Wilson, 2016). This study makes the following theoretical contributions to expand extant IB literature and theories. First, it contributes to social capital studies in the context of SM. Social capital studies seek to explain variation in success as a function of network ties (Borgatti & Foster, 2003); however, the present study extends this further by providing a nuanced understanding of how network ties are strengthened in SM. The study achieves that through its focus on SM marketing capability literature and the entrepreneurial behaviour of firms informed by the social network approach. Second, as Maltby (2012) stated, ‘little is known about the principles, processes, and tools that entrepreneurs can use to accelerate their startups’ internationalization from inception’ (p. 22). By integrating SM into the discussion as a contextual facilitator of network-tie strength in firm internationalization, this study advances knowledge of the processes and tools that facilitate internationalization processes in SMEs (and in our case, startups). The study thereby contributes to the call made by Coviello et al. (2017) to investigate digitalization as a new context of firm internationalization. Third, according to Knight and Liesch (2016), opportunityrelated studies are an emergent force in internationalization research, and this contribution integrates international perspectives of SMEs and SM to advance our knowledge of opportunity-based studies (Knight & Liesch, 2016), thus responding to the call for interdisciplinary studies (Cavusgil & Knight, 2015).

2 Theoretical Background 2.1

The Social Media Context

A context refers to as ‘. . . situational opportunities and constraints that affect the occurrence and meaning of organizational behavior as well as functional relationships between variables’ (Johns, 2006, p. 386). The SM context comprises both the omnibus and discrete contexts (McFarland & Ployhart, 2015). The omnibus context represents a human-constructed digital system based on Web 2.0 technology that facilitates social interaction and communication (e.g. Twitter, LinkedIn, and

128

E. K. Appiah

Facebook). In contrast, the discrete context represents specific characteristics that influence the occurrence and meanings of behaviours (Johns, 2006; McFarland & Ployhart, 2015). According to McFarland and Ployhart (2015), the discrete ambiance encapsulates the following characteristics. First, physicality, which represents the irrelevance of physical constraints in hindering SM interactions (McFarland & Ployhart, 2015). Second, accessibility, which stands for open-access structure that facilitates an easy connection to networks. Third, temporal (latency), which represents the instantaneous nature in sharing content. Fourth, interdependence, which refers to the interrelatedness of interactions. Fifth, synchronicity and asynchronicity, which represents the possibility to be temporally ‘in tune’ or interact at one’s own pace. Sixth, permanence which relates to the longevity of posts on SM. Seventh, verifiability relates to the extent to which content posted to SM can be checked.

2.2

Social Network Approach

According to social network theory, the number of connections or the strength of ties in a network is inversely related to relationship quality (Quinton & Wilson, 2016). Granovetter (1973) proposed a four-tie strength dimension to determine the strength of network ties. The ties are duration, intimacy, intensity, and reciprocal services. Scholars (e.g. Gilbert & Karahalios, 2009) have adapted the dimensions in a SM context. In the context of SM, duration means the frequency of contact among ties, and intimacy means the number of friends/followers, time since the last communication, and the extent of communication between ties, such as the exchange of messages, sharing of posts, and direct messages (Gilbert & Karahalios, 2009). Intensity means closeness (Marsden & Campbell, 1984), measured, for instance, by inbox messages exchanged, participant-initiated wall posts, friend-initiated wall posts, and comments on pictures. Finally, reciprocal services are links exchanged by wall posts, etc. Reciprocity relates to the transmitting and sharing of content and others responding to, possibly commenting, showing likes, or sharing with others, and is acknowledged as strengthening business relationships (Quinton & Wilson, 2016). Existing studies (e.g. Gilbert & Karahalios, 2009) focus on how the networktie dimensions predict tie strength on SM. However, the underlying tactics that strengthen network ties have not been revealed.

2.3

Social Networking Tactics

In this paper, we define networking tactics as what a firm does with its SM marketing capability to establish relationships with others. According to Drummond et al. (2020), SM marketing capability encompasses four layered abilities. They are, the ability to connect, engage, coordinate, and collaborate in interaction with partners in a network. First, the ability to connect means targeting and receiving messages from

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization. . .

129

users from beyond the firm’s local networks (Drummond et al., 2020). Second, the ability to engage means using SM to communicate and exchange social and business messages among partners—which can be termed as social-interactive engagement (Calder et al., 2009). Engagement in a social media context is marked with different perspectives, namely—engagement focused non-purchase activities, engagement focused on purchase activities, and engagement focused on both non-purchase activities and purchase activities (Calder et al., 2009; Halloran & Lutz, 2021; Malthouse et al., 2013). Third, the firm’s ability to coordinate means using SM to interact and share resources between partners. Fourth, the firm’s ability to collaborate means using SM for co-creation activities, such as creating new products or solving problems among partners (Drummond et al., 2020). Extant studies (e.g. Loureiro & Kaufmann, 2018) have investigated how these tactics influence the behaviour of firms and consumers.

2.4

Social Media and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization

Internationalizing SMEs leverage SM as a strategic resource to undertake entrepreneurial action, such as the creation of social networks, extraction of information on foreign markets, or mitigation of probable challenges arising from foreign market uncertainty (Alarcón-del-Amo et al., 2018; Arnone & Deprince, 2016). Arnone and Deprince (2016) focused on the role of social networking sites in the internationalization of small businesses and found that SM usage enables small ventures to create professional and personal relationships with foreign partners, identify market opportunities, and reduce the effect of psychic distance. Nowiński and Rialp (2016), in contrast, examined the role of social networks in the developmental process of international new ventures (INVs) and found that SM contributes to the development of INVs by providing new information to support founders in identifying and assessing international opportunities. To conclude, SM can be of considerable help to internationalizing SMEs by providing opportunities to communicate with current and prospective customers, create awareness, create strategic partnerships with customers, and develop new capabilities to enhance customer relationships (Malthouse et al., 2013). However, the inherent nuances and opportunities derived from the strength of network ties established via SM among internationalizing SMEs are not fully understood. This is puzzling given that SM platforms contain several communication features that support network building, such as status updates, chats, wall posts, inbox messages, LinkedIn suggested contacts feature, Twitter Highlights, and Twitter hashtags. To understand the tactics that firms employ with these SM features to strengthen network ties and the associated nuances and opportunities, the author conducted qualitative research among internationalizing SMEs that have adopted SM as one of the strategic tools in their organizational activities.

130

E. K. Appiah

3 Methodology The study applied a case study method to provide a thorough understanding of the dynamics present within single settings (Eisenhardt, 1989; Eisenhardt & Graebner, 2007). Further, the case study method was appropriate because it allowed the author to analyse the phenomenon (network ties and opportunity recognition) and context (SM) simultaneously (Ellis, 2011; Yin, 2003). The author opted for a multiple-case study design to identify similarities and differences among the cases without any form of manipulation (Yin, 1994). The entire study followed the steps proposed by Yin (2009) for conducting a multiple-case study that includes theory development, case selection, and design of the case-specific data collection protocols, preparation, and analyses. The theoretical framework underpinning this study is the social network approach, and the analysis is supported by SM marketing capability and SME internationalization literature.

3.1

Case Selection

This study followed a purposive sampling method to select the case firms to ensure that selected firms suited the purpose of the study and were homogeneous (Patton, 2015), using the following criteria for case selection. First, the case firm must be an SME with fewer than 250 employees (Eurostat, 2020). The study focused on SMEs because they are known to adapt to using new technologies and can often be quicker to address international opportunities—and be more flexible and responsive—than large firms (Crick, 2009). Second, the firm that should have already started internationalizing right from inception and should be using or have used SM at least within 3 years since inception. Arguably, the author used the 3-year time frame to minimize validity issues and recall bias. In sum, seven firms meeting all the criteria were contacted, and four agreed to participate. The selected firms fit the purposes of theory building concerning the investigated phenomenon. The number of cases selected is in line with Eisenhardt’s (Eisenhardt, 1989) suggestion that having four to ten cases usually provides a basis for generalizing from case material to theory. Table 1 provides a short description of the case firms investigated. For reasons of confidentiality, the names of the firms were represented by fictitious names.

3.2

Data Collection

As reported by Yin (2002), case study research should be supported with multiple sources of evidence. Given this, the study follows a two-stage qualitative research, in that the author employed netnographic research principles (Kozinets et al., 2014)

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization. . .

131

Table 1 Background of case firms Firm Year of inception Area of operation

Alpha 2015 (operations began 2016) Cleaning industrial equipment with ultrasound power

Founders Foreign operations

2 persons Thailand, Japan, the Netherlands, Switzerland, Spain, Sweden, and the United States 95%

2 persons Europe and the United States

Helsinki, Finland

Share of foreign sales within 3 years of establishment Headquarters Social Media Account Starting Year

Facebook, Twitter, YouTube, Instagram, and LinkedIn (2017)

Gamma 2016

Power 2012

Beta 2015

Software development business

Provides energy competencies to B2B customers based on lean principles and built on teamwork 1 person Japan, Sweden, Czech Republic, Germany, Belgium, and Norway

Design and distribution of industrial lighting for mining, oil and gas, and heavy industries 2 persons Sweden, Norway, Denmark, Estonia, Latvia, Lithuania, and the UK

70%

70%

85%

Helsinki, Finland Facebook, LinkedIn, and Twitter (2016); YouTube (2017); Instagram (2018)

Vaasa, Finland

Vaasa, Finland

Facebook, Twitter, and LinkedIn (2014)

LinkedIn and Facebook (2015)

involving analysing the firms’ websites, SM platforms, and blogs, and combined that approach with semi-structured face-to-face interviews. Data from both sources ensure construct validity, that is, triangulation (Yin, 2002, 2013). Using a netnographic research approach provides the researcher with an idea of what people are actually doing, not what they are perceiving, or what they tell outsiders in an interview situation. In the context of this study, the author use the netnographic approach to understand the social interactions of the case firms on SM platforms. The sampling duration for data collection from the SM platforms of the case firms was from March 2018 to June 2021. The author conducted the procedures manually by using an excel code sheet to record the information. Table 2 provides some of the data elicited from the SM platforms of the case firms that occurred during the two rounds of interviews. The adoption of semi-structured face-to-face interviews creates flexibility and makes it possible to obtain diverse insights. The author ensured that the questions for the semi-structured interviews were correctly designed and met reliability standards by piloting them to check for inconsistencies before the actual interview process was

As at first interview

As at first interview

As at first interview

Gamma

Power

Beta

Firm Alpha

As at first interview As at first interview

132 followers

64 followers

2234 followers

LinkedIn 390 followers

Twitter 203 followers 203 following 374 tweets 400 likes 132 followers 183 following 653 tweets 90 likes 23 following 23 followers 58 tweets 0 likes

Table 2 Social media data on case firms

264 followers 122 following 180 posts

8 subscribers 4 videos 1.4 K views

56 followers 50 likes

22 followers 20 likes

329 followers 326 likes

Instagram 86 followers 133 following 74 posts

YouTube 22 subscribers 4 videos 13.0 K views

Facebook 90 followers 80 likes

As at second interview

As at second interview

As at second interview

As at second interview As at second interview

141 followers

80 followers

2234 followers

LinkedIn 431 followers

Twitter 208 followers 209 following 390 tweets 489 likes 161 followers 183 following 828 tweets 190 likes 25 following 24 followers 58 tweets 0 likes

408 followers 152 following 358 posts

9 subscribers 5 videos 1.5 K views 117 followers 94 likes

22 followers 23 likes

329 followers 326 likes

Instagram 97 followers 135 following 86 posts

YouTube 55 subscribers 4 videos 13.4 K views

Facebook 100 followers 86 likes

132 E. K. Appiah

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization. . .

133

Table 3 Data collection process Firm Position

Alpha Marketing Director

Length of interview (first round)

1h 10 mins Company premises 09/04/ 2019 20 pages 48 min Company premises 02/05/ 2020 15 pages 25 pages

Venue (first round) Date No. of transcribed pages Length of interview (second round) Venue (second round) Date No. of transcribed pages No. of textual pages transcribed from SM platforms (e.g. comments, videos, podcast, and photos)

Gamma Chief Commercial Officer/Cofounder 1h

Power CEO (entrepreneur)

Beta Marketing Director

1 h 15 min

1 h 05 min

Company premises 08/05/2019

Company premises 10/05/2019

17 pages 50 min Company premises 14/05/2020

20 pages 1h Company premises 18/05/2020

14 pages 21 pages

18 pages 17 pages

Company premises 16/05/ 2019 19 pages 40 min Company premises 16/05/ 2020 14 pages 12 pages

conducted. During the interview process, close attention was paid to the interview protocol to ensure that the right questions were asked and continued by revising the protocol with probing questions as and when necessary. The interviewing was conducted in two rounds. The first round of interviews centred on the firm’s establishment, its internationalization process, objectives for initial SM usage, and ongoing SM usage strategies for networking. The second round of interviews focused mainly on the opportunities and dynamics associated with the ongoing use of SM for networking. Table 3 provides an overview of the data collection process facilitated by semi-structured interviews.

3.3

Data Analyses

The author audio-recorded the interviews and transcribed verbatim into Microsoft Word documents. Thereafter, a summary report of the transcribed interviews was sent to the interviewees to check the accuracy of the information. In addition, the author transcribed the contextual observations made in each interview formulated as interim summaries. The interim summaries proved to be invaluable aids in that they supported developing reflexivity in recalling the context, the observation content, and the subsequent interpretations (Saunders et al., 2016). Following Miles et al. (2014), the author cleansed the data to remove irrelevant information. The analyses began by assigning codes to the data chunks using in vivo coding to detect recurring

134

E. K. Appiah

patterns and then combined similar codes to form pattern codes or themes (Saldaña, 2013). Next, a cross-case analysis was conducted using concepts from network ties, SM marketing capability, and opportunity recognition literature as a guide to derive conclusions.

4 Findings 4.1

Omnibus Context

According to the findings, psychosocial context within which interaction ensues includes Twitter, LinkedIn, Instagram, Facebook, and blogs (see Table 2). The aforementioned contexts provide the case firms the ability to strengthen network ties. . . . Instagram, Twitter, and LinkedIn help us to not only reach out but also to connect . . . We are actively visible on LinkedIn and keep posting photos and interesting discussions. (Gamma, chief commercial officer)

4.2

Discrete Context

The findings are structured so as to reflect the tactics for strengthening network ties focusing on the dimensions of network strengths identified in the literature, which is supported by SM marketing capability and the associated opportunity that is recognized in a discrete context. The analysis reveals three dimensions of network strength: duration, intimacy, and reciprocity.

4.3

Duration

Clear differences are not evident among the node structures (i.e. the type of followers who follow the case firms). The findings show that the followers include customers, business executives, partners, and ordinary people. The chief commercial officer of Gamma explained: For example, on Instagram, there are businesspeople, our customers, people in the industry, and even people who are in entertainment and who have nothing to do with our business but are interested in what we do . . . On LinkedIn, there are customers, business people who are either prospective employees for us or prospective customers and industry people.

Given the asynchronous nature of SM context, when we asked about the frequency of contact with and postings to followers, the author found the numbers varied for each firm. According to the marketing director of Alpha, the firm is active on SM weekly to share industrial-related content and comment on relevant content.

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization. . .

135

The firm also updates its blog page at least three times every month. The CEO of Power described how the firm was active on a semi-regular basis and used time efficiently to share content with its networks. Gamma’s chief commercial officer described the firm as active online most of the time: ‘We do not do it daily yet, so it is still like every other day, but I would say three times a week’. In contrast, the marketing director of Beta stated the firm used SM as much as possible but was not frequently active: Yes, we are using it as much as possible . . . We are looking for a path, setting goals and objectives . . . Now we are building on our existing strategy on how we can use it [SM] more in the future for our online networking.

4.3.1

Opportunity Recognition

The findings indicate that the frequency of online (Saldaña, 2013) content postings and commenting has enabled the case firms to bolster brand recognition, as exemplified below: We are actively visible on LinkedIn and keep posting photos and interesting discussions. This has increased the traffic to our LinkedIn profile. We have visitors from the USA, UK, and countries around the globe . . . Our foreign networks have increased. Because we have a strong presence on SM, companies would like to associate themselves with our brand. (Gamma) We use google analytics weekly to analyse our blog page to find out how many people read our article, what specific pages they visited, and also the top countries the visitors are from . . . Sometimes, the USA is first, followed by Finland . . . it really varies . . . Some of our followers have contacted us expressing their interest in our technology, requesting that we send them some of the presentations and showcase videos. (Alpha)

4.4

Intimacy

Table 2 illustrates how the number of SM followers of the case companies has increased rapidly over the years. For example, during the first round of interviews, Gamma had 2234 followers on LinkedIn, 132 on Twitter, 56 on Facebook, 264 on Instagram, and four subscribers on YouTube. However, by the time of the second round of interviews, Twitter followers had risen to 161, Facebook followers to 117, Instagram followers to 408, and the firm had nine subscribers to its YouTube videos. The shared content on the various SM platforms shows a diversity of tactics adopted by the case firms to enhance their intimacy with followers. For example, tweeting customers’ success stories. Moving with Gamma has given us one referential place, and we were able to tailor the database to fit our workflow, rather than our workflow changing to match the database. Customer X (Tweeted by Gamma, 11th June 2021)

136

E. K. Appiah

Apart from tweeting, the case firms adopted tactics that included posting projectbased cases, customer cases, using periodic suggestions from LinkedIn to connect to potential contacts, posting engaging messages, videos, industrial news, events, and achievements on various SM platforms, and sending its online followers a link to its blog site. The following exemplifies the process involved: For customers, it is about staying active and showing them what we are doing, sharing, and engaging with them through informative content, and providing more insights for them . . . On our Instagram page, we post project-based cases and customer cases . . . Some of the companies that have scrolled through our Instagram page have contacted us expressing their interest in our technology, requesting that we send them some of the presentations and showcase videos. (Alpha) We take advantage of the periodic suggestions made by LinkedIn of users whose interests or profiles are similar to our area of operations . . . Usually, we send them requests, and those that accept our requests, we send them offers and information on our services . . . That initiates the networking journey (Power)

In posting engaging contents, the findings also reveal that the access characteristic related to a social media context influences the way it is carried out. A lot is happening on social media, and the content you post can be rendered obsolete by newer postings from other users . . . Yes, we customize. Every post that goes out we think of like, who is this message for, and what is the target of that message, always. (Gamma).

Furthermore, intimacy was evident in those postings focused on firm-related achievements, generating comments and likes. For example, a LinkedIn posting made by Gamma about one of its achievements garnered 143 likes and prompted 22 comments. That posting is reproduced below. The secret is out! We’re excited to share that we’ve closed a $16 Million Series A round led by Sapphire Sport (Sapphire Ventures) and supported by Icebreaker.vc and Global Founders Capital! (Shared by Gamma in April 2021) Remember well when you called me years ago and sold your solution. I couldn’t go with you, but I realized these are serious [about the] business. The work rewards the perpetrator, and your journey has continued [and delivered] tremendous growth. Congratulations! (Comment from a follower) Congratulations—really looking forward to the next chapter of growth! (Comment from a follower)

4.4.1

Opportunity Recognition

The current investigation reveals the tactics used to enhance intimacy with followers include writing short LinkedIn posts, posting pictures of events, posting on the company’s activities to engage followers on SM (e.g. LinkedIn, Instagram, and Twitter). Moreover, those tactics have enabled the case firms to recognize opportunities in foreign markets. According to the CEO of Power, using SM has increased the visibility of the firm. He also asserted that taking advantage of periodic suggestions of other LinkedIn users based on the firm’s background provided by LinkedIn

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization. . .

137

enables the firm to conduct prospecting and build new ties. The CEO described how the firm sends friend requests to such people and organizations, and those that accept their requests are sent offers and messages about the firm’s services. In the operations of Beta, according to the marketing director, the firm has tried Facebook and LinkedIn but of the two, LinkedIn has created a clearer opportunity for the firm to expand its foreign networks and enhanced its brand image. He explained: We have used LinkedIn. The focus is to measure and find the winning solution. In addition, Facebook . . . we have not tried Twitter . . . LinkedIn has supported us immensely in expanding our foreign networks . . . Over the years our LinkedIn contacts are growing, and the brand image has enhanced.

Further, browsing the SM (LinkedIn and Twitter) used by followers and their comments, has created opportunities to convey knowledge and broaden accessibility for Alpha and Gamma. You start to see, followers (firms) who are really active online . . . also they tell us what is happening . . . for example, if we have an expo somewhere we sometimes get information from our networks, their postings on LinkedIn and Twitter . . . We can actually see what the world is doing through them, in our industry (Alpha). For the target group, which is business-to-business, we reach out to relate to them in the best way through LinkedIn . . . We use LinkedIn to understand the key people we are meeting; who they are and where they are coming from . . . (Gamma).

4.5

Reciprocity

The content shared on the SM pages of the case firms included videos, retweeted news, industry issues, events, and photographs of firm-related activities. Gamma has 262 photos and videos on its Twitter page, Alpha (144), Power (2). Because time and space are no longer barriers, the interdependence characteristics of SM context allowed the opportunity for interactions to emerge between the case firms and followers. Followers viewed and commented on shared videos, discussions, events, and photos of firm-related activities. For example, Gamma shared a video explaining its core values on LinkedIn on May 4th, mothers’ day and it garnered 702 views, 39 likes, and four comments. ‘What a way of celebrating May the 4th! . . . . Love it!’ (Comment by a follower). Among the case firms specifically Gamma, Alpha, and Power have strategies and tactics that support the effective use of SM in strengthening ties through the process of reciprocity . . . As our strategy, we connect to companies and those that accept our request to follow us, we also follow back. So, there’s already a connection . . . We also post interesting content on our pages (Gamma, chief commercial officer) When it comes to all platforms, such as Instagram and Twitter, there are companies that are actively using them and some of these are following us. Going through their online profiles, we also follow those we deem relevant . . . Our followers not only read our posts but also sometimes comment on them or like them (Alpha, marketing director)

138

E. K. Appiah

Our SM strategy is quite simple but is proving effective. One colleague does most of the LinkedIn short postings, I like them and share them, depending on content and aim. We get comments and likes from our followers and send replies to most of the shared posts. (Power, CEO)

The author found the LinkedIn page of Beta had little content, which the marketing director explained is because the firm has few followers. In view of that, they use their private LinkedIn accounts to engage with potential clients. I make a post and my colleague does, on the company’s activities and impending events on LinkedIn and links them to our networks. Through that, we have received positive comments and inquiries from people from different countries. (Beta, marketing director)

Furthermore, the case companies’ Twitter pages feature retweets that reflect reciprocity. Interesting information shared by followers or partners on Twitter that related to the case firms was retweeted. On the Twitter pages of Gamma and Alpha, we found numerous examples of retweeted content, some of which we reproduce below. One of the best parts of leading the Salesforce ISV team is that I get to meet incredible entrepreneurs from around the globe. Congrats to our appexchange partner, Gamma for announcing their $16M Series A led by XXX (retweeted, Gamma, January 28, 2021) A must-watch! Roger Berman, ZenWorks Licensing takes you on a walkabout of everything on show at Licensing Japan – an actual real-life trade show! (retweeted, Gamma, on April 15, 2021, 2 likes) Hello alternative sources of protein! joins X House and expands to Europe as they partner up with Y and bring their insect-based products to stores in Poland, Czech Republic, Bulgaria & Croatia! (retweeted, Alpha, Apr 22, 2020, 24 likes)

4.5.1

Opportunity Recognition

According to the findings, frequent interactions with followers, especially companies on SM fostered opportunity recognition in foreign markets. Scrutinizing the actions of Gamma and Alpha in reciprocally following the LinkedIn, Instagram, and Twitter pages of other firms and other followers revealed the firms were identifying opportunities through such actions. A lot of opportunities are available . . . You start to see, especially people who are active on the market . . . Well, I would say, first, getting new customers. That is the number one that we get from there . . . also, we get current information . . . for example, if we have an expo somewhere we get information from our networks’ postings on LinkedIn and Twitter . . . We can see what the world is doing through our frequent interactions with our followers (Gamma, chief commercial officer) . . . also, when it comes to Twitter, a simple hashtag will reveal information on companies. At the beginning of last year, I tried to search for information on some of the companies following us who do the same thing as we do, and lo and behold, I had access to all that they have said or written about their operations . . . (Alpha, marketing director)

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization. . .

139

Furthermore, the findings show that the interactions between the case firms and followers have enhanced their brand visibility and opened new foreign market avenues. For instance, sharing posts and case videos meant the case firms received requests from foreign companies. On our Instagram page, we post project-based cases and customer cases . . . and we have been contacting those who have expressed an interest in our solutions by sending them private messages. (Alpha, marketing director) Through my high-quality network of more than 2500 contacts . . . what we post, and share reaches foreigners, and it increases our visibility. (CEO, Power) We have received positive comments and inquiries from people from different countries . . . LinkedIn has supported us immensely in expanding our foreign networks . . . Over the years our LinkedIn contacts are growing, and the brand image has been enhanced. (Beta, marketing director) We are active and visible on LinkedIn and keep posting photos and interesting discussions. This has increased the traffic to our LinkedIn profile. We have visitors from the USA, Finland, and countries around the globe . . . Our foreign networks have increased. (Gamma, chief commercial officer)

5 Discussion Figure 1 incorporates the findings to present a conceptual framework illustrating how internationalizing SMEs strengthen their network ties in the SM context and the associated opportunity realization in a foreign market. As pointed out by McFarland and Ployhart (2015), understanding the nature of behaviour within a SM context requires understanding of both the discrete and omnibus context. As shown in the conceptual model, relationships or networks are supported by discrete ambient characteristics (i.e. interdependence, accessibility, and asynchronicity) and omnibus context (i.e. LinkedIn, Twitter, Facebook, Instagram, and blog). This differentiates SM from traditional (e.g. face-to-face) and other digital (e.g. email) contexts (McFarland & Ployhart, 2015). For example, unlike traditional (e.g. face-to-face) which demands close physical proximity to gain opportunity to change from being an outsider to an insider to a network (Ibarra & Andrews, 1993), the open access of SM enabled the case firms to attract numerous followers. In line with Granovetter’s (1973) dimensions of tie strength, the conceptual model shows that the case firms based tactical initiatives such as tweeting customers’ stories, retweeting stories, posting contents, and commenting on contents posted by followers to strengthen ties on the dimensions of reciprocity, intimacy, and duration. The tactical initiatives emerge from the case firms’ SM marketing capabilities in the form of their ability to use an SM platform to connect and engage with prospective customers and then coordinate interactions with online followers (Drummond et al., 2020). We found that because the case firms (e.g. Gamma) have a strong presence on SM, other companies wish to associate themselves with their brand. This confirms Granovetter’s (1973) assertion that the strength of a tie is determined by duration,

140

E. K. Appiah

Omnibus Context

Digital: Social Media LinkedIn, Twitter, Facebook, Instagram, and Blog

Discrete Ambient Stimuli

Interdependence

Accessibility

Asynchronousity

Tactics/Strategies Reciprocity: retweeting news, industrial discussions and events; mutual commenting on contents posted by followers

Intimacy: Tweeting customers’ stories, posting customer-based cases, posting engaging messages, videos, industrial news and events

Duration: Frequency of online content postings and commenting

International Opportunity Recognition - Foreign network expansion - Creation of brand awareness - Access to information on competitor activity, potential customers and partners

Fig. 1 Conceptual framework developed from the findings

which in the present study refers to how often the case firms post content or engage with followers on SM. As a way of improving intimacy, the case firms adopted the tactic of maintaining online activity, sharing informative content with followers and engaging with them, and exchanging direct messages (Marsden & Campbell, 1984). For example, Alpha follows up periodic suggestions of people or firms to connect with offered by the LinkedIn application to expand its own network of connections, and if the connection request is accepted, the firm sends information on its services. The case firms exhibit different levels of intimacy in terms of the number of followers and level of engagement focusing on non-purchase activities (Gilbert & Karahalios, 2009; Halloran & Lutz, 2021; Malthouse et al., 2013). The analyses corroborate existential theorization that reciprocity strengthens relationships (Granovetter, 1973; Quinton & Wilson, 2016), which was evident in the case of Gamma and Alpha. Reciprocity appears in the form of expressing interest by following back those who follow the firm, retweeting news, industrial discussions, events, and photos posted by followers, and mutual commenting on content. Concerning opportunity recognition, the conceptual model brings to light the importance of the tactical initiatives. To a certain extent, some of the opportunities are similar and some are extensions of the others. For example, according to the CEO

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization. . .

141

of Power, using LinkedIn to strengthen online network ties creates opportunities for expanding into foreign networks. Findings from the other case firms extend this notion by including opportunities such as the creation of brand awareness, access to information on competitor activity, potential customers and partners, and industry events. Furthermore, unlike the traditional business network perspective, where weak ties are usually direct (Ellis, 2011), the results of the analyses show that internationalizing SMEs can obtain information from weak ties that are either direct or indirect. For example, in using a Twitter hashtag to search for information on competitors, the marketing director of Alpha was able to access information on what they do, what they have said, and what others have said about them. Another example was provided by Power leveraging the suggestions of people or firms to connect with that come via the LinkedIn platform to identify and approach prospective customers. Despite the case firms’ earliness in the foreign market, the findings show that writing short posts, posting pictures and videos of events, commenting, liking, and retweeting shared posts by the case firms have enhanced their brand awareness and offered access to new foreign market knowledge and opportunities. The findings corroborate extant studies asserting that SM usage has a positive impact on networking and information accessibility (see Arnone & Deprince, 2016; Parveen et al., 2016). Further, the findings provide evidence on how to overcome the problem of legitimacy, which is tightly coupled with the liability of foreignness associated with young internationalizing SMEs. The findings confirm the assertion in social network theory that a larger number of connections enhance information accessibility (Quinton & Wilson, 2016) but it is contrary to the assertion that too many connections might result in difficulty in managing information and relationship with network members (Burt, 1992). Arguably, the contrary finding is a result of the presence of the discrete ambient characteristics (i.e. accessibility, asynchronicity, and interdependence) of the SM context. For example, the SM platforms used by the case firms are open (accessible) to more followers (interdependence) from any location in a convenient manner (asynchronicity). The findings show that the ability to interact anywhere, anytime, with followers, and according to one’s schedule has the potential to strengthen network ties.

6 Conclusion This study utilized theoretical arguments drawn from the social network approach, SM marketing capability literature, and SME internationalization literature to investigate how network ties are strengthened in an SM context and how it supports opportunity recognition in a foreign market. Thus, the study offers both theoretical and practical insights.

142

6.1

E. K. Appiah

Theoretical and Practical Implications

First, the study contributes to social capital studies in the context of SM usage at the organizational level. Instead of trying to explain variation in success as a function of network ties (Borgatti & Foster, 2003), we take a step further by providing a nuanced understanding of how network ties are strengthened on SM. By integrating insights from social network theory, opportunity recognition literature, and literature on SM, the study highlights the associated tactics and corresponding opportunities recognized in the usage of SM. Second, the digitalization of business operations has challenged the traditional way of conducting foreign business operations, prompting researchers to investigate the sources and implications of the use of digital technologies. By studying network ties and opportunity recognition via SM, the study advances our knowledge of the processes and tools that facilitate internationalization processes among SMEs, and specifically, startups. In so doing, it contributes to research on the internationalization of firms in a digital context (Coviello et al., 2017) and the call for interdisciplinary studies (Cavusgil & Knight, 2015). Finally, the study advances our knowledge of opportunity-based studies by highlighting some of the strategies used by internationalizing SMEs for opportunity recognition in the context of SM usage and network ties. According to Ellis (2011), little is known about the strategies used for opportunity recognition. Similarly, Knight and Liesch (2016) revealed that opportunity recognition studies are an emergent force in internationalization research. In bringing into the limelight the associated opportunities with network-tie strengths via SM, the study contributes to emergent studies on opportunity recognition. From a practical point of view, this study will help international entrepreneurs and information technology managers understand the efficacy of SM in online network development and opportunity recognition in an overseas market. International entrepreneurs are encouraged to utilize more digital content marketing activities (e.g. making posts and sharing videos, presentations, and product offers) as an important element of an SM strategy. That advice is based on the findings of the present study indicating that digital content marketing activities disseminated via SM play a key role in strengthening online network ties and facilitating the opportunity recognition process of internationalizing firms.

6.2

Limitations

The current study is qualitative, meaning the potential for statistical generalization is limited. However, the findings are generalizable in relation to theory (Yin, 2013). Furthermore, the data may be culturally biased since the case firms are from Finland. Therefore, it is recommended that future studies conduct a similar study with SMEs from different cultural contexts. Lastly, the possibility of SM also weakening

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization. . .

143

network ties was beyond the scope of this study. Therefore, scholars are encouraged to have a careful examination of this.

References Alarcón-del-Amo, M., Rialp-Criado, A., & Rialp-Criado, J. (2018). Examining the impact of managerial involvement with social media on exporting firm performance. International Business Review, 27(2), 355–366. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.ibusrev.2017.09.003 Arnone, L., & Deprince, E. (2016). Small firms internationalization: Reducing the psychic distance using social networks. ERPN: Entrepreneurs (Finance) (Topic). Borgatti, S., & Foster, P. (2003). The network paradigm in organizational research: A review and typology. Journal of Management, 29(6), 991–1013. https://doi.org/10.1016/s0149-2063_03_ 00087-4 Burt, R. (1992). Structural holes: The social structure of competition. Harvard University Press. Calder, B. J., Malthouse, E. C., & Schaedel, U. (2009). An experimental study of the relationship between online engagement and advertising effectiveness. Journal of Interactive Marketing, 23(4), 321–331. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.intmar.2009.07.002 Cavusgil, S., & Knight, G. (2015). The born global firm: An entrepreneurial and capabilities perspective on early and rapid internationalization. Journal of International Business Studies, 46(1), 3–16. https://doi.org/10.1057/jibs.2014.62 Coviello, N., & Munro, H. (1995). Growing the entrepreneurial firm. European Journal of Marketing, 29(7), 49–61. https://doi.org/10.1108/03090569510095008 Coviello, N., Kano, L., & Liesch, P. (2017). Adapting the Uppsala model to a modern world: Macro-context and microfoundations. Journal of International Business Studies, 48(9), 1151–1164. https://doi.org/10.1057/s41267-017-0120-x Crick, D. (2009). The internationalisation of born global and international new venture SMEs. International Marketing Review, 26(4/5), 453–476. https://doi.org/10.1108/ 02651330910971986 Drummond, C., O’Toole, T., & McGrath, H. (2020). Digital engagement strategies and tactics in social media marketing. European Journal of Marketing, 54(6), 1247–1280. https://doi.org/10. 1108/ejm-02-2019-0183 Eisenhardt, K. (1989). Building theories from case study research. Academy of Management Review, 14(4), 532–550. https://doi.org/10.5465/amr.1989.4308385 Eisenhardt, K. M., & Graebner, M. E. (2007). Theory building from cases: Opportunities and challenges. Academy of Management Journal, 50(1), 25–32. https://doi.org/10.5465/amj.2007. 24160888 Ellis, P. (2011). Social ties and international entrepreneurship: Opportunities and constraints affecting firm internationalization. Journal of International Business Studies, 42(1), 99–127. https://doi.org/10.1057/jibs.2010.20 Eurostat. (2020). Small and medium-sized enterprises (SMEs). Retrieved on 24.03.2020 from https://ec.europa.eu/eurostat/web/structural-business-statistics/structural-business-statistics/sme Fraccastoro, S., Gabrielsson, M., & Chetty, S. (2021). Social media firm specific advantages as enablers of network embeddedness of international entrepreneurial ventures. Journal of World Business, 56(3), 101164. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jwb.2020.101164 Freixanet, J., Braojos, J., Rialp-Criado, A., & Rialp-Criado, J. (2020). Does international entrepreneurial orientation foster innovation performance? The mediating role of social media and open innovation. The International Journal of Entrepreneurship and Innovation, 22(1), 33–44. https://doi.org/10.1177/1465750320922320 Gilbert, E., & Karahalios, K. (2009). Predicting tie strength with social media. In CHI 2009: Digital Life New World - Proceedings of the 27th International Conference on Human Factors in

144

E. K. Appiah

Computing Systems (pp. 211–220). (Conference on Human Factors in Computing Systems Proceedings). doi:https://doi.org/10.1145/1518701.1518736. Granovetter, M. (1973). The strength of weak ties. American Journal of Sociology, 78(6), 1360–1380. https://doi.org/10.1086/225469 Halloran, T. J., & Lutz, R. J. (2021). Let's give them something to talk about: Which social media engagements predict purchase frequency? Journal of Interactive Marketing, 56, 83–95. https:// doi.org/10.1016/j.intmar.2021.05.003 Ibarra, H., & Andrews, S. (1993). Power, social influence, and sense making: Effects of network centrality and proximity on employee perceptions. Administrative Science Quarterly, 38(2), 277. https://doi.org/10.2307/2393414 Johanson, J., & Mattsson, L.-G. (1988). Internationalisation in industrial systems - A network approach. In Strategies in global competition (pp. 287–314). Retrieved from http://urn.kb.se/ resolve?urn=urn:nbn:se:uu:diva-18113 Johanson, J., & Vahlne, J. (2009). The Uppsala internationalization process model revisited: From liability of foreignness to liability of outsidership. Journal of International Business Studies, 40(9), 1411–1431. https://doi.org/10.1057/jibs.2009.24 Johns, G. (2006). The essential impact of context on organizational behavior. Academy of Management Review, 31(2), 386–408. https://doi.org/10.5465/amr.2006.20208687 Kao, T., Yang, M., Wu, J., & Cheng, Y. (2016). Co-creating value with consumers through social media. Journal of Services Marketing, 30(2), 141–151. https://doi.org/10.1108/jsm-032014-0112 Kaplan, A., & Haenlein, M. (2010). Users of the world, unite! The challenges and opportunities of Social Media. Business Horizons, 53(1), 59–68. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.bushor.2009.09.003 Kietzmann, J., Hermkens, K., McCarthy, I., & Silvestre, B. (2011). Social media? Get serious! Understanding the functional building blocks of social media. Business Horizons, 54(3), 241–251. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.bushor.2011.01.005 Kiráľová, A., & Pavlíčeka, A. (2015). Development of social media strategies in tourism destination. Procedia - Social and Behavioral Sciences, 175, 358–366. https://doi.org/10.1016/j. sbspro.2015.01.1211 Knight, G., & Liesch, P. (2016). Internationalization: From incremental to born global. Journal of World Business, 51(1), 93–102. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jwb.2015.08.011 Kozinets, R. V., Pierre-Yann, D., & Amanda, E. (2014). Netnographic analysis: Understanding culture through social media data. In U. Flick (Ed.), Sage handbook of qualitative data analysis (pp. 262–275). Sage. Loureiro, S., & Kaufmann, H. (2018). The role of online brand community engagement on positive or negative self-expression word-of-mouth. Cogent Business and Management, 5, 1–24. https:// doi.org/10.1080/23311975.2018.1508543 Maltby, T. (2012). Using social media to accelerate the internationalization of startups from inception. Technology Innovation Management Review, 2(10), 22–26. https://doi.org/10. 22215/timreview616 Malthouse, E. C., Haenlein, M., Skiera, B., Wege, E., & Zhang, M. (2013). Managing customer relationships in the social media era: Introducing the social CRM House. Journal of Interactive Marketing, 27(4), 270–280. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.intmar.2013.09.008 Marsden, P., & Campbell, K. (1984). Measuring tie strength. Social Forces, 63(2), 482–501. https:// doi.org/10.1093/sf/63.2.482 McFarland, L., & Ployhart, R. (2015). Social media: A contextual framework to guide research and practice. Journal of Applied Psychology, 100(6), 1653–1677. https://doi.org/10.1037/a0039244 Miles, M. B., Huberman, A. M., & Saldana, J. (2014). Qualitative data analysis: A methods sourcebook. Sage. Monaghan, S., Tippmann, E., & Coviello, N. (2019). Born digitals: Thoughts on their internationalization and a research agenda. Journal of International Business Studies, 51(1), 11–22. https:// doi.org/10.1057/s41267-019-00290-0

Network Ties and Opportunity Recognition in SME Internationalization. . .

145

Nowiński, W., & Rialp, A. (2016). The impact of social networks on perceptions of international opportunities. Journal of Small Business Management, 54(2), 445–461. https://doi.org/10.1111/ jsbm.12149 Parveen, F., Jaafar, N., & Ainin, S. (2016). Social media’s impact on organizational performance and entrepreneurial orientation in organizations. Management Decision, 54(9), 2208–2234. https://doi.org/10.1108/md-08-2015-0336 Patton, M. Q. (2015). Qualitative research and evaluation methods (4th ed.). Sage. Quinton, S., & Wilson, D. (2016). Tensions and ties in social media networks: Towards a model of understanding business relationship development and business performance enhancement through the use of LinkedIn. Industrial Marketing Management, 54, 15–24. https://doi.org/10. 1016/j.indmarman.2015.12.001 Saldaña, J. (2013). The coding manual for qualitative researchers (2nd ed.). Sage. Saunders, M., Lewis, P., & Thornhill, A. (2016). Research methods for business students (7th ed.). Pearson Edu-cation Limited. UN. (2022). Sustainable development goals. Access on 17/10/2022 from: https://www.un.org/ sustainabledevelopment/infrastructure-industrialization/ Vadana, I., Kuivalainen, O., Torkkeli, L., & Saarenketo, S. (2021). The role of digitalization on the internationalization strategy of born-digital companies. Sustainability, 13(24), 14002. https:// doi.org/10.3390/su132414002 Williams, C., Du, J., & Zhang, H. (2020). International orientation of Chinese internet SMEs: Direct and indirect effects of foreign and indigenous social networking site use. Journal of World Business, 55(3), 101051. https://doi.org/10.1016/j.jwb.2019.101051 Yin, R. K. (1994). Case study research: Design and methods (2nd ed.). Sage. Yin, R. K. (2002). Case study research: Design and methods. Sage. Yin, R. K. (2003). Case Study Research: Design and Methods (3rd ed.). Sage. Yin, R. K. (2009). Case study research: Design and methods (4th ed.). Sage. Yin, R. (2013). Validity and generalization in future case study evaluations. Evaluation, 19(3), 321–332. https://doi.org/10.1177/1356389013497081 Zaheer, S. (1995). Overcoming the liability of foreignness. Academy of Management Journal, 38(2), 341–363. https://doi.org/10.2307/256683 Zahra, S. (2005). A theory of international new ventures: A decade of research. Journal of International Business Studies, 36(1), 20–28. https://doi.org/10.1057/palgrave.jibs.8400118 Zucchella, A. (2021). International entrepreneurship and the internationalization phenomenon: taking stock, looking ahead. International Business Review, 30(2), 101800. https://doi.org/10. 1016/j.ibusrev.2021.101800

Emmanuel Kusi Appiah received his Ph.D. in 2022 from the University of Vaasa. His dissertation deals with internationalization of new ventures in the digital context. Emmanuel’s research interest is on early internationalization at the interface of digitalization. He has presented his papers at top scientific conferences such as the Hawaii International Conference on System Sciences, Academy of International Business, McGill International Entrepreneurship, and European International Business Academy. Also, Emmanuel has previous consulting experience in the area of digital and social media marketing. He has worked as a reviewer for International Marketing Review, a reviewer of several conference proceedings, and a reviewer for several books.

Part II

Environmental Sustainability

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation Among International Businesses: A Review and Research Agenda Shadreck Matindike, Stephen Mago, Florah Sewela Modiba, and Amanda Van den Berg

Abstract Green entrepreneurship, though still under-studied, has become a matter of general sustainable development discourse. This chapter reviews the concept of green entrepreneurship adopted by international businesses in pursuit of environmental commitment and eco-innovation within the corpus of literature to identify common practices, trends, and gaps for future research agenda. Through bibliometric analysis and thematic analysis, an exploration of common environmental commitment and eco-innovation practices among international businesses was conducted using VOSviewer software. Consequently, the main themes were derived and discussed. Additionally, the study identifies literature gaps relevant to formulating a possible future research agenda.

1 Introduction Global warming and climate change were included in the world’s development goals at the beginning of the twenty-first century. It was recognized that human endeavours and commercial operations were badly impacting the environment. Scientists contend that climate change results from the toxic and other pollutants industry emits. All parties involved in the political and economic spheres have to work together with environmentalists to lessen the consequences of climate change (Junior et al., 2016; Khan, 2015; Kulkanjanapiban & Silwattananusarn, 2022; Long & Blok, 2021; Malavisi, 2018; Massoudi et al., 2017; Matthews et al., 2017). Climate change has certainly become one of humanity’s protracted concerns worldwide. Climate change is a unique challenge and may be the most significant market failure the S. Matindike (✉) · S. Mago · F. S. Modiba · A. Van den Berg Faculty of Business and Economic Sciences, Department of Development Studies, School of Economics, Development and Tourism, Nelson Mandela University, Gqeberha (formally Port Elizabeth), South Africa e-mail: [email protected]; [email protected]; [email protected]; [email protected]; [email protected] © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2023 P. Arte et al. (eds.), Sustainable International Business, Contributions to Management Science, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-43785-4_8

149

150

S. Matindike et al.

global economy has seen in years. The ongoing growth in human activity as a result of major modernization and the usage of fossil energy has accelerated greenhouse gas emissions into the environment. Many international institutions and economies are moving towards sustainable development and growth motivated by environmental preservation concerns and climate change adaptation (He & Liu, 2018; Matthews et al., 2017). The world body, United Nations, is working hard to keep temperatures leading to global warming beneath 2 °C at the end of the century to preserve humanity and the ecosystem from the harmful effects of climate change (Adekoya et al., 2021). As a result, numerous governments in both developed and emerging economies have undertaken steps to minimize greenhouse gas emissions and speed funding flows to green and environmentally friendly projects (Tudo et al., 2021; Mrkajic et al., 2019; Muo & Azeez, 2019; Orduña-Malea & Delgado-López-Cózar, 2018). East African businesses and society now have better access to global capital markets due to Finance 4.0. (Vida et al., 2020).

1.1

Concept of Green Entrepreneurship

The promotion of environments that are favourable for biodiversity has grown, and thanks to creative intelligence, a new field of research known as “green field” has emerged (Pham et al., 2019; Saari & Joensuu-Salo, 2019; Sen & Theres von Schickfus, 2020; Shunsuke et al., 2022). Demuth (2014), for example, defines green creative entrepreneurialism as an entrepreneur’s capacity to win over stakeholders to his/her innovations, seize power over the value chains, and profit from his/her ability to address environmental issues. Demuth (2014) contends that the degree of success obtained through inventive efforts is determined by the entrepreneurs’ capacity to draw investors for their original ideas. Dale (2018) defined entrepreneurship as a storytelling process whereby entrepreneurs garner stakeholder support to accomplish their goals. According to the literature, experts are yet to be to reach an agreement on a definition for green entrepreneurship because it is still in its infancy (Mrkajic et al., 2019; Muo & Azeez, 2019; Orduña-Malea & Delgado-López-Cózar, 2018; Pham et al., 2019; Saari & Joensuu-Salo, 2019; Sen & Theres von Schickfus, 2020; Shunsuke et al., 2022; Stahlschmidt & Stephen, 2020; Tee et al., 2017). According to Buck Consultants (2011), 60% of firms currently measure efficiency by focusing on green programmes, with 78% achieving efficiency in electricity, two-thirds indicating paper savings and heating/cooling, and 60% reducing water use expenses. As a result, a higher percentage of respondents than in the previous year’s survey—roughly 69%—said they are already experimenting with being green in their various endeavours (Vida et al., 2020; Zhaojun et al., 2017; Demirel et al., 2017). As evidence, Khan (2015) asserts that the only practical, sustainable approach enables company owners to start their operations and depend on “going green” for success and protracted survival.

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

151

The extent to which certain companies engage in “greenwashing” to utilize marketing ploys to entice unsuspecting people to their brand also serves to highlight the power of green practices in expanding consumer bases for specific brands (Kulkanjanapiban & Silwattananusarn, 2022; Long & Blok, 2021; Malavisi, 2018; Massoudi et al., 2017). Saari and Joensuu-Salo (2019) defined greenwashing as giving out false information regarding the company’s green activities. Zhaojun et al. (2017) have found that genuine green businesses are likely to have high levels of consumer loyalty despite the rising problem of greenwashing. Therefore, dishonest companies that pose as green or environmentally friendly to gain an unfair competitive advantage can only succeed in the short term. To put it another way, organizations that have recognized the value of becoming green are now better positioned to take advantage of sustainable market prospects than those that are faking it but are not by trying to include greening within their operating procedures (Junior et al., 2016; Khan, 2015; Kulkanjanapiban & Silwattananusarn, 2022; Long & Blok, 2021; Malavisi, 2018; Massoudi et al., 2017; Matthews et al., 2017). However, young green business people’s difficulty in this aspect cannot be understated (Long & Blok, 2021; Malavisi, 2018). If green entrepreneurship is to be broadly accepted, these hurdles including the absence of sufficient government assistance and the challenge of evaluating funding and markets, among others—must be overcome (Kulkanjanapiban & Silwattananusarn, 2022; Long & Blok, 2021; Malavisi, 2018; Massoudi et al., 2017). Green entrepreneurs overcame these obstacles because they were determined to run compassionate and ecologically conscious businesses (Adekoya et al., 2021; Arezki, 2021; Bannamar & Gressel, 2015; Barbieri et al., 2016). Thus, their sincerity of intent led to a positive reputation as environmentally friendly businesses with goods and services that clients would be happy to use (Consoli et al., 2016; Dale, 2015, 2018). It should be in our best interests to band together in favour of the recently established green businesses that promote sustainability in all its forms (Consoli et al., 2016). Alternatively, it is in everyone’s best interest to ensure that new, green-born businesses thrive and achieve their goals (Mrkajic et al., 2019; Muo & Azeez, 2019; Orduña-Malea & Delgado-López-Cózar, 2018; Pham et al., 2019). Transitioning to reduced carbon and more sustainable economies needs a capital boost from corporate and governmental sectors (Long & Blok, 2021). Green entrepreneurship is defined as entrepreneurship that aims to provide environmental advantages in the context of attaining ecological sustainability while yielding good returns (Long & Blok, 2021). Climate entrepreneurship, environmental entrepreneurship, sustainable entrepreneurship, and carbon entrepreneurship are all phrases that are used interchangeably with green entrepreneurship (Giuliana & Chiappini, 2021; Harzing, 2019; He & Liu, 2018; Hörisch et al., 2017; Jones & Gettinger, 2016; Arezki, 2021). Ever since the 2015 Paris Climate Agreement, green entrepreneurship has become a vital facilitator in combating dangers caused by environmental harm and climate change. According to Pham et al. (2019), the global effort of the Paris Agreement has raised the risk of return for stocks in polluting businesses. Green entrepreneurship provides a solid foundation for long-term growth and sustainable

152

S. Matindike et al.

development (Frydrych, 2021). In the Intended Nationally Determined Contributions (INDCs), more than 200 nations have declared their desire to cooperate to minimize climate change’s effects (Arezki, 2021). Numerous scholarly articles explore the reaction of European and global firms and markets to the Paris Agreement (Sen & Theres von Schickfus, 2020).

1.2

Sustainability and International Businesses

Businesses can be domestic (national) or international. Domestic business refers to commercial transactions within a nation’s borders. It is a company whose business operations are carried out within a country. Both the company’s producer and its clients are citizens of the nation. Because the buyer and seller in a domestic transaction are from the same nation, the trade deal is rooted in national laws, traditions, and practices. A domestic firm benefits from various advantages, such as cheap transaction costs, a quick turnaround from production to sale, affordable transportation, and support for small businesses. An international business entails a company where production and trading occur outside the country of origin (Matthews et al., 2017; Meyskens & Carsrud, 2013; Mohammed, 2018; Mrkajic et al., 2019). All economic endeavours involving cross-border trade fall under the category of international or external business. It covers all business transactions between two or more nations, such as sales, investments, and logistics. A multinational or international corporation conducts business internationally (Pham et al., 2019). These businesses benefit from a sizable international consumer base; therefore, their resource needs are open to more than just one nation. Additionally, international business increases investment and commerce between nations. As a result, a firm is considered domestic if its economic transactions are carried out within the nation’s borders. A firm involved in economic transactions with more than one country is said to be doing international business (Pham et al., 2019; Saari & Joensuu-Salo, 2019). The outcomes of corporate operations (both national and international) help to raise communal well-being (Matthews et al., 2017; Meyskens & Carsrud, 2013; Mohammed, 2018; Mrkajic et al., 2019). However, the effects of these commercial operations may undermine social and environmental development. Natural calamities like landslides, floods, droughts, or wildfires result from unchecked resource extraction; thus, it is important to strike a balance between economic focus and conservation of the environment. In order to ensure sustainability, the existing economic framework requires a mechanism to regulate the effects of corporate activities (Hörisch et al., 2017; Jones & Gettinger, 2016; Arezki, 2021). The global community needs a unifying programme that addresses the welfare of future and current generations to enhance well-being and social equality. In order to fulfil social welfare and maintain the quality of natural resources, corporate activities must align with sustainability ideals (Harzing, 2019; He & Liu, 2018; Hörisch et al., 2017; Jones & Gettinger, 2016).

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

153

Entrepreneurs must regard social programmes, environmental protection, and cultural and social developments to align with sustainability issues. The general population must readily understand this, particularly in the business sector. The education system must play a crucial role in transforming learning and knowledge paradigms to support sustainable development in order to safeguard environmental protection for upcoming generations (Harzing, 2019; He & Liu, 2018; Hörisch et al., 2017; Jones & Gettinger, 2016; Arezki, 2021). The businesses should make sure that the surroundings are secure and sanitary. They may do this by encouraging natural resource use and sustainable economic practices. This chapter will examine two opposing viewpoints on whether a firm has a moral obligation to protect the environment (Matthews et al., 2017; Meyskens & Carsrud, 2013; Mrkajic et al., 2019). According to the first viewpoint, the business should willingly allocate part of its financial means to the battle against climate change. In the second case, MNCs and other parties are supposed to accept a legally obligatory policy. The companies’ monetary commitments to assist initiatives aimed at reducing climate change will be specified in the policy. (a) Voluntary action Managers from several multinational companies concur that quick responses are required to the problems caused by environmental changes (Harzing, 2019; He & Liu, 2018; Hörisch et al., 2017; Jones & Gettinger, 2016; Arezki, 2021). The businesses have understood that successful climate change management would benefit them. MNCs can make voluntary commitments towards the effort to counter the threat in light of these evident measures. Multinational enterprises have signalled their desire to contribute to the effort to combat this issue. The corporations’ intention to follow the many rules that have been established and their reaction to customer proposals regarding climate change show their goodwill. (b) Legal requirement A reputable company, like an MNC, would be willing to assist with the fight against climatic changes in such situations (Hörisch et al., 2017; Jones & Gettinger, 2016). Nevertheless, in the absence of compelling laws that would impose trade-offs, the company will not have the ability to keep its moral obligation (Harzing, 2019; Arezki, 2021). The issue informs the moral requirement to contribute financially to the battle against climate change of harm to other people. Producers, users, non-clients, and coming generations are all impacted by environmental destruction (Harzing, 2019; Hörisch et al., 2017; He & Liu, 2018; Arezki, 2021; Jones & Gettinger, 2016). A business should not remain at peace while committing such social harm (Matthews et al., 2017; Meyskens & Carsrud, 2013; Mohammed, 2018; Mrkajic et al., 2019). Hence, reducing and ultimately avoiding this kind of injury is morally needed. The best action in this situation is for a corporation to respond to environmental challenges independently. The knowledge of green entrepreneurial strategies by international enterprises still needs to improve, even though the significance of climate change in

154

S. Matindike et al.

developing activities is apparent. As a result, the current analysis attempts to draw attention to the following main question: (1) What are the bibliometric characteristics of the research corpus on green entrepreneurship as environmental commitment and eco-innovation among international businesses? (2) Which themes/key concepts dominate the current body of knowledge on green entrepreneurship practices by international businesses? (3) What are the major green activities done as environmental commitment and eco-innovation practices among International Businesses?

1.3

Chapter Objectives

The chapter’s main objective is to review the concept of green entrepreneurship adopted by international businesses in pursuit of environmental commitment and eco-innovation within the corpus of literature. The specific objectives are (1) To reveal the bibliometric characteristics of the research corpus on green entrepreneurship as environmental commitment and eco-innovation among international businesses. (2) To extract the major themes/key concepts explored and how they are related. (3) To expose the major green activities done as environmental commitment and eco-innovation practices among International Businesses.

1.4

Study Justification and Significance

It is critical to conduct bibliometric analysis because it synthesizes studies in an area of interest, assesses the level of agreement or lack thereof within the body of knowledge, displays trends and identifies gaps, and recommends research directions (Chen & Song, 2019). The bibliometric analysis provides a comprehensive overview of the knowledge landscape on selected topics to budding scholars (Chen & Song, 2019). The current study supports veteran researchers by supplying an up-to-date standing of the literary works and highlighting gaps that can lead to future research areas on topics of interest (Lang et al., 2021). This research provides decision-makers access to a synthesis of literature demonstrating the presence or absence of consensus.

2 Theoretical Review Some theories explaining why international businesses can adopt green entrepreneurship as environmental commitment and eco-innovation among international businesses are legitimacy theory, multi-stakeholder theory, and knowledge spillover theory (Acs et al., 2009; Demuth, 2014).

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

2.1

155

Legitimacy Theory

Legitimacy theory suggests business owners should know the structures and institutions relevant to their working environment (Demuth, 2014). In order to establish their legitimacy to offer any goods or services that the general public would accept, those businesspeople had to be capable of recognizing and comprehending these structures and systems. Hörisch et al. (2017) viewed institutions as embedded elements of societal structures with a propensity to specify or issue obligatory rules that businesses or business owners must abide by to succeed. Additionally, Khan (2015) contends that sustainable development cannot occur until there is a balance between economic expansion for accumulating riches and environmental protection. Legitimacy theory encourages businesspeople to use institutions to achieve the legitimacy they need to survive (Jones & Gettinger, 2016). Hence, legitimacy within the current context refers to how people see the essence of the interaction between a business and the rest of the institutions within its scope concerning social conventions and principles, which should be balanced. The explanation is that greening is a sustainability-focused strategy for business administration that has emerged to make up for past wrongs committed by the previous strategy for business operations (Giuliana & Chiappini, 2021; Harzing, 2019; He & Liu, 2018; Hörisch et al., 2017; Jones & Gettinger, 2016). So, it is wise for astute businesspeople to incorporate sustainability into their endeavours in the modern corporate environment. As a result, everybody should support green entrepreneurship.

2.2

Knowledge Spill-Over Theory

Business benefits and prospects frequently result from knowledge stored internally. The knowledge is accumulated over time, covering the period from the creation of the business enterprise up to the current period (Demuth, 2014). This knowledge acquired over time can benefit future entrepreneurship initiatives through knowledge spill-over (Acs et al., 2009). Within the context of knowledge spill-over, new business startups may be influenced to follow green entrepreneurship by past experiences of other businesses which have realized the importance and enjoyed the benefits of green entrepreneurship.

2.3

Multi-stakeholder Theory

The impact of enterprises on stakeholders varies according to their interactions with the business. While there are benefits, such as the supply of goods and services that address specific societal requirements, the creation of jobs, and the advancement of

156

S. Matindike et al.

improvements in the quality of life for individuals, there are also drawbacks, such as the constant monopolization of space, corporate greediness, ecological degradation, and many others. Moreover, Mohammed (2018) notes that firms have more negative externalities than favourable ones on stakeholders. As a result, we use the fact that there are numerous environmental stakeholders to support our justification for innovation and green entrepreneurship over traditional ways of doing business.

3 Research Method 3.1

Theoretical Basis

The research was guided by the theoretical framework Qiang et al. (2022) postulated. The framework identifies two aspects: the research front, which constitutes what is cited by the research front, and the intellectual base, which consists of everything cited by the research front. Presume that (t) symbolizes a group of terms and phrases associated with advancements over time t and that (t) includes groups of articles cited by articles from which the research front terms were derived. By adding the following expressions, relations can be established within the framework: Stitle is a collection of title words, IsHotTopic (term, t) is a Boolean function, and article0article indicates that article0 cites article. ΦðtÞ : ΨðtÞ → ΩðtÞ

ð1Þ

Furthermore, defined notations and the outlined elements can show relations that showcase the research’s theoretical base. ΨðtÞ term j term 2 Stitle [ Sabstract [ Sdescriptor [ Sidentifier ^ IsHotTopicðterm, t Þ ð2Þ ΩðtÞ = article jterm 2 ΨðtÞ ^ term 2 article0 ^ article0 → article

ð3Þ

The expression in (1) demonstrates a mapping of terms and phrases connected to new trends and advancements. (2) displays phrases and terms that resemble the intellectual foundation. Finally, the association in (3) exposes the intellectual foundation of article categories cited by other articles.

3.2

Research Strategy

The current analysis was carried out in phases. The first phase was to define and formulate research questions. The second phase entailed developing inclusion and exclusion criteria to guide the decision on whether or not to include a document. The

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

157

criteria used in the study were guided by the following factors: language, publication type, and title (Booth et al., 2016). The third phase involved conducting a literature search within the database of choice. The articles were chosen based on a preset vetting criterion in the fourth phase. Documents were transferred to visualization software for bibliometric analysis in the fifth stage. The sixth phase involves creating maps from text and bibliographic data. The phase entailed presenting research findings, drawing conclusions, and recommending future research.

3.3

Search Strategy

The search strategy entails selecting a relevant database and creating search strings.

3.3.1

Identification of a Database

The Web of Science (WoS) is the one that has been in existence for the longest period among the most well-known database. Clarivate Analytics operates and controls WoS. Elsevier’s Scopus database, founded in 2004, introduced competition to the bibliometric database arena. Scopus seeks a happy medium between quantity and quality, whereas WoS places a high value on quality over quantity (Stahlschmidt & Stephen, 2020). Digital Science, a subsidiary of Holtzbrinck Publishing Group, launched the Dimensions database, which is well known for its reputable publishing house, SpringerNature. Digital Science created the Dimensions database in response to two concerns: (1) existing databases focused on publications as the primary scientific output, and (2) a significant part of the research corpus was inaccessible to researchers (Adams et al., 2018). In terms of citation counts and coverage, Dimensions matches WoS and Scopus (Thelwall, 2018; Orduña-Malea & Delgado-López-Cózar, 2018; Harzing, 2019; Stahlschmidt & Stephen, 2020; Kulkanjanapiban & Silwattananusarn, 2022). According to the results of an exponential regression test conducted by Kulkanjanapiban and Silwattananusarn (2022), the Dimensions database grew at a rate of 15.32% per year, while Scopus grew at a rate of 14.85% per year. In a nutshell, the per year publication rate of growth for researchers on Scopus was revealed to be lesser than that on Dimensions. According to a study by Kulkanjanapiban and Silwattananusarn (2022), Dimensions enhances the number of citations mildly more than Scopus, and citation counts correlate positively between the two databases. Stahlschmidt and Stephen (2020) compared three databases, WoS, Scopus, and Dimension, based on a field of study coverage and German articles. Dimensions had the highest rate of exclusive articles, with 20% of its documents not being found in WoS or Scopus, compared to 6.3% for Scopus and 2.1% for WoS. Harzing (2019) compared Dimensions, WoS, and Scopus, finding that Scopus and WoS provided less coverage than Dimensions.

158

S. Matindike et al.

Using a sample of 20 journals, 28 authors, and 262 articles, Orduña-Malea and Delgado-López-Cózar (2018) compared Dimensions and Scopus coverage and citations in library and information science. According to the study, Dimensions surpassed Scopus in terms of coverage. As a result, the authors concluded that Dimensions is a viable substitute for Scopus. Still, another study, Thelwall (2018), evaluated by comparing Scopus and Dimensions in regard to their coverage, using a sample of 84,691 food science records from 2008 to 2018 and a random sample of 10,000 records from 2012, and the results suggest that these databases performed similarly for coverage and citation counts for food science papers published. As per Thelwall (2018), Orduña-Malea and Delgado-López-Cózar (2018), Harzing (2019), Stahlschmidt and Stephen (2020), Kulkanjanapiban and Silwattananusarn (2022), Dimensions is fairly similar to Scopus and may even be the superior database in terms of citation counts and coverage. As a result, data in this study is drawn from the Dimensions database.

3.3.2

Search Strings

The population was used to generate search strings. The population is the current knowledge base on green entrepreneurship as a strategy in pursuit of environmental commitment and eco-innovation within the corpus of literature. Keywords utilized comprised green entrepreneurship and climate change. Such keywords were linked with Boolean operators “AND” and “OR” to develop appropriate search phrases and terms, which were then utilized to extract useful publications from databases. Keywords Green entrepreneurship Climate change Environmental entrepreneurship

Boolean Operators AND OR

Search phrases/terms “green entrepreneurship AND climate change OR environmental entrepreneurship AND climate change” “green entrepreneurship AND climate change OR environmental entrepreneurship AND climate change”

The literature search was conducted on the 8th of January 2023 using the search string, “green entrepreneurship AND climate change OR environmental entrepreneurship AND climate change”, based on full data. The search yielded 23,272 results.

3.3.3

Exclusion and Inclusion Criteria

According to Patino and Ferreira (2018), identifying criteria for accepting and excluding data sources is useful in setting a benchmark for harmonizing studies with high-quality procedures. Furthermore, Connelly (2020) proposes that considering the chance of having comprehensive and massive datasets, the utilization of inclusion and exclusion criteria supports enabling restrictive elements that reduce the

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

159

sources accepted for analysis. As a result, the important characteristics that qualified or excluded the data sources are highlighted in the Table below: Inclusion criteria Bibliometric analysis Only publications released from 2018 to 2023 were considered for inclusion. For the convenience of understanding, the study considered only articles written in English. This research covers material on green entrepreneurship The investigation relied on peer-reviewed published papers by credible publishers. Thematic analysis Articles with the following keywords in the Title, Abstract, or Full text: green entrepreneurship, climate change, international business climate change

3.4 3.4.1

Exclusion criteria Publications released prior to 2018 were considered for exclusion. Articles written in other languages were considered for exclusion from the study. Any material that focused on other topics was excluded. The investigation excluded material that was not peer-reviewed, like blogs and newspapers. Articles which do not have the following keywords in the Title, Abstract, or Full text: green entrepreneurship, climate change, international business climate change

Analysis Strategy Bibliometric Analysis and VOS Viewer

According to Qiang et al. (2022), the two most common visualization tools are VOSviewer and CiteSpace. A significant portion of the features of the two programs are shared. Regarding bibliometric cases and technical evaluation, Markscheffel and Schröter (2021) compared CiteSpace to VOSviewer, revealing VOSviewer’s exceptionalism by being more user-friendly and clearer. CiteSpace, on the other hand, had advantages in network visualizations, resulting in better cluster node analysis using Cluster Explorer. Articles from Dimensions were imported into VOSviewer for bibliometric analysis and visualization. The VOSviewer can generate publication maps, journal maps, country maps, and keywords. The bibliometric analysis was conducted on the 23,272 documents. 3.4.2

Thematic Analysis

Thematic analysis is a technique for examining qualitative data and involves going through the documents to identify, evaluate, and reveal recurring patterns (Nowell et al., 2017). The thematic analysis enables the investigator to view and draw a sense of common meaning among items in data. The main aim of thematic analysis is not just to pinpoint particular and peculiar meanings and ideas that can only be discovered inside a single piece of information (Nowell et al., 2017; Sandelowski, 2010).

160

S. Matindike et al.

The strategy is to determine the common idea or meaning shared among pieces of information. Commonality, however, does not always imply significance or importance in itself. The derived meaning should be relevant to the research question being addressed. Based on 25 documents selected using the exclusion and inclusion criteria, a thematic analysis was conducted to derive a common meaning of how green entrepreneurship among international businesses can contribute to Sustainable Development Goals, common green entrepreneurial practices to facilitate the formulation of policies and possible future research agenda.

4 Results and Discussion 4.1

Distribution of Articles by Output and by Academic Impact

(Output, Citations, Publications with citations, and Field Citation Ratio (FCR) This section presents results addressing the question of articles’ distribution by output and academic impact.

4.1.1

Output

Publications output on green entrepreneurship and its implications for climate change in Africa existing in Dimensions have increased over the years. The number of publications in Dimensions for 2018 was 3449, and a steady increase led to an output of 4440 in 2020 before reaching 6025 publications in 2022. Since 2015, research output on green finance has steadily grown. This trend indicates that scientific researchers have become increasingly interested in green entrepreneurship. This expansion reflects scholars’ heightened interest in learning about green entrepreneurship as a response to climate change. This growth can be ascribed to growing worldwide sustainability efforts. These findings are consistent with those of comparable research conducted by Akomea-Frimpong et al. (2022), which discovered an increasing trend in the scholarly scientific output of green entrepreneurship publications beginning in 2017.

4.1.2

Citations

The academic impact of literature on green entrepreneurship and its implications for climate change in Africa has also increased, especially in the years covered by the study from 2018 to 2023. In 2018, citations were three and increased to 82 in 2017. However, the increase from 2018 was tremendous, registering an improvement from 2157 to 10,895.

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

161

The increase in the academic impact of literature on green entrepreneurship and its implications for climate change in Africa shows the increasing interest in the field and its importance in the development discourse.

4.2

Top Journals that Have Published the 100 Most Cited Articles on Green Entrepreneurship and Its Implications for Climate Change in Africa

This section answers the question on the top journals that have published the 100 most cited articles on green entrepreneurship and its implications for climate change in Africa (source titles in Dimensions). Top ten journals that contribute the most to the body of knowledge. Table 1 shows that top journals are some of the major literature sources on the topic under study. Sustainability is the journal topping the list of major sources with an output of 1099 publications with 18,328 citations. Closely following Sustainability, the Tobacco Induced Diseases Journal is second with 957 publications. After these two journals, the other sources contribute publications which are at most 500.

4.3

The Intellectual Structure of Knowledge on Green Entrepreneurship and Its Implications for Climate Change in Africa (Co-authorship and Citation Network Analysis As Well As Countries and Institutions Dominating)

This section presents results based on the question of the intellectual structure of knowledge on green entrepreneurship and its implications for climate change in Table 1 Top ten sources of literature in dimensions Name Sustainability Tobacco Induced Diseases Journal of Cleaner Production Environmental Science and Pollution Research Technological Forecasting and Social Change Business Strategy and the Environment Journal of Business Research Frontiers in Psychology International Journal of Environmental Research Energy Research & Social science Source: Compiled by Researchers

Publications 1099 957 439 348 278 272 188 185 183 171

Citations 18,328 245 9056 4828 8303 5210 3180 478 1450 4128

Citations(mean) 16.68 0.26 20.63 13.87 29.87 19.15 16.91 2.58 7.92 24.14

162

S. Matindike et al.

Table 2 Top authors and organizations Name Colin Michael Hall Dirk L R De Clercq Geoffrey T Fong Simplice Anutechia Asongu Sascha Kraus Joao Jose De Matos Ferreira Benjamin Kenneth Sovacool Nancy M P Bocken Muhammad Irfan Abdullah-AlMamun

Organization and country University of Canterbury, New Zealand Brock University, Canada

Publications 43

Citations 3239

Citations mean 75.33

36

481

13.36

University of Waterloo, Canada African Governance and Development Institute, Cameroon

30 27

16 930

0.53 34.44

Free University of Bozen-Bolzano, Italy University of Beira Interior, Portugal

26

1201

46.19

26

499

19.19

University of Sussex, United Kingdom

26

2310

88.85

Maastricht University, Netherlands

22

1168

53.09

Beijing Institute of Technology, China National University of Malaysia, Malaysia

21

541

25.76

21

263

12.52

Source: Compiled by Researchers

Africa (co-authorship and citation network analysis); countries and institutions dominating.

4.3.1

Top Authors and Organizations

Colin Michael Hall from New Zealand tops the list of authors in the literature on green entrepreneurship and its implications for climate change with 43 publications. Dirk Clercq and Geoffrey T. Fong follow in the list with 36 and 30, respectively (Table 2).

4.3.2

Co-authorship

Releasing publications into peer-reviewed journals has traditionally been necessary for incentives and promotions for university researchers and some authors in research institutions. Engaging in scientific partnerships and co-authorship improves the number of studies in which an author participates and their publishing chances. This rise is shown in disciplines of study that prioritize collaborative research, such as public health. Not all collective actions result in published publications;

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

163

Fig. 1 Co-authorship

nonetheless, article co-authorship is a recognized indicator of scientific collaboration and the collective influence of organizational success (Fonseca et al., 2016) (Fig. 1). Researchers discovered that the degree of co-authorships might be significantly raised, but African researchers must be roped in since they are underrepresented. Furthermore, we identified certain significant writers inside the network that have the potential to enhance collaborative actions among members of the network. Our findings support the advice that the existing researchers topping in research collaboration be encouraged to increase their efforts in fostering teamwork among their networks and peers.

4.3.3

Citation Analysis

Citation analysis counts the instances in which a certain author, piece of writing, or magazine has been referenced in other works to determine the relative relevance or effect of each. The following encompasses the purposes of conducting citation analysis: (1) To determine the influence of a certain work by determining which other writers based their studies on it or mentioned it in their publications; (2) To better understand a discipline or issue by recognizing significant works in that field; (3) To measure the effect of a certain author inside his or her domain and beyond, examine the overall citation count disaggregated by field and nation. (4) Considering the calibre of the sources from which a scholar’s output was published and quoted is important for tenure purposes and promotions.

164

S. Matindike et al.

Fig. 2 Citations

Various citation analysis resources are available, some needing a membership, whereas others are open. Each instrument has advantages and disadvantages, but none encompasses the world of scholarly papers. As a result, it is critical to employ many tools in order to obtain a more complete view of the researcher’s or journal’s scholarly effect (Fig. 2).

4.4 4.4.1

Major Themes/Key Concepts that Have Been Explored and How Are They Related Themes According to Research Categories

This section provides findings on the themes/key concepts explored and their relation. The dominant themes in the research corpus on green entrepreneurship and its implications on climate change include commerce, management and tourism; human society; engineering; economics; environmental sciences, and built environment and design. On the other hand, creative arts and writing, mathematical sciences, law and legal studies, education, and agricultural, veterinary and food sciences are themes that are underrepresented in the research corpus on green entrepreneurship and its implications on climate change.

4.4.2

Themes According to SDGs

Themes within the research corpus on green entrepreneurship and its implications on climate change can be depicted along the SDGs lines.

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

165

The dominant themes in the research corpus on the topic under study are aligned to the following SDGs: affordable and clean energy, climate action, responsible consumption and production, sustainable cities and communities, good health and well-being, industry, innovation and infrastructure. However, themes that are underresearched are aligned with the following SDGs: peace, justice and strong institutions, reduced inequalities, gender equality, no poverty, life below water, clean water and sanitation, as well as partnerships for the goals (Giuliana & Chiappini, 2021; Harzing, 2019; He & Liu, 2018; Hörisch et al., 2017; Jones & Gettinger, 2016).

4.4.3

Green Entrepreneurship and SDGs

Green business owners will play a significant role in the business ecosystem by deploying more environmentally friendly production techniques and promoting green consumers’ sustainable purchase habits (Saari & Joensuu-Salo, 2019). The advancement of energy and resource efficiency and green infrastructure are crucial for sustainable production and consumption. With the support of green entrepreneurship, a rise in Gross Domestic Product will be achieved in a way that lowers social and environmental burdens and increases economic competitiveness based on sustainable standards, including social and environmental considerations alongside financial sustainability. As a result, the growth in green entrepreneurship would also contribute to creating more environmentally friendly and sustainable businesses and better working conditions for employees. Sustainable production and consumption aim to achieve more with less effort and better results. Using resources sparingly makes production processes and finished goods less degrading and polluting throughout their life cycles. Also, consumers need access to reliable information about the products and their manufacture that promotes sustainable consumption habits and lifestyle decisions (Saari & Joensuu-Salo, 2019). Businesses and the economic environment should adjust to the circumstances to prevent consumption and production from causing long-term environmental damage due to the expanding global population and higher demand for goods manufactured from limited natural resources. By using a green entrepreneurial approach, businesses can support discoveries and product designs that encourage and support end users’ goals to live more sustainably and so lessen the environmental effect of their consumption (Giuliana & Chiappini, 2021; Harzing, 2019; He & Liu, 2018; Hörisch et al., 2017; Jones & Gettinger, 2016). Green business owners are more driven to create sustainable alternatives than traditional business owners. Green business owners are motivated by a sustainable mentality to examine the effects of their operations and develop better solutions that consider the societal and environmental effects of their goods and services throughout their life cycles. They are prepared to address the problems with the biggest negative effects and where there is the greatest opportunity to enhance the entire life span of their goods and services.

166

4.5

4.5.1

S. Matindike et al.

Common Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation Practices Among International Businesses Creative Green Entrepreneurial Practices Among International Businesses

Similarly to this, Zhaojun et al. (2017) suggest that green entrepreneurs have a proclivity to evaluate a wide range of options because of their adaptability and flexibility, both of which are products of creativity, commonly resulting in improved ideas to societal challenges. Similarly, according to Yousuf et al. (2017), green entrepreneurs are creative thinkers who can protect the social environment from environmental threats. Entrepreneurs gain from opportunities in the green market for sustainability due to their flexibility to start at any level. Malavisi (2018) claims that green business entrepreneurs use their unique and creative skills to implement modern green business methods. In the interest of reducing global environmental concerns, Dale (2019) makes a case for green innovation, which he defines from a green entrepreneurship perspective as a revolutionary solution to the current environmental and socioeconomic hurdles. Hence, creative entrepreneurship is simply the planned application of skills and other means (both technical and human) in order to address socioeconomic concerns through morally upstanding products and services that provide owners with a sense of purpose and financial rewards.

4.5.2

Greenwashing and Green International Businesses

Some deceptive companies manipulate unsuspecting clients into believing that they are concerned about environmental difficulties in their business operations by using hyperbolic phrases like “eco”, “bio”, and “organic”, as well as “green” sustainability. Businesses have been recognized to deliberately engage in “greenwashing”, which is the practice of misleading customers through marketing initiatives (Junior et al., 2016; Consoli et al., 2016). As a result, the extensive utilization of deceptive green messaging to gain market acceptability demonstrates that companies now know that their clients care about diversity and the ecosystem. Despite these marketing gimmicks, customers normally discover trustworthy eco-friendly firms they decide to support long-term. Consumers are now more fully conscious than ever of the negative effects of entrepreneurship on someone’s socio-environmental wellness, according to Dale (2019); therefore, they are starting to think about each company’s and company’s pro-environmental behaviours before making real purchasing decisions. Suppose businesses at all levels have differing views on a strategy to be committed to going green. In that case, the common wish for an egalitarian and reasonable society may continue to exist just as

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

167

a wish (Bannamar & Gressel, 2015). Therefore, companies that wanted to retain their customers had to do more than develop and market environmentally friendly products and services; they also had to convince customers that they truly believe in going green and support green initiatives vehemently in their quest for sustainability practices. However, once the business has established a green status, which tends to compensate for any initial cost invested generously, this price would be justified in the long run. For instance, according to Tee et al. (2017), a business should not see environmental campaigning as an added burden before using greenwashing. According to their analysis, the authors assert that there are undeniably much bigger long-term benefits to having a green image, so the short-term costs of adopting ecologically conscious behaviour must be higher. In particular, with respect, “greenwashing” might be regarded as “economic fraud” because every company that partakes in it would theoretically ignore its environmental commitments due to the false belief that it is not necessary to pay for being environmentally friendly or responsible (Giuliana & Chiappini, 2021; Harzing, 2019; He & Liu, 2018; Hörisch et al., 2017; Jones & Gettinger, 2016). Green public image is one of the effective marketing methods of the contemporary day. As a result, more items are being packaged to give the impression that they are truly ecologically benign or at least superior to those of their competitors, whose own products are known to be destructive to the environment. The public will eventually recognize and support the actual pro-environmental enterprises, although some purportedly green businesses involved in greenwashing oversold their environmental advantages through publicity stunts, according to Junior et al. (2016). As a result, after the public learns the truth about the numbers and eco-friendly business products gain popularity, the former may eventually leave the market. Green washers would do well to learn from the proverb, “He who lives with a sword shall end up perishing with a sword”, as they will eventually come to regret their hypocrisy (Demuth, 2014; Frydrych, 2021). Greenwashing is an immoral marketing technique that will eventually come to light to expose many who engage in it. Moreover, there is less commitment to ecologically beneficial behaviours the more money is spent on bogus green product promotion (Mrkajic et al., 2019; Yousuf et al., 2017). Nevertheless, organizations may progressively migrate away from business as usual if they continuously make promises about sustainability in their products, services, or brand awareness to attract customers. This unfulfilled promise is because greenwashing serves as a strategy to raise society’s awareness of environmental problems.

5 Recommendation 5.1

Business Sector

For international businesses to acquire legitimacy according to the legitimacy theory, to consider the needs of the wider community as a stakeholder within the business

168

S. Matindike et al.

environment as per the multi-stakeholder theory as well as to exploit knowledge spill-over effects from seasoned international businesses, there is an increased need to promote good end user lifestyles, safety, and health aspirations (Saari & JoensuuSalo, 2019). There is a dire need for international businesses to pursue eco-services like ecotourism. These services ensure that the natural environment is preserved and species that are in danger are protected. The active involvement of local communities is achieving the provision of services that balance economic aspirations, environmental concerns, and societal values and norms. Due to increased demand, green products like electric cars and natural foods are now attracting higher prices. By focusing on products that are believed to be friendly to the environment and the people, an international business can secure customer loyalty, resulting in sustainable business operations (Saari & Joensuu-Salo, 2019).

5.2

Government

Countries should evaluate whether voluntary action or legal requirements can more effectively take international businesses on board regarding environmental sustainability. Indeed, some businesses have come to understand that successful climate change management would be advantageous to them and can voluntarily commit to counter the threat in light of these evident measures. However, in such circumstances, a good-willed business, such as an MNC, would be prepared to contribute to aiding in the fight against climate change. However, the firm cannot uphold its moral commitment because it lacks compelling legislation to make trade-offs. Enhancing the policy frameworks to encourage international businesses becomes crucial in such cases.

5.3

Academics

In light of the findings of this study, universities and research funders must promote African researchers in green entrepreneurship and its implications on climate change. This increased participation will improve African authors’ output and academic impact in green entrepreneurship. Our findings support the advice that the existing researchers topping in research collaboration be encouraged to increase their efforts in fostering teamwork among their networks and peers, especially African counterparts. The future research agenda should focus on the following themes and their role within green entrepreneurship and climate change: creative arts and writing, mathematical sciences, law and legal studies, education, and agricultural, veterinary and food sciences. In addition, themes that include peace, justice and strong institutions, reduced inequalities, gender equality, no poverty, life below water, clean water and

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

169

sanitation, as well as partnerships for the SDGs goals are potential areas of research that, if explored, the body of knowledge can be enhanced and gaps covered.

6 Conclusion The chapter’s main goal was to explore the research corpus on green entrepreneurship as environmental commitment and eco-innovation by international businesses. The chapter attempted to reveal the bibliometric characteristics of the research corpus on green entrepreneurship as environmental commitment and eco-innovation among international businesses, to extract the major themes/key concepts that have been explored and how they are related and to expose the major green activities done as environmental commitment and eco-innovation practices among international Businesses. The chapter identified legitimacy theory, multi-stakeholder theory, and knowledge spill-over theory as explanations of why international businesses may pursue green entrepreneurship. In order to address the research questions, bibliometric analysis and thematic analysis were adopted. Firstly, bibliometric analysis was conducted, using VOSviewer, on the 23,272 documents searched in the Dimensions database. Secondly, a thematic analysis was conducted based on 25 documents selected using the exclusion and inclusion criteria. The thematic analysis aimed to derive a common meaning of how green entrepreneurship among international businesses can contribute to Sustainable Development Goals and common green entrepreneurial practices to facilitate policy formulation and possible future research agenda. Bibliometric analysis revealed that throughout time, particularly over the study’s period of 2018 to 2023, the academic influence of publications on green entrepreneurship has increased. Researchers found that the number of co-authorships might be greatly increased, but they must be included because African scholars are underrepresented. The main themes explored in the research corpus on green entrepreneurship as environmental commitment and eco-innovation by international businesses within the corpus of literature include commerce, management and tourism; human society; engineering; economics; environmental sciences and built environment and design. On the other hand, creative arts and writing, mathematical sciences, law and legal studies, education, and agricultural, veterinary and food sciences are themes that are underrepresented in the research corpus on green entrepreneurship and its implications on climate change. The dominant themes in the research corpus on the topic under study are aligned to the following SDGs: affordable and clean energy, climate action, responsible consumption and production, sustainable cities and communities, good health and well-being, industry, innovation and infrastructure. However, themes that are under-researched are aligned with the following SDGs: peace, justice and strong institutions, reduced inequalities, gender equality, no poverty, life below water, clean water and sanitation, as well as partnerships for the goals. Additionally, developing countries,

170

S. Matindike et al.

especially in Africa, are underrepresented in publications output over the years within the corpus of research on the topic under study. Additionally, they were identified through thematic analysis as common practices among international businesses. Creative green business involves using strategies based on innovative and creative abilities. Thus, international businesses are using innovative entrepreneurship, which is just the coordinated use of talents and other resources (both human and technical) to address socioeconomic issues through ethical goods and services that give owners a feeling of fulfilment and financial benefits. On the other hand, some dishonest businesses utilize hyperbolic terms like “bio”, “eco”, “organic”, and “green” sustainability to mislead gullible customers into thinking that these businesses are mindful of the environmental issues in their company operations. This dishonest behaviour is termed greenwashing. In order to avoid the negative effects of greenwashing, international businesses are encouraged to pursue eco-services like ecotourism. In addition, international businesses should focus on green products like electric cars and natural foods, which are now attracting higher prices due to increased demand. Governments also have a role to play in promoting green entrepreneurship. Governments should evaluate whether voluntary action or legal requirements can more effectively take international businesses on board regarding environmental sustainability. It is important to pursue a policy that is suited to the country’s context. Consequently, the future research agenda should focus on the themes and their role in green entrepreneurship and climate change: creative arts and writing, mathematical sciences, law and legal studies, education, and agricultural, veterinary and food sciences. In addition, themes that include peace, justice and strong institutions, reduced inequalities, gender equality, no poverty, life below water, clean water and sanitation, as well as partnerships for the SDGs, are potential areas of research that, if explored, the body of knowledge can be enhanced and gaps covered.

References Acs, Z. J., Audretsch, D. B., Braunerhjelm, P., & Carlsson, B. (2009). The knowledge spill-over theory of entrepreneurship. Journal of Small Business Economics, 32(1), 15–30. Adams, J., Jones, P., Porter, S., Szomszor, M., Draux, H. and Osipov, I. (2018). Dimensions – A collaborative approach to enhancing research discovery. Digital Science. Available at: https:// figshare.com/articles/Dimensions_A_Collaborative_Approach_to_Enhancing_Research_Dis covery/5783160. Adekoya, O., Oliyide, J., Asl, M. G. & Jalalifar, S. (2021), Financing the green projects: Market efficiency and volatility persistence of green versus conventional bonds, and the comparative effects of health and financial crises. International Review of Financial Analysis, 78, issue C, https://EconPapers.repec.org/RePEc:eee:finana:v:78:y:2021:i:c:s105752192100274x. Arezki, R. (2021). Climate finance for Africa requires overcoming bottlenecks in domestic capacity. Nature Climate Change, 11(11), 888–888. Bannamar, K., & Gressel, N. (2015). Forget sustainability: Go for green entrepreneurship. Journal of Thinkers Creative Leadership, 1, 17. Available at: https://www.think.org/insights/go-forgreen-entrepreneurship/

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

171

Barbieri, N., Ghisetti, C., Gilli, M., Marin, G., & Nicolli, F. (2016). A survey of the literature on environmental innovation based on main path analysis. Journal of Economic Surveys, 30(3), 596–623. Chen, C. M., & Song, M. (2019). Visualizing a field of research: A methodology of systematic scientometric reviews. PLoS One, 14. Consoli, D., Marin, G., Marzucchi, A., & Vona, F. (2016). Do green jobs differ from non-green jobs in terms of skills and human capital? Journal of Research Policy, 45(5), 1046–1060. Dale, G. (2015). Origin and delusion of green growth. International Socialist Review, 2(97), 1–5. Available at: www.isreview.org/https://isreview.org/issue/97/origins-and-delusions-greengrowth Dale, G. (2018). The emergence of an ecological Karl Marx: 1818 – 2018. The legacy of the political economist is fiercely contested. Journal of Entrepreneurial Knowledge, 7(2). Dale, G. (2019). Climate, communism and the age of affluence? A review of Aaron Bastani in automated luxury communism: A manifesto, 1–6. Available at www.isreview.org/https:// theecologist.org/ Demirel, P., Cher Li, Q., Rentocchini, F., & Tamvada, J. P. (2017). Born to be green: new insights into the economics and management of green entrepreneurship. Journal of Business Economics, 52(1), 759–771. Demuth, A. (2014). Green entrepreneurship: A promising path towards a sustainable future in Tunisia and elsewhere. Internationale Zusammenarbeit (GIZ) GmbH, 4–51. Fonseca, B. P. F., Sampaio, R. B., Fonseca, M. V. A., & Zicker, F. (2016). Co-authorship network analysis in health research: Method and potential use. Health Res Policy Syst, 14(1). Frydrych, S. (2021). Green bonds as an instrument for financing in Europe. Ekonomia I PrawoEconomics and Law, 20, 239–255. Giuliana, B., & Chiappini, H. (2021). Climate change policies: Good news or bad news for firms in the European Union? Corporate Social Responsibility and Environmental Management, 28, 831–848. Harzing, A. W. (2019). Two new kids on the block: How do crossref and dimensions compare with Google Scholar, Microsoft Academic, Scopus and the Web of Science? Scientometrics, 120(1), 341–349. He, X., & Liu, Y. (2018). The public environmental awareness and the air pollution effect in Chinese stock market. Journal of Cleaner Production, 185, 446–454. Hörisch, J., Kollat, J., & Brieger, S. A. (2017). What influences environmental entrepreneurship? A multilevel analysis of the determinants of entrepreneurs’ environmental orientation. Small Business Economics, 48(1), 47–69. Jones, G., & Gettinger, B. (2016). Alternative paths of green entrepreneurship: The environmental legacies of the North Face’s Doug Tompkins and Patagonia’s Yvon Chouinard. Harvard Business School Working Paper, 10(1), 17–34. Junior, F. H., Galleli, B., Gallardo-Vȧzquez, D., & Sȧnchez-Hernȧndez, M. I. (2016). Strategic aspects in sustainability reporting in oil & gas industry: The comparative case-study of Brazilian Petrobras and Spanish Repsol. Ecological Indicators, 72(1), 203–214. Khan, M. (2015). Green human resource management – A prerequisite for sustainable environment. Progress in Science and Engineering Research Journal, 18(3), 1–7. Kulkanjanapiban, P., & Silwattananusarn, T. (2022). Comparative analysis of Dimensions and Scopus bibliographic data sources: An approach to university research productivity. International Journal of Electrical and Computer Engineering (IJECE), 12(1), 706–720. Lang, Z. H., Liu, H., Meng, N., Wang, H. N., Wang, H., & Kong, F. Y. (2021). Mapping the knowledge domains of research on fire safety—An informetrics analysis. Tunnelling and Underground Space Technology, 108, 103676. Long, T. B., & Blok, V. (2021). Niche level investment challenges for European Green Deal financing in Europe: Lessons from and for the agri-food climate transition. Humanities and Social Sciences Communications, 8, 269.

172

S. Matindike et al.

Malavisi, A. (2018). The urgency of the greening of ethics. Australasian Journal of Logic, 4(3), 593–609. Markscheffel, B., & Schröter, F. (2021). Comparison of two science mapping tools based on software technical evaluation and bibliometric case studies. COLLNET Journal of Scientometrics and Information Management, 15(2), 365–396. Massoudi, M. S., Marcelin, R. A., Young, B. R., et al. (2017). Prevention research centers: Perspective for the future. American Journal of Preventive Medicine, 52(3), S218–S223. Matthews, T. K. R., Wilby, R. L., & Murphy, C. (2017). Communicating the deadly consequences of global warming for human heat stress. Proceedings of the National Academy of Sciences USA, 114, 3861–3866. Meyskens, M., & Carsrud, A. L. (2013). Nascent green- technology ventures: A study assessing the role of partnership diversity in firm success. Journal of Small Business Economics, 40(3), 739–759. Mohammed, A. Y. (2018). International trade and its impact on CO2 emission: Empirical study of Bahrain. International Journal of Academic Research in Business and Social Sciences, 8(2), 318–333. Mrkajic, B., Murtinu, S., & Scalera, V. G. (2019). Is green the new gold? Venture capital and green entrepreneurship. Small Business Economics, 52(4), 929–950. Muo, I., & Azeez, A. (2019). Green entrepreneurship: Literature review and agenda for future research. International Journal of Entrepreneurial Knowledge, 7(2), 17–29. Nowell, L. S., Norris, J. M., White, D. E., & Moules, N. J. (2017). Thematic analysis: Striving to meet the trustworthiness criteria. International Journal of Qualitative Methods, 16(1). Orduña-Malea, E., & Delgado-López-Cózar, E. (2018). Dimensions: Re-discovering the ecosystem of scientific information. El Profesional de la Información, 27(2), 420–431. Pham, H., Nguyen, V., Ramiah, V., Saleem, K., & Moosa, N. (2019). The effects of the Paris climate agreement on stock markets: Evidence from the German stock market. Applied Economics, 51, 6068–6075. Qiang, Y., Tao, X., Gou, X., Lang, Z., & Liu, H. (2022). Towards a bibliometric mapping of network public opinion studies. Information, 13(1), 17. Saari, U. A., & Joensuu-Salo, S. (2019). Green entrepreneurship. In W. Leal Filho, A. Azul, L. Brandli, P. Özuyar, & T. Wall (Eds.), Responsible consumption and production. Encyclopedia of the UN sustainable development goals. Springer. https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-31971062-4_6-1 Sandelowski, M. (2010). What’s in a name? Qualitative description revisited. Research in Nursing and Health, 33(1), 77–84. Sen, S., & Theres von Schickfus, M. (2020). Climate policy, stranded assets, and investors’ Expectations. Journal of Environmental Economics and Management, 100. Shunsuke, M., Broadstock, D., & Wurgler, J. (2022). Green and climate finance: Challenges and opportunities. International Review of Financial Analysis, 79, 101962. Stahlschmidt, S., & Stephen, D. (2020). Comparison of Web of Science, Scopus and Dimensions databases. German Centre for Higher Education Research and Science Studies (DZHW) GmbH. Tee, M., Abdulahi, R., Din, J., Abdulahi, S., & Wu, L. (2017). Green SD Adoption using knowledge management facilitation – Motivational perspective. Journal of Theoretical and Applied Information Technology, 5(17), 4291–4301. Thelwall, M. (2018). Dimensions: A competitor to Scopus and the Web of Science? Journal of Informetrics, 12(2), 430–435. Tudo, J. L., Aleixandre, L. C.-C., Aleixandre, J. L., & Aleixandre-Benavent, R. (2021). Trends in funding research and international collaboration on greenhouse gas emissions: A bibliometric approach. Environmental Science and Pollution Research, 28, 32330–32346.

Green Entrepreneurship as Environmental Commitment and Eco-innovation. . .

173

Vida, I., Spaller, E., & Vasa, L. (2020). Potential effects of Finance 4.0 on the employment in East Africa. Economy and Sociology, 2, 9–41. Yousuf, N. A., Awang, H., & Iranmaneseh, M. (2017). Determinants and outcome of environmental practices in Malaysian construction projects. Journal of Cleaner Production, 156(17), 345–354. Zhaojun, Y., Jun, S., Yali, Z., & Ying, W. (2017). Green, green, it’s green: A triad model of technology, culture, and innovation for corporate sustainability. Sustainability, 9, 1–23.

Shadreck Matindike is a Post-doctoral Fellow at Nelson Mandela University in the Department of Development Studies. He holds a BCom Honours Degree in Economics, BSc Special Honours degree in Monitoring and Evaluation, Post graduate Diploma in Tertiary Education, MCom Degree in Economics, and a PhD in Development Studies. He participated in Research Internship with UNDP and Indian Technical and Economic Cooperation Programme course, “Empowering Women for Development” conducted at NIRD & PR, Hyderabad, India. Shadreck’s research interests are in development finance, entrepreneurship (including rural entrepreneurship), cooperatives and cooperating behaviour, gender issues, devolution and public policy, and social science research methods. Stephen Mago is a Professor at Nelson Mandela University in the Department of Development Studies. He is an interdisciplinary researcher who holds a BSc Honours degree in Economics, a Masters in Business Administration (MBA), and a PhD in Development Studies. Stephen’s research interests are in development finance, entrepreneurship (including rural entrepreneurship), local economic development, development theory, research ethics, and social science research methods. He supervises postgraduate students up to the doctoral level. Stephen has linkages with various universities (national and international) as an external examiner or moderator. Florah Sewela Modiba is an academic coordinator, lecturer, and researcher in the Department of Development Studies. She holds a doctoral degree (DLitt et Phil) in Development Studies from UNISA. Before joining NMU, she spent 8 years in the corporate industry and academia working for companies such as SAP Research and UNISA. She is also an external examiner and moderator for other universities. Her research and innovation interests are in development policy; entrepreneurship (formal and informal businesses); ICTs in development; gender and development; and sustainable rural and township development. She is involved in research projects focusing on rural and township entrepreneurial financing. Amanda van den Berg obtained her PhD in Business Management from the Nelson Mandela University in 2016. She received her BA, BA Honours, and MA degrees from the University of Port Elizabeth in South Africa. She is currently employed and teaches within the Department of Development Studies at Nelson Mandela University. She is involved in the teaching, supervision, research, and academic delivery, including the co-ordination of the Masters and Doctoral programmes within the Department. She also offers her services to a number of South African universities as an external examiner/moderator.

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens of Sustainability Anushka Lydia Issac

Abstract While the world’s population continues to grow expeditiously, a rapid increase in the demand of raw materials and a simultaneous decrease in supplies is evident. Government collaboration with International Businesses, decentralized authorities, and civil society is crucial for transitioning the global economy to rely predominantly on reusable materials by 2050. If implemented right, the Circular Economy holds the potential to preserve the endangered environment, boost social equity, and foster sustainable economic progress. This chapter is a conceptual discussion that explores the extent of the Circular Economy’s contribution towards International Business and in turn the potential contribution of this mix towards the promotion of SDGs, to better comprehend the conditions promoting or impeding the SDGs’ fulfillment. The chapter also aims at identifying critical opportunities and challenges for International Business in adopting and implementing the Circular Economy and providing recommendations for better implementation. The chapter describes the essential foundations of the Circular Economy and aims at assessing its most significant influence in achieving the sustainable development goals laid out by the UN Charter. The chapter is useful to academics and researchers in the fields of international political economy, economics, and sociology, in addition to policymakers and experts in the field of sustainability.

1 Introduction 1.1

Defining the Circular Economy

Scientific literature and professional journals over time have coined more than 100 different definitions of Circular Economy and this diversity of definitions has made the measurement of circularity more complicated (Kirchherr et al., 2017). First made popular by Kate Raworth’s work on Doughnut Economics, the Circular A. L. Issac (✉) Associate Professor and Program Leader - Level 3 Pearson, Westford University College, Sharjah, United Arab Emirates © The Author(s), under exclusive license to Springer Nature Switzerland AG 2023 P. Arte et al. (eds.), Sustainable International Business, Contributions to Management Science, https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-031-43785-4_9

175

176

A. L. Issac

Economy model is established over a rather simple postulation: ensuring that resources stay in the loop for a longer period of time reduces greenhouse gas emissions and curtails dependency on fossil resources and waste production (Laura Puttkamer, 2022). Evidence in literature (Andersen, 2007; Ghisellini et al., 2016; Su et al., 2013) attributes the coining of the term and concept to (Pearce & Turner, 1989). The Circular Economic System includes practices like reducing, reusing, recycling, and recovering (Kristensen & Mosgaard, 2020) in contrast to the existing traditional economies. While the Circular Economy might sound like a novel approach, its roots stem from older schools of thought, such as Industrial Ecology (Graedel, 1994; Lifset & Graedel, 2002), Biomimicry (Janine M Benyus, 2002), Natural Capitalism (Lovins et al., 1999), Cradle-to-Cradle (McDonough & Braungart, 2010), Performance Economy (Stahel, 2010), and others. While the global population continues to grow, the demand for raw materials simply escalates, however the supply of crucial raw materials remains limited. A resource deficiency indicates an increased depending on each other at the countrylevel. The Circular Economy defined as a model of production and consumption involving the sharing, leasing, reusing, repairing, refurbishing, and recycling of existing materials and products offers a fresh perspective towards ensuring that the life cycle of products remain extended (European Parliament, 2022). The World Economic Forum defines Circular Economy as an industrial system that by the nature of its intention and design is restorative or regenerative. Circular Economy is said to replace the end-of-life concept with restoration, creating a shift towards the use of renewable energy, eliminating the use of toxic chemicals, which impair reuse and return to the biosphere, and aims for the elimination of waste through the superior design of materials, products, systems, and business models (Victoria Masterson, 2022). The Ellen MacArthur Foundation defines the aim of Circular Economy to be that of redefining growth, focusing on positive society-wide benefits. Circular Economy is believed to entail gradually decoupling economic activity from the consumption of finite resources and designing waste out of the system (Ellen MacArthur Foundation, 2022). The International Encyclopedia of Human Geography (Deutz, 2020) describes Circular Economy as an economic system designed with the intention to utilize the extracted resources to the maximum potential and generate as minimal waste as possible. According to the Circular Economy Action Plan published by the European Commission (2020), the circular economy is defined as an economic system that aims to keep resources in use for as long as possible and minimize waste. This involves moving away from the traditional linear “take-make-use-dispose” model of production and consumption, and instead designing products and systems to be regenerative and restorative. The applicability of the circular economy is broad and includes a range of sectors, such as manufacturing, construction, energy, food, and textiles. The circular economy framework emphasizes the importance of creating closed-loop systems where products and materials are reused, repaired, or recycled, rather than being disposed of as waste. This can involve strategies such

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens. . .

177

as designing products for disassembly, using recycled materials, or implementing innovative business models such as product-as-a-service.

1.2

Putting Circular Economy in Practice

Within a Circular Economy, products are designed to be reusable, such as an electrical device that is designed in a way that makes it easier to repair. It is also encouraged to use products and raw materials as much as possible, like the recycling of plastic into pellets for the production of new plastic products. For products that are not used often like drills and cars, the Circular Economy supports an intensive use by sharing them with others. This would in turn mean that fewer products are created, and hence fewer raw materials are required. The Circular Economy also demands a responsible treatment of the environment by preventing litter on streets or banning free plastic bags (Government of the Netherlands, 2022). Environmental challenges such as climate change, biodiversity loss, and pollution require urgent action. By exploring the Circular Economy in international businesses through the lens of Sustainability, one can identify ways to reduce waste, increase resource efficiency, and minimize negative environmental impacts. Sustainability is not only about environmental protection but also about social equity. The Circular Economy can contribute to social equity by creating jobs and economic opportunities, reducing inequality, and improving the quality of life for communities. Understanding Circular Economy through Sustainability can ensure that social equity is a central consideration in the transition to a more sustainable economy. The Circular Economy can also contribute to economic growth by creating new markets, reducing costs, and improving resource efficiency. By comprehending the Circular Economy through Sustainability, one can ensure that economic growth is achieved in a way that is environmentally and socially responsible. This, however, requires collaboration between different fields, including economics, engineering, and social sciences. This interdisciplinary approach can lead to more innovative solutions that address the complex challenges of sustainability. The Circular Economy offers a new way of thinking about the economy, one that is based on regenerating natural systems and using resources efficiently. However, for this model to be successful, it needs to be integrated into a broader framework of sustainability that considers social, economic, and environmental dimensions. By exploring the Circular Economy in the international business sphere through the lens of Sustainability, one can ensure that a long-term perspective and building a sustainable future for all is being considered.

1.3

Conceptual Framework

The Circular Economy and sustainability are two concepts that have gained increasing attention in recent years, as the world grapples with the challenges of resource

178

A. L. Issac

Linking Circular Economy to Sustainability Resource Depletion Environmental Degradation

Sustainability

Circular Economy

Social Equity Economic Growth

Fig. 1 Conceptual framework linking circular economy to sustainability

depletion, climate change, and environmental degradation. The Circular Economy is a model of economic development that is based on the principles of designing out waste, keeping materials and resources in use, and regenerating natural systems. Sustainability, on the other hand, is a broader concept that encompasses environmental, social, and economic dimensions, and seeks to ensure that present and future generations can meet their needs without compromising the ability of the planet to sustain life as indicated in Fig. 1. The need to link the Circular Economy with sustainability arises from several factors: The linear economy model, which is based on the “take-make-dispose” approach, is no longer viable in a world of finite resources. The Circular Economy offers a solution to the problem of resource depletion by promoting the efficient use of resources, reducing waste, and extending the life of products and materials. The current linear economy model is also a major contributor to environmental degradation, including air and water pollution, deforestation, and greenhouse gas emissions. The Circular Economy can help to reduce environmental impacts by promoting the use of renewable energy, reducing emissions, and minimizing waste and pollution. Sustainability is not only about environmental protection but also about social equity. The Circular Economy can contribute to social equity by creating jobs and economic opportunities, reducing inequality, and improving the quality of life for communities. The Circular Economy can also contribute to economic growth by creating new markets, reducing costs, and improving resource efficiency. By linking Circular Economy with sustainability, one can ensure that economic growth is achieved in a way that is environmentally and socially responsible. The need to link Circular Economy with sustainability is driven by the urgent need to address resource depletion, environmental degradation, social equity, and economic growth in a way that is sustainable over the long term. By promoting the efficient use of resources, reducing waste and pollution, and improving social equity, a more sustainable future for all is created. Resource depletion, environmental

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens. . .

179

degradation, social equity, and economic growth are negatively correlated to Circular Economy, while Sustainability mediates the relationship between these independent factors and Circular Economy. The conceptual framework suggests that the need to link Circular Economy with sustainability arises from the negative impact of the current linear economy model on resource depletion, environmental degradation, social equity, and economic growth. By linking the Circular Economy with sustainability, it is possible to achieve a more sustainable future that is socially and environmentally responsible while promoting economic growth.

2 The Inter-Link and Variance Between Circular Economy, Sustainability, and the SDGs 2.1

The 3 Pillars of Sustainability

Extensive literature has established three prime and interlinked pillars of Sustainability, namely—Economical, Social, and Environmental. Having first appeared as a three circles diagram (Barbier, 1987), the “3 pillars of sustainability” or also alternatively referred to as the “Triple Bottom Line,” some origins of the paradigm also date back to the Brundtland Report, Agenda 21, and the 2002 World Summit on Sustainable Development (Moldan et al., 2012). However, recently Elkington chose to “recall” the 3BL in order to rethink capitalism (Elkington, 2018) stemming from the fact that the paradigm had been reduced to a mere accounting tool, a means to balance trade-offs instead of changing the way the society and business functions, as opposed to the original hypothesis that presented the triple bottom line as a sustainability framework that assesses an organization’s social, environment, and economic impact (. . .) encouraging organizations to track and manage economic value that is not limited to financial aspects alone, social, and environmental value added or destroyed (Kraaijenbrink, 2019).

2.1.1

Social Sustainability

This aspect encompasses various social elements of society including but not limited to environmental justice, human health, resource security, and education, urban regeneration, community development, cultural diversity, workforce development, social justice and equality, human rights, globalization, consumerism, and ethical trade. While the paradigm includes economic and environmental benefits, from an international business perspective, measures to initiate social sustainability could comprise focused efforts towards employee retention, thereby improving employee motivation instead of merely prioritizing economic benefits (Morais & Silvestre, 2018; Vega Mejía et al., 2018). International organizations that adopt and implement

180

A. L. Issac

sustainability are likely to have a positive impact on customers and communities as well, in a number of ways. By implementing sustainability, businesses can contribute to poverty reduction, increased access to education and healthcare, and improved gender equality. This can have a significant impact on the well-being of communities and can help to create a more equitable and just society. Secondly, as consumers become more aware of the impact of businesses on society and the environment, they are increasingly looking for companies that share their values and beliefs. By demonstrating a commitment to social sustainability, businesses can build trust with customers and differentiate themselves from competitors. Sustainability provides a framework for businesses to identify new opportunities for sustainable development and to work together with other stakeholders to create shared value. By collaborating with customers, suppliers, and other stakeholders, businesses can develop new solutions to complex sustainability challenges and drive positive change. Ultimately, by prioritizing social sustainability, businesses can create shared value and contribute to a more equitable and just society.

2.1.2

Economic Sustainability

This factor of the paradigm includes job creation, profitability, and proper accounting of ecosystem services for ideal cost–benefit analysis. Research at the job market indicates high rates of employment aiding both the economy and the employee wellbeing (Malik et al., 2021). Measures taken to ensure environmental sustainability also lead to economic sustainability of the organization. For instance, recycling valuable materials, such as electronic waste and textile waste, can reduce operating costs and lower the intensity of resource extraction essential to endure business continuity (Xavier et al., 2021; Nunes et al., 2018).

2.1.3

Environmental Sustainability

The environmental sustainability aspect is anchored on environmental well-being including water quality, air quality, and reduction of environmental stressors, such as greenhouse gas emissions. Human health is also dependent on the quality of an individual’s environment, inevitably linking human health and the environment and thereby the attempts to preserve and restore the environment help people as well (Krausmann et al., 2018). Natural resources provided by the environment help foster economic sustainability, and organizations relying on the extraction of natural resources can be economically sustainable (Vandyck et al., 2018). In order to transform into a sustainable society, contribution towards the following should be controlled through scientific advances such as enzymatic or catalytic plastic recycling (Tulloch & Neilson, 2014).

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens. . .

2.2

181

Circular Economy and SDGs

The 2030 development agenda (United Nations, 2015) adopted by the United Nations indicated 17 sustainable development goals (SDGs) interlinked with 169 sub-targets that were in turn structured around five pillars (5Ps)—people, planet, prosperity, peace, and partnership. While the first pillar (People) aims at eradicating poverty and hunger, the second pillar (Planet) outlines an agenda to preserve the planet from degradation. The third pillar (Prosperity) aims to establish a prosperous and fulfilling lives for all humans; the fourth pillar (Peace) strives to manifest peaceful, just, and inclusive societies; the fifth pillar (Partnership) helps to create a network in order to mobilize the implementation of this agenda (Khajuria et al., 2022)—all of this is done with the intention to shift the world into a sustainable perspective and resilient development path while leaving no man behind. Existing literature identifying the relevance and implementation of Circular Economy practices towards Sustainable Development Goals, suggests a powerful synergism between Circular Economy practices and SDG targets. These are said to exist largely lie across SDG 6 (Clean Water and Sanitation), SDG 7 (Affordable and Clean Energy), SDG 8 (Decent Work and Economic Growth), SDG12 (Responsible Consumption and Production), and SDG 15 (Life on Land), contributing to highest numbers (Schroeder et al., 2019). It is estimated that by 2030, a transition towards Circular Economy could reduce net resource spending in the European Union (EU) by 600 billion euros annually, improve resource productivity by up to 3% annually, and generate an annual net benefit of 1.8 trillion euros (Ellen Macarthur Foundation, 2015). Rightly so, the Circular Economy is seen as a potential means to pursue increased Sustainable Development (Geissdoerfer et al., 2018). Various perspectives of Circular Economy are presented via academic literature. While on end it is contrasted against environmental sciences and Sustainable Development, with CE offering a relatively clear “angle of attack” to tackle environmental problems (Sauvé et al., 2016), another study places it across three categories: One that is conditional—(CE as a condition for SD), one that beneficial—(CE benefits SD), and one as a trade-off—(CE having both positive and a negative sustainability impact) relationship (Geissdoerfer et al., 2017). While the academic discussion connecting Circular Economy to sustainability remains active, the contribution of organizations within the Circular Economy seems disregarded in literature related to Circular Economy. However, this contribution carries the potential insights towards solving current sustainability problems through the real-world impacts of firms’ CE solutions. The advancement and application of Circular Economy as a positive tool of influence towards all three dimensions of sustainability of an organization, is popularized by the Triple Bottom Line (TBL) concept (Cannibals with Forks: The Triple Bottom Line of 21st Century Business, 1999).

182

2.3

A. L. Issac

Understanding How Sustainability Differs from Circular Economy

While circularity and sustainability are terms that are being used in conjunction and somewhat interchangeably, a Circular Economy does not necessarily translate to sustainability. It is estimated that there are about 300 definitions to Sustainability (Johnston et al., 2007). Sustainability is defined to be more of a systems-level approach that like an umbrella garners a wide array of environmental, social, and economic factors and gauges their interaction and in theory cannot be sustainable in isolation (Rachel Meidl, 2021). Forbes (Rachel Meidl, 2021) declares sustainability to be a feature of a system in its entirety and not a singular focus on any individual part. The practice of circularity, on the other hand, is concentrated to support the conversion of raw materials for human consumption (The U.S. Chamber of Commerce Foundation, 2022). The Circular Economy is assumed to carry with it the potential to disrupt the current linear economy of unsustainable production, consumption, and waste generation through system innovation that designs out waste, expands resource efficiency, keeps materials in use, and secernates growth from the consumption of finite resources, thereby achieving a healthier balance between the economy, the environment, and society. Circular Economy is also presumed to be resilient against future disruptions such as pandemics, extreme and punctuated weather events, or the impacts of a changing climate (Rachel Meidl, 2021). While sustainability targets the larger benefits of the environment, the economy, and society (Cannibals with Forks: The Triple Bottom Line of 21st Century Business, 1999) and has a broader framing (Jarvie, 2016), the major focus of the Circular Economy are the economic actors that play a vital role within the system and only implicitly benefits the society. Sustainability refers to the ability of a system to meet the needs of the present without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs. It is a broad and multifaceted concept that encompasses social, economic, and environmental dimensions. Sustainability involves balancing the needs of the planet, people, and profit, and ensuring that economic growth is environmentally and socially responsible. On the other hand, the Circular Economy is a specific economic model that aims to keep resources in use for as long as possible and minimize waste. It involves moving away from the traditional linear “take-make-use-dispose” model of production and consumption, and instead designing products and systems to be regenerative and restorative. The Circular Economy framework emphasizes the importance of creating closed-loop systems where products and materials are reused, repaired, or recycled, rather than being disposed of as waste. While sustainability and Circular Economy are distinct concepts, they are closely related and can reinforce each other. For example, a company that adopts Circular Economy principles to reduce waste and improve resource efficiency can contribute

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens. . .

183

to sustainability by reducing its environmental impact and conserving resources for future generations. Similarly, a city that adopts sustainable policies such as renewable energy and green infrastructure can create a more conducive environment for the Circular Economy by reducing the cost and environmental impact of resource extraction and waste disposal. To illustrate the difference between Sustainability and Circular Economy with an example, consider a company that produces single-use plastic bottles. A sustainability-oriented approach to this problem would involve reducing the environmental impact of the company’s operations by using recycled materials, minimizing waste, and reducing carbon emissions. In contrast, a Circular Economy approach would involve redesigning the product and production process to create a closed-loop system where plastic bottles are collected, recycled, and reused to make new bottles, rather than being discarded as waste.

2.4

The Contribution of Circular Economy Towards SDGs and in Turn Towards Sustainability (Table 1)

3 Circular Economy Encapsulated Within International Businesses 3.1

The Need for Sustainability in International Business

The need for sustainability in international business has been well documented in academic literature, scholarly articles, and corporate reports. A study by Esen (2013) found that corporate social responsibility (CSR) initiatives can enhance a company’s reputation and brand image. Similarly, a report by Cone Communications found that 87% of consumers would purchase a product because a company advocated for an issue they cared about (Cone Communications, 2017). A report by KPMG (2017) found that sustainability risks are becoming increasingly important for businesses to manage. The report highlights the need for businesses to assess the environmental and social impact of their operations and supply chains to identify potential risks and develop strategies to manage them. A report by the United Nations (2017) found that sustainability practices can lead to cost savings for businesses. The report highlights examples of companies that have reduced costs by improving energy efficiency, reducing waste, and adopting sustainable sourcing practices. A report by Nielsen (2018) found that sustainability is becoming increasingly important for consumers when making purchasing decisions. The report highlights the potential for businesses to access new markets and increase

184

A. L. Issac

Table 1 The incorporation of circular economy practices in international business; Source: Multiple authors

Sr. No. SDG 2 and Sub-Target 2.4

SDG Focuses sustainable food production systems. It also ensures the implementation of strong agricultural practices that help improve productivity and production, aid sustainable ecosystems, reinforce capacity for adaptation to climate change, extreme weather, drought, flooding, and other disasters (Mukhisa Kituyi, 2016).

SDG 6 and Sub-target 6.1

The responsibility to achieve universal and equitable access to safe

The contribution of circular economy towards SDGs in international business The idea of circular agriculture can help reinstate and augment the quality of soil through techniques such as the design of local nutrient loops. Reweighing the effectiveness of the value chains can also help avoid food losses (Van Kruchten & Van Eijk, 2020). Biomass, a precious renewable resource, captures CO2 from the air and acts a potential source for food, animal feed, materials, transport fuel and energy. It rightfully lies at the heart of the Circular Economy and the existing scarce biomass can be addressed via circular production (Van Kruchten & Van Eijk, 2020) The reclamation of degenerated land can be achieved by connecting nutrient loops, through farms that are located close to consumers through urban and periurban farming. Organic agriculture would minimize the need for fertilizers and pesticides, thus ensuring the non-wastefulness of the food system with the circular also being regenerative, resilient, and healthy (Van Kruchten & Van Eijk, 2020) The recycling and reuse of water aids in the essential improvement of

Examples of real-time applications For instance, a farm in Uganda has developed a small-scale mixed farming system that houses a wide variety of livestock and plants on the farm. Waste products are shared and reused within the system to provide fertilizers, pesticides, and energy. The waste is fed to maggots and is used as feed for fish and other animals. The insects’ waste and nutrient-rich wastewater from the aquaculture system is used to fertilize and irrigate crops. An anaerobic digester is also used to process livestock waste to make biogas for cooking. This farm aims to emulate natural processes by integrating livestock and crop production to allow systems to make use of other’s waste and reduce environmental impact, as well as to generate multiple income streams, improving the farms environmental and economic sustainability (Africa Food Prize, 2019; Ellen MacArthur Foundation, 2010; Nattassha et al., 2020)

For instance, the Chennai Metropolitan Water Supply and Sewerage (continued)

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens. . .

185

Table 1 (continued)

Sr. No.

SDG 8

SDG

The contribution of circular economy towards SDGs in international business

and affordable drinking water for all, by 2030, the proportion of population using safely managed drinking water services being an indicator (United Nations, 2022)

water quality, by reducing pollution and minimizing hazardous chemicals and materials in a Circular Economy can be achieved via: (a) Water-efficient technologies and closed-loop systems. (b) Recovery of valuable constituents from process water and industrial symbioses. (c) Site-specific, decentralized removal of hazardous substances. (d) Recovery of nutrient and energy at wastewater treatment plants. (e) Reuse of treated wastewater or its introduction into the environment. (f) Recycling of water and nutrients & waterefficient irrigation systems, management of water balance, and recovery of substances (International Water Association, 2016).

The agenda to promote sustained, inclusive, and

Since Circular Economy creates different avenues

Examples of real-time applications Board (CMWSSB) in India has launched a number of initiatives and investments to diversify water supply, improve water efficiency, and strengthen its capacity to withstand droughts. Since 2005, CMWSSB has been putting various projects into action to treat and reuse wastewater. It recoups the capital investment in the reuse project in less than 5 years by selling the treated wastewater to industrial users and covering all operating and maintenance costs with the additional revenues. Additionally, the CMWSSB retrofitted seven of its wastewater treatment facilities to recover energy from waste and supply more than half of the plants’ total energy requirements. This helped to lower GHG emissions while also saving on energy costs and supporting operations financially. The payback period for the energy generation investment was 2.8 years (Morseletto et al., 2022; Voulvoulis, 2018; UNESCO & International Centre for Water Security and Sustainable Management, 2020; Delgado et al., 2021) In the area of agriculture, for instance, Association (continued)

186

A. L. Issac

Table 1 (continued)

Sr. No.

SDG 9

SDG

The contribution of circular economy towards SDGs in international business

sustainable economic growth, full and productive employment, and decent work for all to improve living standards (United Nations, 2022).

that does not otherwise exist with primary production and the disposal practice with linear economy, the Circular Economy creates more jobs (Van Kruchten & Van Eijk, 2020). The UK Waste & Resources Action Plan (WRAP) predicts the creation of three million more jobs within the EU alone, three times more than usual business, with enhanced activities like industrial symbiosis and remanufacturing while the current employment in the Circular Economy being around 3.4 million people (HM Government, 2018).

Building resilient infrastructure, promotion of inclusive and sustainable industrialization to foster innovation (United Nations, 2022).

Industrial symbiosis via which byproducts of an industry or its process becomes the raw materials for another, remanufacturing, and closed-loop supply chains (World Business Council for Sustainable Development, 2018a).

Examples of real-time applications pour le Maintien d’une Agriculture Paysanne (AMAP) in France is establishing direct links between local farmers and consumers, thereby helping to shorten supply chains between producers and consumers and creating local jobs at the same time (International Institute for Sustainable Development, 2020). According to research by Circle Economy and Ehero, there were 810,000 jobs in the Dutch circular labor force in 2015, or 8% of all jobs in the country. Before 2008, the percentage of circular jobs in the Dutch workforce as a whole was fairly stable, hovering around the 10% mark. However, after 2008, it significantly decreased, losing almost 100,000 of these positions (Sulich & Sołoducho-Pelc, 2021; Circle Economy & Erasmus Research Institute for Happiness Economics (Ehero), 2022) In order to improve waste processing, treatment, and recycling in the city of Lahti, PäijätHäme Waste Management Ltd. (PHJ) has applied the concepts of industrial symbiosis. Their project for the Kujala Waste Center has succeeded. To make it (continued)

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens. . .

187

Table 1 (continued)

Sr. No.

SDG 11

SDG

Making cities and human settlements inclusive, safe, resilient, and sustainable (United Nations, 2022).

The contribution of circular economy towards SDGs in international business

Examples of real-time applications

Embedding core resources of circularity at their highest potential— from water, via housing and infrastructure, to food and nutrition, the idea of Circular Cities aims to sustain the societal needs of its residents within the natural boundaries of the earth. Circular Cities could additionally: (a) Providing a platform to showcase ideal practices within the city. (b) Discovering the circular potential of the city and setting priorities and ambitions. (c) Including businesses and creating space for experimentation. (d) Comprehending the barriers to circularity and addressing them. (e) Promoting the interdisciplinary and crosssectoral collaborations. (f) Leading by example and building on successes. (g) Establishing mainstream circular thinking into all education and training. (h) Monitoring, adjusting, and scaling (Circle

simple to transfer wasterelated outputs from one business to another for reuse or further processing, several waste-related businesses were consolidated on a single site covering over 70 ha (Oughton et al., 2022) Glasgow City Council, Circle Economy, and Zero Waste Scotland are partners in the delivery of Circular Glasgow, a project of the Glasgow Chamber of Commerce. It lays out a vision for Glasgow’s Circular Economy and offers the city’s business community concrete steps they can take to support economic growth, resource recovery and reuse, and carbon emissions reductions (Ellen MacArthur Foundation, 2023a). In the spring of 2018, the City of San Francisco passed a law requiring all carpets installed in city departments to be at least Cradle-to-Cradle Certified Silver and free of antimicrobials, fluorinated compounds, flame retardant chemicals, and other hazardous substances. When it comes to carpet adhesives, the same rules apply. To make replacement simple and reduce waste, carpet tiles should be used. Additionally, the carpet fibers and backing (continued)

188

A. L. Issac

Table 1 (continued)

Sr. No.

SDG

The contribution of circular economy towards SDGs in international business Economy & Holland Circular Hotspot, 2019).

SDG 12

Ensuring sustainable consumption and production practices maximizing the socioeconomic benefits of resource use (United Nations, 2022).

Implementing Circular Economy practices in terms of water management, waste management, sustainable products and services, sustainable supply chains as well as synergies with renewable energy (Van Kruchten & Van Eijk, 2020). Executing Circular Economy practices via small-

Examples of real-time applications materials must both have a minimum percentage of recycled materials and be recyclable after use (Ellen MacArthur Foundation, 2023b). In an effort to lower emissions, lessen noise pollution, and improve air quality, Shenzhen became the first city in the world to electrify all public buses in 2017. Additionally, the project promoted the advancement of electric mobility. Manufacturers are encouraged by the adoption of new service models to create auto parts that are easy to maintain, keep in use, and retain value. There are currently more than 16,000 electric public buses (e-buses) operating on city streets, and the city has invested heavily in urban infrastructure, adding more than 500 bus charging stations and 5100 bus charging points (Ellen MacArthur Foundation, 2023d). 10.9 billion cans and bottles were recycled for reuse in Denmark in 2021, reaching a return rate of 93% for disposable packaging. Dansk Retursystem, the Danish deposit and return system for recycling beverage cans and bottles, is largely to blame for this. A widespread circular (continued)

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens. . .

189

Table 1 (continued)

Sr. No.

SDG

The contribution of circular economy towards SDGs in international business scale biomass technologies (e.g., biogas) are crucial elements of renewable energy systems. Circular Economy practices can also be used in industry and buildings for energy efficiency, however (e.g., waste heat recovery or insulation materials) (Babette Porcelijn, 2016).

SDG 13

Undertaking immediate action towards climate change and its impacts

The application of strategies in the Circular Economy within four critical industries—cement, steel, plastic, and aluminum could help in the reduction of emissions by 40% in 2050. Across the food system, the reduction could amount to 49%, bringing emissions 45% closer to their net-zero emission targets (Ellen Macarthur Foundation, 2021).

Examples of real-time applications return system that enables you to return your used beverage containers to supermarkets and self-service kiosks throughout Denmark in exchange for a cash deposit (Boorová, 2020). The Danish deposit system can be viewed as a model for boosting recycling rates and promoting the Circular Economy, particularly in order to meet the EU target of collecting 90% of plastic bottles by 2029 (Dansk Retursystem, 2022). Greenhouse gas emissions can be decreased throughout the value chain by removing waste and pollution. The embodied energy is kept by circulating goods and materials, by regenerating nature, reducing carbon in products and soil. For example, it is possible to reduce emissions from construction materials by 38% by 2050 in the building and construction industry by reducing waste, increasing building sharing, and recycling and reusing construction materials. The emissions from the food system can be cut in half by 2050 in agriculture by switching to regenerative production methods, eliminating food waste, and using (continued)

190

A. L. Issac

Table 1 (continued)

Sr. No.

SDG

The contribution of circular economy towards SDGs in international business

SDG 14

Addressing the conservation and sustainable use of the oceans, seas, and marine resources for sustainable development.

(a) Calling for regulatory interventions like the setting up of or expansion of extended producer responsibility (EPR) for working with bans, taxes, subsidies. (b) Communicating with consumers about the aftermath of the products that they buy and the ways to separate their waste. (c) Ensuring source separation of plastics and phasing out unnecessary materials such as singleuse plastics (Van Kruchten & Van Eijk, 2020).

SDG 15

To ensure the protection, restoration and promotion and the sustainable use of terrestrial ecosystems, sustainable forest management, tackling of desertification, reversing land degradation, and halting biodiversity loss (United Nations, 2022).

Organic agriculture and organic waste management can strengthen the resilience to benefit biodiversity as well as forestry (Van Kruchten & Van Eijk, 2020). Biomimicry that reckons on the operation of ecosystems emulates

Examples of real-time applications better and up-cycled ingredients in food products and menus (Ellen MacArthur Foundation, 2023c). This case study is one in a series that the World Bank’s Water Global Practice has created to highlight real-world water sector experiences. The series aims to highlight one or more of the components that can lead to a Water in Circular Economics and Resilience (WICER) system. Cambodia’s capital city of Phnom Penh is the subject of this case (Morseletto et al., 2022). Efficiency in using resources and zero (or minimal) waste is two of the central tenets of a Circular Economy. The Phnom Penh Water Supply Authority (PPWSA) is adopting Circular Economy principles in order to create a more sustainable future by significantly reducing water losses and enhancing operational effectiveness (World Bank Group, 2022). The Japanese bullet train Shinkansen serves as one example. According to Sunni Robertson of the San Diego Zoo, a center for biomimicry research and education, Japan made a breakthrough in transportation technology in the late ’90s that (continued)

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens. . .

191

Table 1 (continued)

Sr. No.

SDG

The contribution of circular economy towards SDGs in international business functional strategies to create sustainable solutions that embody the reconnection of nature (The Biomimicry Institute, 2023)

SDG 17

To strengthen the means of implementation and revitalization of the Global Partnership for Sustainable Development (United Nations, 2022).

To design products and materials with the objective of long-term value retention: Product Design, Circular Materials, Classic Long Life, Encourage Sufficiency and to enforce industrial symbiosis, with an organization’s waste becoming another’s resource, creates a mutual symbiotic dependency (Van

Examples of real-time applications allowed trains to travel at 300 kph. However, the bullet train’s impact with the air cushion that was accumulating in front of it caused sound pollution issues. Both local residents and the wildlife were startled by the booming noise. When a kingfisher bird flew into the water with a smooth splash at that time, Japanese engineers who were out for a stroll in the park witnessed it. Engineers visited biologists in awe and learned that the large head and the long, narrow beak were the miracles. The bullet train eliminated any boom and saved an additional 10–15% of energy thanks to a straightforward change in design that was inspired by nature. We can see how Benyus’ four essential steps for achieving a biomimetic future are applied practically through Shinkansen’s example (Dinh, 2021). Non-governmental organizations (NGOs) are stepping in to bring together various stakeholders, like the Alliance to End Plastic Waste, which has its headquarters in Singapore, and the Worldwide Fund for Nature (WWF). The Alliance collaborates with the innovation platform Plug and Play, (continued)

192

A. L. Issac

Table 1 (continued)

Sr. No.

SDG

The contribution of circular economy towards SDGs in international business Kruchten & Van Eijk, 2020).

Examples of real-time applications which connects over 30,000 start-ups, businesses, venture capitalists, and other industry players. This collaboration enables promising start-ups fighting plastic pollution to grow. Through their 90-day accelerator, 11 start-ups from across the value chain were linked to large multinationals’ investment and support in 2020. These solutions ranged from smart home waste management tools to robots that collect floating waste in waterways. Global consumer goods companies like Procter & Gamble and Nestle, many of which have their Asia and Pacific (APAC) Office headquarters in Singapore, are collaborating with regional research organizations like the Institute of Sustainability for Chemicals, Energy, and Environment (ISCE2) of the Agency for Science, Technology and Research (A*STAR). These collaborations could hasten the creation and commercialization of circular innovations. One such instance is HyperScale, the first waste-tech accelerator in Asia established by Enterprise Singapore (ESG) and StartupX in (continued)

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens. . .

193

Table 1 (continued)

Sr. No.

SDG

The contribution of circular economy towards SDGs in international business

Examples of real-time applications April 2022. The program provides start-ups in the recycling of plastics and e-waste with the knowledge they need to develop marketable products and longlasting business models. Additionally, it links them to local stakeholders who can help them improve their product-market fit as well as VC firms and impact investment funds that specialize in wasteand sustainability-related technologies (Poh, 2022).

their competitiveness by adopting sustainable practices. A study by Global Reporting Initiative (2018) found that sustainability reporting is becoming increasingly important for businesses to comply with regulations and meet stakeholder expectations. The report highlights the need for businesses to adopt a comprehensive approach to sustainability reporting that includes environmental, social, and governance (ESG) issues. A study by PwC (2018) found that employees are increasingly interested in working for companies that are committed to sustainability. The report highlights the potential for businesses to attract and retain talented employees by adopting sustainable practices. The need for sustainability in international business is supported by a range of academic research and corporate reports. These sources highlight the potential benefits of sustainability practices in terms of reputation and brand image, risk management, cost savings, access to new markets, compliance with regulations, and employee engagement.

3.2

Current State of International Businesses’ Adopting Circular Economy

To this day, several organizations still find it difficult to view Circular Economy as a revenue-making paradigm, and instead view it as being risky and expensive

194

A. L. Issac

(Cristoni & Tonelli, 2018). Circular Economy can drive sustainable practices in several areas within organizations such as strategic planning, cost management, circular supply chain management, quality management, environmental management, process management, logistics and reverse logistics, service management, and research and development (Barros et al., 2021). Only niche markets like product service systems in automotive coatings and resource recovery in the steel sector, so far have been able to successfully adopt the Circular Economy to a significant extent. The reuse and remanufacturing, sharing of under-utilized capacity, and the provision of services amount to only a small proportion of not more than 10% output in most sectors (Organization for Economic Co-operation and Development, 2018). There are several practical actions and strategies that international organizations can develop and promote to encourage a more effective implementation of the circular economy. Governments can promote the implementation of extended producer responsibility (EPR) programs, which require producers to take responsibility for the environmental impact of their products throughout their lifecycle. EPR programs can encourage the adoption of circular economy practices such as product design for recyclability and the use of recycled materials. Design for Circularity is an approach that involves designing products, processes, and systems with circularity in mind. This approach can involve designing products that are easy to disassemble and repair, using recycled materials, and reducing waste and emissions throughout the product lifecycle. International organizations can promote circular business models such as product-as-a-service, which involves providing customers with access to a product rather than selling it outright. This model can encourage businesses to design products that are durable, easy to repair, and designed for circularity. And finally, international organizations can promote research and development in circular innovation, which involves developing new technologies, materials, and business models that support circular economy principles. This can involve providing funding for research, fostering collaborations between businesses and researchers, and supporting the development of pilot projects (Table 2).

3.3

Ensuring the Continuous Adoption of Circular Economy in International Businesses

Extensive literature across sources claims Circular Economy in both developed and developing countries could benefit in terms of cost savings, job creation, innovation, productivity, and resource efficiency (e.g., Yuan et al., 2008; Ellen MacArthur Foundation, 2015; Gower & Schroeder, 2016). Despite these optimistic economic benefits, currently the amount of all materials recycled from the ones processed by the global economy are only as little as 6%, while the intensity of circularity within the EU economy is almost twice as much as

Exploring Circular Economy in International Businesses Through the Lens. . .

195

Table 2 The market share of sectors that have adopted Circular Business Model; Source: Andrew McCarthyi et al. (2018), Organization for Economic Co-operation and Development (2018) Business Model PSS: result-oriented (chemicals) PSS: result-oriented (digital content) Waste as value: Recycling PSS: result-oriented (digital content) Waste as value: Recycling PSS: result-oriented (chemicals) Waste as value: Recycling Product life extension: Refurbishment PSS: result-oriented (lighting and heating) Product life extension: remanufacturing Product life extension: refurbishment Product life extension: remanufacturing Idle Capacity: co-access Product life extension: remanufacturing Product life extension: remanufacturing Was as value: recycling PSS: user-oriented (car sharing)

Sector Automobile Music

Market penetration 50–80% 50%

Pulp and paper Books

38% 25–35%

Steel Aeronautical Plastics Smartphones

25% 5–15% 13% 4–8%

Miscellaneous

4–8%

Machinery

3–4%

Miscellaneous

2–3%

Aeronautical

2–12%

Lodging Automobile

1–6% 1%

Consumer and electrical and electronic equipment (EEE) Rare earth element (REE) metals Transit

0–1%